PACKAGED ROOFTOP
AIR CONDITIONING UNITS
Form 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
035-21979-002
New Release
INSTALLATION, OPERATION & MAINTENANCE
YPAL 050
YPAL 051
YPAL 060
YPAL 061
DESIGN LEVEL F
SIMPLICITY ELITE CONTROL
LD13271
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
CHANGEABILITY OF THIS DOCUMENT
In complying with JOHNSON CONTROLS’s policy
for continuous product improvement, the information
contained in this document is subject to change without
notice. While JOHNSON CONTROLS makes no
commitment to update or provide current information
automatically to the manual owner, that information, if
applicable, can be obtained by contacting the nearest
JOHNSON CONTROLS Applied Systems office.
It is the responsibility of operating/service personnel
to verify the applicability of these documents to the
equipment in question. If there is any question in
the mind of operating/service personnel as to the
applicability of these documents, then prior to working
on the equipment, they should verify with the owner
whether the equipment has been modified and if current
literature is available.
NOMENCLATURE
BASE MODEL NUMBER
YPAL050-061
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
Base Product
Type
Nominal Capacity
Application Refrigerant
Voltage
Supply
Openings
Return Design Special
Openings
Y
P
A
:YORK
0
0
0
0
5
5
6
6
0
1
0
1
:50 Ton Capacity
:51 Ton Capacity
:60 Ton Capacity
:61 Ton Capacity
B :R-407C
C :R-22
:208/3/60
:230/3/60
:460/3/60
:575/3/60
:380/3/60
:400/3/50
X
S
A
B
:Standard
2
5
:Packaged Rooftop
:Air Cooled
:Scroll
:Special P
:Standard
:Special P
E
:R-410A
4
5
4
4
6
8
0
5
L
C
V
F
:Constant Volume
:VAV, VFD
:Flexsys
F
:Revision Level F
B
R
S
:Bottom Return
:Rear Return
:Side Return
C
N
G
M
F
E
H
S
:Cooling Only
:Staged Natural Gas Heat
:Staged Natural Gas Heat SS HX
:Full Modulating Gas Heat
:Full Modulating Gas Heat SS Staged HX
:Electric Heat
B
L
R
:Bottom Supply
:Left Supply
:Right Supply
:Hot Water Heat
:Steam Heat
LD13270
JOHNSON CONTROLS
3
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
TABLE OF CONTENTS
BASE MODEL NUMBER ..............................................................................................................................3
CHANGEABILITY OF THIS DOCUMENT.....................................................................................................3
NOMENCLATURE.........................................................................................................................................3
TABLE OF CONTENTS ................................................................................................................................4
LIST OF TABLES........................................................................................................................................11
LIST OF FIGURES ......................................................................................................................................12
SECTION 1 – INTRODUCTION.........................................................................................................13
ECOLOGICAL AND ECONOMICAL DESIGN............................................................................................13
Condensing Section.............................................................................................................13
Heating Section.....................................................................................................................14
AIR MANAGEMENT....................................................................................................................................15
CONTROLS.................................................................................................................................................15
INDOOR AIR QUALITY ..............................................................................................................................15
ELECTRICAL ..............................................................................................................................................16
SERVICE AND INSTALLATION..................................................................................................................16
SECTION 2 – INSTALLATION...........................................................................................................17
APPROVALS...............................................................................................................................................17
LIMITATIONS...............................................................................................................................................17
UNIT INSPECTION......................................................................................................................................17
LOCATIONS AND CLEARANCES .............................................................................................................17
RIGGING AND HANDLING.........................................................................................................................19
UNIT WEIGHTS...........................................................................................................................................20
Unit Placement......................................................................................................................21
Roof Curb Installation ..........................................................................................................22
PHYSICAL DATA.........................................................................................................................................23
GENERAL ARRANGEMENT DRAWING – 050-061 MODELS .................................................................25
Bottom Supply / Bottom Return..........................................................................................25
Bottom Supply / Side Return...............................................................................................26
Bottom Supply / Rear Return...............................................................................................27
Curb Layout Drawing / 050-061 Models..............................................................................28
ELECTRICAL DATA....................................................................................................................................29
Electrical Service Sizing ......................................................................................................29
Load Definitions: ..................................................................................................................29
FILTERS ......................................................................................................................................................32
CONDENSATE DRAIN................................................................................................................................32
Condensate Drain Piping.....................................................................................................32
Condensate Drain Trap ........................................................................................................32
AIR HOODS FOR ECONOMIZER...............................................................................................................33
AIR HOODS FOR FIXED OUTSIDE AIR (UNITS WITHOUT ECONOMIZER)...........................................33
AIR HOODS FOR EXHAUST AIR...............................................................................................................33
JOHNSON CONTROLS
4
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
TABLE OF CONTENTS
FIELD WIRING ............................................................................................................................................33
Thermostat ............................................................................................................................33
Fan input................................................................................................................................33
Space Sensor........................................................................................................................33
CO2 Sensor ...........................................................................................................................34
Occupied / Unoccupied Input..............................................................................................34
Shutdown Input.....................................................................................................................34
Smoke Purge Input...............................................................................................................34
BAS Economizer Input.........................................................................................................34
Fault Output ..........................................................................................................................34
VAV Heat Relay Output.........................................................................................................35
Supply Air Temperature Reset.............................................................................................35
COMMUNICATION......................................................................................................................................35
DIRTY FILTER SWITCH..............................................................................................................................35
FIELD CONTROL WIRING CONNECTIONS..............................................................................................36
POWER WIRING.........................................................................................................................................37
ELECTRICAL SERVICE SIZING.................................................................................................................37
SINGLE-POINT POWER SUPPLY WIRING ...............................................................................................38
SINGLE-POINT POWER SUPPLY WIRING WITH NON-FUSED DISCONNECT SWITCH.......................39
DUAL-POINT POWER SUPPLY WIRING...................................................................................................40
CONTROLS.................................................................................................................................................41
TRANSDUCER PNEUMATIC TUBING.......................................................................................................42
Static Pressure Control Plastic Tubing .............................................................................42
Duct Static Transducer.........................................................................................................42
Building Pressure Transducer.............................................................................................42
Static Pressure Probe Installation ......................................................................................42
DUCT SYSTEM ...........................................................................................................................................44
Duct Connection Guidelines................................................................................................44
SOUND AND VIBRATION TRANSMISSION ..............................................................................................44
GAS HEATING ............................................................................................................................................45
GAS PIPING................................................................................................................................................45
GAS CONNECTION....................................................................................................................................45
Gas Piping Recommendations............................................................................................45
COMBUSTION VENT..................................................................................................................................46
SECTION 3 – START-UP...................................................................................................................47
CRANKCASE HEATERS............................................................................................................................47
CHECKING THE SYSTEM PRIOR TO INITIAL START (NO POWER)......................................................47
Unit Checks...........................................................................................................................47
UNIT CHECKS – POWER APPLIED ..........................................................................................................49
Verifying Compressor Rotation...........................................................................................49
Compressor Oil Level Check...............................................................................................49
JOHNSON CONTROLS
5
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
TABLE OF CONTENTS
INITIAL START-UP......................................................................................................................................50
Refrigerant Charge ..............................................................................................................50
Checking Superheat and Subcooling.................................................................................50
Subcooling (R-410A) ............................................................................................................50
Superheat (R-410A) ..............................................................................................................50
Leak Checking ......................................................................................................................51
GAS HEAT MODELS ..................................................................................................................................53
Pre-Start Checks:..................................................................................................................53
Post Start Checks:................................................................................................................53
SECTION 4 – MAINTENANCE..........................................................................................................55
GENERAL ...................................................................................................................................................55
PERIODIC MAINTENANCE – MONTHLY...................................................................................................55
Filters.....................................................................................................................................55
Linkages ................................................................................................................................55
Compressors.........................................................................................................................55
Fan Bearing Lubrication .....................................................................................................55
Recommended Lubricant for Fan Bearings.......................................................................55
Condenser Coils ...................................................................................................................56
PERIODIC MAINTENANCE – THREE TO SIX MONTHS ..........................................................................56
Motor Bearing Lubrication...................................................................................................56
Belt Tension ..........................................................................................................................56
PERIODIC MAINTENANCE – YEARLY......................................................................................................56
Entire Unit Inspection...........................................................................................................56
Sheave Alignment: ...............................................................................................................56
Belts.......................................................................................................................................56
Belt Replacement..................................................................................................................57
Belt Tensioning:....................................................................................................................57
Filter Drier Replacement ......................................................................................................58
Forward Curved Fans...........................................................................................................58
Fan Motor ..............................................................................................................................59
Fan Shaft Bearings...............................................................................................................59
Bearing Lock Devices ..........................................................................................................60
Eccentric Type ......................................................................................................................60
Torquing of Set-screws .......................................................................................................61
SECTION 5 – SEQUENCE OF OPERATION ....................................................................................63
UNIT TYPE ..................................................................................................................................................63
OCCUPIED / UNOCCUPIED MODE...........................................................................................................63
CONSTANT VOLUME MODE (CV).............................................................................................................63
Thermostat Input ..................................................................................................................64
Occupied Cooling ............................................................................................................64
Unoccupied Cooling........................................................................................................64
Occupied Heating ............................................................................................................65
Unoccupied Heating ........................................................................................................65
JOHNSON CONTROLS
6
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
TABLE OF CONTENTS
Space Sensor – Hard Wired or Communicated .................................................................65
Cooling Operation – Occupied or Unoccupied.............................................................65
Heating Operation – Occupied or Unoccupied .............................................................66
Stand Alone...........................................................................................................................66
Cooling Operation – Occupied or Unoccupied.............................................................67
Heating Operation – Occupied or Unoccupied .............................................................67
VARIABLE AIR VOLUME (VAV) .................................................................................................................68
Cooling - Occupied with Thermostat..................................................................................68
Cooling – Unoccupied with Thermostat.............................................................................69
Occupied or Unoccupied Heating with a Thermostat .......................................................69
Occupied Cooling with Hard Wired or Communicated Space Sensor ............................69
Cooling – Unoccupied with a Hard Wired or Communicated Space Sensor .................70
Heating – Occupied with a Hard Wired or Communicated Space Sensor ......................70
Heating – Unoccupied with a Hard Wired or Communicated Space Sensor ..................70
Occupied Cooling – Stand Alone........................................................................................71
Cooling – Unoccupied Stand Alone ...................................................................................72
Heating – Occupied Stand Alone ........................................................................................72
Heating – Unoccupied Stand Alone....................................................................................72
CONDENSER FAN OPERATION ...............................................................................................................72
COOLING COMPRESSOR LOCKOUT .....................................................................................................72
Sequence of Operation .......................................................................................................72
LOW AMBIENT OPERATION ....................................................................................................................73
Operation and Pressure Control Range .............................................................................73
Configuration (Jumpers and Potentiometers) ...................................................................73
SUPPLY FAN OPERATION.........................................................................................................................74
Constant Volume (CV)..........................................................................................................74
Variable Air Volume (VAV)....................................................................................................75
VAV Supply Fan Speed Control...........................................................................................76
ECONOMIZER.............................................................................................................................................76
Dry Bulb.................................................................................................................................76
Single Enthalpy.....................................................................................................................77
Dual Enthalpy........................................................................................................................77
BAS ECONOMIZER OPERATION .............................................................................................................77
Sequence of Operation .......................................................................................................78
Constant Volume Economizer Set Point ............................................................................78
Variable Air Volume Economizer Set Point ........................................................................78
Economizer / Compressor Operation .................................................................................79
Economizer PI Loop (Proportional and Integral)...............................................................79
ECONOMIZER LOADING...........................................................................................................................79
Constant Volume ..................................................................................................................80
Variable Air Volume ..............................................................................................................80
JOHNSON CONTROLS
7
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
TABLE OF CONTENTS
COMFORT VENTILATION ..........................................................................................................................81
Sequence of Operation ........................................................................................................82
Conditions of Operation.......................................................................................................82
EXCESSIVE SAT (SUPPLY AIR TEMPERATURE) CONTROL .................................................................82
Cooling ..................................................................................................................................82
Heating...................................................................................................................................83
SPACE SENSOR WITH SET POINT ADJUSTMENT.................................................................................84
Sequence of Operation ........................................................................................................84
SPACE SENSOR FAULT OVERRIDE ENABLE ........................................................................................85
Sequence of Operation ........................................................................................................85
REMOTE CONTROL...................................................................................................................................85
Sequence of Operation ........................................................................................................85
REDLINE .....................................................................................................................................................85
Sequence of Operation ........................................................................................................85
LOADSHED.................................................................................................................................................86
Sequence of Operation ........................................................................................................86
DIRTY FILTER.............................................................................................................................................86
Sequence of Operation ........................................................................................................86
METRIC OPERATION.................................................................................................................................86
INTELLI-START ..........................................................................................................................................86
Sequence of Operation ........................................................................................................87
Subsequent Operation .........................................................................................................87
MORNING WARM-UP.................................................................................................................................88
Sequence of Operation ........................................................................................................88
HYDRONIC HEAT .......................................................................................................................................89
Sequence of Operation ........................................................................................................89
HYDRONIC HEAT FREEZE STAT ..............................................................................................................89
VENTILATION .............................................................................................................................................89
Manual ...................................................................................................................................90
Fixed Minimum......................................................................................................................90
Sequence of Operation ........................................................................................................90
Demand Ventilation ..............................................................................................................90
Definitions ........................................................................................................................91
Sequence of Operation....................................................................................................91
VENTILATION LOW AMBIENT MINIMUM POSITION RESET ..................................................................91
Sequence of Operation ........................................................................................................91
EXHAUST FAN OPERATION .....................................................................................................................92
On/Off Control Based on Outdoor Damper Position.........................................................92
Sequence of Operation....................................................................................................92
On/Off Control Based on Building Pressure......................................................................92
Sequence of Operation....................................................................................................93
JOHNSON CONTROLS
8
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
TABLE OF CONTENTS
Modulating Damper with Fixed Speed Exhaust.................................................................93
Sequence of Operation....................................................................................................93
Modulating Exhaust with a VFD ..........................................................................................93
Sequence of Operation....................................................................................................94
PRE-OCCUPANCY PURGE........................................................................................................................94
Criteria for Operation ...........................................................................................................94
Sequence of Operation ........................................................................................................94
ENERGY RECOVERY VENTILATOR .........................................................................................................95
Sequence of Operation ........................................................................................................95
LOW VOLTAGE PROTECTION ..................................................................................................................95
OUTDOOR AIR HEATING LOCKOUT........................................................................................................95
HOT GAS BYPASS.....................................................................................................................................95
SPACE TEMPERATURE ALARM...............................................................................................................95
Sequence of Operation ........................................................................................................96
SAT ALARM FOR HEATING.......................................................................................................................96
Sequence of Operation ........................................................................................................96
“Supply Air Temp Alarm Setpoint for Heating” Alarm .................................................96
“Economizer Minimum Position” Alarm........................................................................97
SAT ALARM FOR COOLING......................................................................................................................97
Sequence of Operation ........................................................................................................97
“Supply Air Temp Alarm Setpoint for Cooling” Alarm .................................................97
“Economizer Minimum Position” Alarm........................................................................98
ALARM HISTORY .......................................................................................................................................98
SECTION 6 – USER INTERFACE .....................................................................................................99
UNIT CONTROLLER INTERFACE .............................................................................................................99
PROGRAM BUTTON ..................................................................................................................................99
TEST/UP BUTTON....................................................................................................................................100
ADDRESS/DOWN BUTTON.....................................................................................................................100
ALARM/CHANGE .....................................................................................................................................100
CHARACTER DISPLAY ADDRESSES & CODES ...................................................................................100
COMMUNICATION USING SIMPLICITY PC ............................................................................................104
Simplicity PC Download.....................................................................................................104
USB Adapter Drive - Simplicity Pocket PC.......................................................................106
Establishing Communication ............................................................................................107
Simplicity PC Data Screens...............................................................................................111
Revising Settings................................................................................................................126
SECTION 7 – PARAMETER DESCRIPTIONS AND OPTIONS ......................................................141
SECTION 8 – SERVICE...................................................................................................................153
ANALOG INPUT OPERATION .................................................................................................................153
Temperature Sensors.........................................................................................................153
Duct Pressure Transducer.................................................................................................153
JOHNSON CONTROLS
9
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
TABLE OF CONTENTS
Return Fan Pressure Transducer......................................................................................154
Discharge Pressure Transducer........................................................................................154
Building Pressure Transducer...........................................................................................154
Suction Pressure Transducer............................................................................................155
Humidity Sensors ...............................................................................................................155
CO2 Sensor..........................................................................................................................156
Furnace Status Input..........................................................................................................156
FAULTS AND LOCKOUTS .......................................................................................................................160
Light Emitting Diode...........................................................................................................160
Alarm Codes........................................................................................................................160
Alarm Trouble Shooting.....................................................................................................163
Refrigerant System Alarm Codes (01, 02, 03, 04, 09, 10, 11, 12)................................163
Low Pressure Cutout Alarm (09, 10, 11, 12).................................................................164
Limit Switch Alarms (13, 14, 15) ...................................................................................164
Gas Heating Alarms (16, 17, 18)....................................................................................164
Space Temperature Sensor Alarm (19) ........................................................................164
Supply Air Temperature Sensor Alarm (20).................................................................165
Return Air Temperature Sensor Alarm (21) .................................................................165
Outdoor Air Temperature Sensor Alarm (22)...............................................................165
Dirty Filter Switch Alarm (23)........................................................................................165
Supply Fan Air Proving Switch (24) .............................................................................165
Supply Fan Air Proving Switch Closed Alarm (25) .....................................................165
Microelectronics Failure Alarm (26) .............................................................................165
Microelectronics Failure Alarm (27) .............................................................................165
Supply Fan Overload Alarm (28)...................................................................................165
Outdoor Humidity Sensor Alarm (29)...........................................................................166
Return Humidity Sensor Alarm (30) .............................................................................166
IAQ (CO2) Sensor Alarm (31) ........................................................................................166
Time Clock Error Alarm (32)..........................................................................................166
Space Temperature Offset Alarm (33)..........................................................................166
CV/VAV Input Alarm (34)................................................................................................166
Low Voltage Alarm (35)..................................................................................................166
Smoke Purge Mode Alarm (36) .....................................................................................166
High Duct Static Pressure Alarm (37) ..........................................................................166
Supply Air Temperature Cooling Alarm (38)................................................................167
Supply Air Temperature Heating Alarm (39)................................................................167
Economizer Minimum Position Alarm (40) ..................................................................167
Space Temperature Trending Alarm (41) .....................................................................167
Duct Static Low Pressure Alarm (42) ...........................................................................167
Hot Water Coil Freeze Alarm (43) .................................................................................167
JOHNSON CONTROLS
10
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
LIST OF TABLES
TABLE 2-1 – VOLTAGE LIMITATIONS .............................................................................................17
TABLE 2-2 – UNIT WEIGHTS - 050-061 MODELS...........................................................................20
TABLE 2-3 – UNIT CENTER OF GRAVITY.......................................................................................20
TABLE 2-4 – UNIT CORNER WEIGHTS - 050-061 MODELS..........................................................21
TABLE 2-5 – PHYSICAL DATA – 050-061 MODELS .......................................................................23
TABLE 2-6 – PHYSICAL DATA - COMPRESSORS..........................................................................24
TABLE 2-7 – COMPRESSOR DATA - R410A...................................................................................29
TABLE 2-8 – POWER SUPPLY VOLTAGE LIMITS ..........................................................................29
TABLE 2-9 – SUPPLY AND EXHAUST FAN MOTOR DATA - ODP.................................................30
TABLE 2-10 – SUPPLY AND EXHAUST FAN MOTOR DATA - TEFC .............................................30
TABLE 2-11 – CONDENSER FAN MOTOR RLA - STANDARD FAN...............................................30
TABLE 2-12 – CONDENSER FAN MOTOR RLA - LOW SOUND FAN (FUTURE OPTION) ...........30
TABLE 2-13 – MISCELLANEOUS ELECTRICAL DATA ..................................................................30
TABLE 2-14 – ELECTRIC HEAT.......................................................................................................31
TABLE 2-15 – AIRFLOW AND ENTERING AIR/AMBIENT LIMITATIONS.......................................31
TABLE 2-16 – THREE PHASE POWER SUPPLY CONDUCTOR SIZE RANGE.............................41
TABLE 2-17 – SUPPLY AIR DUCT CONNECTION CONFIGURATIONS.........................................44
TABLE 2-18 – RETURN AIR DUCT CONNECTION CONFIGURATIONS........................................44
TABLE 2-19 – PIPE SIZES................................................................................................................45
TABLE 3-1 –R410-A PRESSURE / TEMPERATURE CHART.........................................................52
TABLE 3-2 – LOW FIRE / HIGH FIRE PRESSURES............................................................................54
TABLE 3-3 – GAS HEAT PERFORMANCE DATA............................................................................54
TABLE 4-1 – FAN BEARING – LUBRICATION INTERVALS ...........................................................55
TABLE 4-2 – SET SCREW TORQUE................................................................................................61
TABLE 5-1 – BINARY OUTPUTS......................................................................................................73
TABLE 5-2 – VFD JUMPERS............................................................................................................73
TABLE 5-3 – POTENTIOMETER SETTINGS....................................................................................73
TABLE 5-4 OPERATION DURING OFF CYCLE..............................................................................81
TABLE 5-5 COMPRESSOR ON WHEN SPACE INPUT SATISFIED................................................81
TABLE 5-6 HEAT STAGE ON WHEN SPACE INPUT SATISFIED..................................................82
TABLE 6-1 - PARAMETER POINTS LIST.......................................................................................101
TABLE 6-2 - SIMPLICITY ELITE DATA MAP .................................................................................130
TABLE 7-1 – DEFINITIONS.............................................................................................................141
TABLE 8-1 – TEMPERATURE SENSOR RESISTANCE ................................................................153
TABLE 8-2 – DUCT PRESSURE TRANSDUCER...........................................................................154
TABLE 8-3 – BUILDING PRESSURE TRANSDUCER OUTPUT ...................................................154
TABLE 8-4 – RETURN FAN PRESSURE TRANSDUCER OUTPUT..............................................154
TABLE 8-5 – PRESSURE TRANSDUCERS ...................................................................................155
TABLE 8-6 – HUMIDITY SENSOR OUTPUTS................................................................................155
TABLE 8-7 – CO2 SENSOR OUTPUT ............................................................................................156
TABLE 8-8 – WIRING DATA............................................................................................................157
TABLE 8-9 – ALARM CODE DESCRIPTIONS ...............................................................................161
JOHNSON CONTROLS
11
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
LIST OF FIGURES
FIG. 1-1 – PACKAGED ROOFTOP AIR CONDITIONING UNIT ......................................................13
FIG. 2-1 – UNIT CLEARANCES........................................................................................................18
FIG. 2-2 – LIFTING LUG LOCATIONS..............................................................................................19
FIG. 2-3 – UNIT RIGGING .................................................................................................................19
FIG. 2-4 – GENERAL ARRANGEMENT DRAWING .........................................................................25
FIG. 2-5 – GENERAL ARRANGEMENT DRAWING ........................................................................28
FIG. 2-6 – DRAIN TRAP SHOWING WATER LOCATION DURING DRAW THROUGH
OPERATION STAGES......................................................................................................32
FIG. 2-7 – TRAP DETAIL FOR DRAW THROUGH APPLICATION ..................................................32
FIG. 2-8 – FIELD CONTROL WIRING CONNECTIONS ...................................................................36
FIG. 2-9 – SINGLE-POINT POWER SUPPLY WIRING.....................................................................38
FIG. 2-10 – SINGLE-POINT POWER SUPPLY WIRING WITH NON-FUSED DISCONNECT .........39
FIG. 2-11 – DUAL-POINT POWER SUPPLY WIRING ......................................................................40
FIG. 2-12 – ATMOSPHERIC SENSOR PROBE ................................................................................43
FIG. 2-13 – TYPICAL GAS PIPING CONNECTION..........................................................................45
FIG. 2-14 – COMBUSTION VENT .....................................................................................................46
FIG. 3-1 – FAN HOLD DOWN BRACKETS.......................................................................................48
FIG. 3-2 – MANIFOLD GAS PRESSURE ADJUSTMENT ................................................................54
FIG. 4-1 – SHEAVE ALIGNMENT......................................................................................................56
FIG. 4-2 – FAN DATA PLATE - BELT TENSION...............................................................................57
FIG. 4-3 – BELT TENSIONING GAUGE............................................................................................57
FIG. 4-4 – EXAMPLE OF FC FAN SHAFT/WHEEL MARKING........................................................58
FIG. 4-5 – BEARING WITH SETSCREW TYPE LOCKING DEVICE................................................60
FIG. 4-6 – BEARING WITH ECCENTRIC CAM ................................................................................60
FIG. 4-7 – ECCENTRIC CAM LOCKING COLLAR BEARING INSTALLATION..............................61
FIG. 4-8 – SPLIT BEARING...............................................................................................................61
FIG. 5-1 – CONDENSER FAN VFD POTENTIOMETER SETTINGS................................................73
FIG. 6-1 – UNIT CONTROLLER INTERFACE...................................................................................99
FIG. 8-1 – CONNECTOR LOCATIONS ...........................................................................................157
JOHNSON CONTROLS
12
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
SECTION 1 – INTRODUCTION
1
LD13271
FIG. 1-1 – PACKAGED ROOFTOP AIR CONDITIONING UNIT
ECOLOGICAL AND ECONOMICAL DESIGN
Condensing Section
• High Efficiency eco2 rooftop units are optimized
for HFC-410A refrigerant. YORK provides the
FIRST standard product offering that meets the
latest ASHRAE 90.1 energy efficiency require-
ments.
• Scroll Compressors – Reliable, efficient,
trouble-free operation is the true measure of a
packaged rooftop’s value. That’s why YORK
eco2 Packaged Rooftop Air Conditioners use
established scroll-compressor technology to
deliver dependable, economical performance
in a wide range of applications. With the eco2
Packaged Rooftop, you get the latest generation
of compressor enhancements added to the scroll’s
inherent strengths. The simplicity of a hermetic
scroll compressor allows the use of fewer moving
parts to minimize breakdown.
• Cooling and Heating – Superior operating per-
formance provides lower operating costs. Smaller
steps of cooling capacity provide tighter control
of building environment and occupant comfort
while optimizing energy efficiency.
• Indoor Air Quality (IAQ) – Outside air econ-
omizers provide energy savings in free cooling
mode, and can provide a healthier and more
comfortable building environment by introducing
fresh outside air into the building as needed. In-
doorAir Quality (IAQ) requirements for building
ventilation and comfort are controlled through
the microprocessor control panel.
• Multiple Compressor Staging – Through the
use of the scroll compressor, the eco2 has the abil-
ity to stage it’s cooling by enabling and disabling
multiple single stage compressors on multiple
circuits. These compressors are manifolded to-
gether in two independent circuits.
• Compressor Circuiting – The eco2 is designed
so that only 2 scroll compressors are in tandem
within one refrigeration circuit. This means more
reliable compressors, and less equipment down
time. With multiple circuits, if a compressor
should ever fail on one circuit, the other circuit/s
will remain operational to work to maintain oc-
cupied loads. The eco2 system has 2 circuits in
the unit.
• Premium-Efficiency Motors – Premium-effi-
ciency motors are available for optimum energy
efficiency. All motors used on the eco2 packaged
rooftop air conditioner meet U.S. EPACT 1992
minimum requirements.
High-efficiency motors are standard. Motors are
available in ODP or TEFC construction.
JOHNSON CONTROLS
13
Introduction
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
Heating Section
• Compressor Sound Blankets – Optional factory
installed sound blankets can be installed to further
reduce compressor sound attenuation.
• Staged gas heat – The eco2 rooftop gas furnace
is an induced-draft gas furnace designed for
high efficiency and reliability. The furnace uses
an aluminized steel tubular heat exchanger and
operates at temperatures sufficient to prevent
acidic exhaust gases from condensing in the
heat exchanger at low fire rates, unlike drum and
tube style furnaces that generate condensation
formation. Up to three stages of heat are avail-
able.
• Replaceable core filter driers – The optional
replaceable core filter driers on the eco2 provides
a convenient means for maintaining and optimiz-
ing the units refrigeration system. Eliminating
additional field penetrations into the refrigerant
circuit, which could lead to potential problems,
reduce the worry of refrigerant circuit contamina-
tion.
• Low Ambient Operation – Head-pressure con-
trol is accomplished via a VFD motor controller
rather than an inefficient and noisy condenser fan
damper. By varying the speed of the condenser
fan, better control and quieter operation is ob-
tained during the colder months. Low ambient
controls are available on all systems offering
higher rooftop cooling capacity than competitive
units.
An optional stainless steel heat exchanger is also
available.
• Electric – The eco2 is also available with an
electrical heater that can range from 40kW up to
50kW. Depending on the size of the heat required,
the eco2 can have 3 steps of control helping to
provide tighter control of the supply and zone
conditioned air. With the utilization of this multi
step function, the eco2 can effectively reduce en-
ergy consumption by bringing on smaller stages
of heat while maintaining the maximum level of
comfort.
• Condenser Fan Motors – The condenser fan
motors used on the eco2 unit are Totally Enclosed
Air Over (TEAO) to provide maximum durability
through any season.
• Steam and Hot water – This option will be
• Condenser Coils – Are available in various
materials and coatings to suit almost any type of
application.Aluminum or copper fins, pre-coated
or post-coated fins are available. The coating is
applied using an epoxy coating on the aluminum
coil. Each coil option is beneficial when the unit
must operate under extreme conditions. The use
of an epoxy coated coil is recommended for units
installed in a corrosive environment.
available in the future.
• Hot Gas By-pass – Is standard on VAV units.
• Condenser Coil Protection – The eco2 is avail-
able with a wire mesh guard for optimum coil
protection.
JOHNSON CONTROLS
14
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
AIR MANAGEMENT
1
The control can also be connected to a computer
for greater access to programming and operating
information.
• DWDI Airfoil fans – High efficiency fans are
used to improve application flexibility, and ad-
dress sound and application concerns.
• Building pressure control – Exhaust fans and
barometric relief dampers are available to meet
building pressure control requirements. Select
the most appropriate option for a given appli-
cation.
• Communication -The controller is designed
to communicate using Modbus RTU protocol.
Through the addition of a ModLINC translator,
the unit can also communicate using BACnet
MS/TP protocol.
• Low sound options – Allow for application of
the eco2 unit in sound-sensitive applications
such as theaters and downtown areas. Contact
JOHNSON CONTROLS for more details on
site-specific requirements.
INDOOR AIR QUALITY
• Double Sloped Stainless Steel Drain Pan – The
eco2’s standard Stainless Steel drain pan meets
ASHRAE 62 requirements for condensate drain-
age to improve indoor air quality. Solid wall liners
encase insulation and prevent moisture damage.
Additional benefits include easy cleanability and
isolates insulation from conditioned airstream.
• Variable Frequency Drives – When a VAV unit
is ordered, the eco2 comes standard with variable
frequency drives (VFD’s). The VFD can optimize
a systems performance by modulating the supply
fan motor speed to reduce energy consumption
by as much as 40% while maximizing occupant
comfort.
• Double Wall Construction – Is the standard
construction of the eco2 and incorporates powder
coated pre-fabricated outer panels and corner post
for maximum exterior surface protection.
• Fan Spring Isolation – Two-inch spring isolation
is used to prevent vibration transmission from the
rooftop unit’s supply fan to the building.
CONTROLS
• Rooftop Controller - The unit is designed to
use the Simplicity Elite control. This control
has been used with the 25 to 40 ton Millennium
product for many years. The control is designed
to operate with conventional room control input.
This allows the same control to be used on instal-
lations requiring 25 to 60 tons of cooling.
The board is equipped with four program but-
tons and two character displays for use by the
technician. They allow for access to the most
important board functions, current operating
data, and current alarms as well as the last five
alarms in the history memory buffer. The buttons
and displays are also used to program the control
with the correct configuration and set points.
JOHNSON CONTROLS
15
Introduction
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
• Factory Shrinkwrap – All eco2 rooftop units
can be ordered from the factory with an optional
factory-fresh shrinkwrap packaging. This elimi-
nates the contractors worries about dirt and debris
clogging up condenser coils or moisture leaking
into the air handler on the units way to the job
site or rigging yard.
SERVICE AND INSTALLATION
• Access Doors – Full-sized access doors provide
easy access into the unit for routine maintenance
and inspection.
The unit can be purchased with a “Both Side
Access” option for additional accessibility.
• Service Valves – Oversized service valves to
provide isolation and quick reclamation and
charging of system refrigerant are available as
an option to minimize downtime and simplify
the service and repair task.
• Demand Ventilation Option – Can be incorpo-
rated into the unit to improve indoor air quality
and help manage indoor pollutants such as CO2
or other harmful airborne contaminates out of
the occupied spaces for maximum comfort and
safety. Activation of this sequence can easily be
accomplished using a CO2 sensor installed in the
conditioned space. CO2 sensors are typically
used with demand ventilation; however other
sensors may be applied to control indoor con-
taminants such as volatile organic compounds
(VOCs).
• Convenience Outlet – For maintenance tasks
requiring power tools, an optional 110V GFCI
power supply can power lights, drills or any other
power hand tool needed.
• Factory Run-Tested – Each unit is subjected
to a series of quality assurance checks as well
as an automated quality control process before
being run-tested. Fans and drives are balanced
at the factory during testing. The factory run-test
ensures safe proper operation when the unit is
installed, and reduces installation and commis-
sioning time.
• Smoke Purge – Is also available to evacuate
smoke due to fire from a room or zone.
• Filtration – The eco2 is configured for various
types of filtration to meet the different needs and
requirements of today's rooftop applications,
including 2-inch throwaway, pleated, carbon,
and cleanable filters and 12-inch high efficiency
rigid filters.
• Gas Heat Sections – Are factory and leaked
checked.
• Replaceable Core Filter Drier Option – Pro-
vides a means to remove moisture, dirt and debris
from the refrigeration circuit in the event it is
opened.
ELECTRICAL
• Single Point Power – The eco2 unit comes stan-
dard with single point power connections to make
installation quick and easy.
• Dual Point Power – Can be factory installed for
applications that require the mechanical heating
and cooling functions to be separated from the
air handling functions. This enables the unit to
be operated in an emergency condition while
minimizing power consumption.
• Unit-Mounted Disconnect – Is available as an
option to minimize time at installation of equip-
ment and to reduce necessary field installed
items.
JOHNSON CONTROLS
16
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
SECTION 2 – INSTALLATION
APPROVALS
Designed certified by CSA, ETL, CETL as follows:
If the VAV boxes in the conditioned
space have hydronic heating coils
installed, it is the responsibility of the
installing contractor to take appropri-
ate measures to protect the hydronic
coils against low unit supply air tem-
peratures that could result in the freeze
up and rupture of the coils.
1.For use as a forced air furnace with cooling unit
(gas heat models).
2.For outdoor installation only.
3.For installation on combustible material and may
be installed directly on combustible flooring or
Class A, Class B or Class C roof covering mate-
rials.
2
UNIT INSPECTION
4.For use with natural gas or LP.
Immediately upon receiving the unit, it should be
inspected for possible damage, which may have
occurred during transit. If damage is evident, it should
be noted in the carrier’s freight bill. A written request
for inspection by the carrier’s agent should be made at
once. See “Instruction” manual, Form 50.15-NM for
more information and details.
5.When used with LPpropane gas one of the follow-
ing conversion kits must be installed before the gas
heat section is fired:
375,000 BTU Input - 385-01866-001
750,000 BTU Input - 385-01866-002
1,125,000 BTU Input - 385-01866-003
To ensure warranty coverage, this
equipment must be commissioned and
serviced by an authorized JOHNSON
CONTROLS service mechanic or a
qualified service person experienced
in packaged rooftop installation.
Installation must comply with all ap-
plicable codes, particularly in regard
to electrical wiring and other safety
elements such as relief valves, HP
cut-out settings, design working pres-
sures, and ventilation requirements
consistent with the amount and type
of refrigerant charge.
Not suitable for use with conventional venting
systems.
LIMITATIONS
The installation of this unit must conform to local
building codes, or in the absence of local codes, with
ANSI 223.1 Natural Fuel Gas Code and /or CAN/CGA
B149 installation codes.
In U.S.A.:
1.National Electrical CodeANSI/NFPANo. 70 - Lat-
est Edition.
2.National Fuel Gas Code Z223.1 - Latest Edition.
3.Gas-Fired Central Furnace StandardANSI Z21.47
- Latest Edition.
4.Local gas utility requirements.
Lethal voltages exist within the control
panels. Before servicing, open and tag
all disconnect switches.
TABLE 2-1 – VOLTAGE LIMITATIONS
UNIT POWER
VOLTAGE VARIATIONS
SUPPLY
MIN. VOLTS
MAX. VOLTS
LOCATIONS AND CLEARANCES
575-3-60
480-3-60
230-3-60
200-3-60
518
415
207
187
632
506
253
228
GENERAL
The eco2 air conditioning units are designed for outdoor
installation. When selecting a site for installation, be
guided by the following conditions:
Refer to Table 2-15 for airflow and entering air/ambient
conditions limitations, and Table 2-1 for voltage
limitations.
• Unit must be installed on a level surface.
• For the outdoor location of the unit, select a place
having a minimum sun exposure and an adequate
supply of fresh air for the condenser.
JOHNSON CONTROLS
17
Installation
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
• Also avoid locations beneath windows or be-
tween structures.
• Optional condenser coil protection should be used
for seashore locations or other harsh environ-
ments.
away from sound sensitive areas such as conference
rooms, auditoriums and executive offices and any other
room that may have potential for tenant occupancy.
Possible locations could be above hallways, mechanical
or utility rooms.
• The unit should be installed on a roof that is structur-
ally strong enough to support the weight of the unit
with a minimum of deflection. It is recommended
that the unit(s) be installed not more than 15 feet
from a main support beam to provide proper
structural support and to minimize the transmis-
sion of sound and vibration. Ideally, the center of
gravity should be located over a structural support
or building column.
• Location of unit(s) should also be away from
building flue stacks or exhaust ventilators to
prevent possible reintroduction of contaminated
air through the outside air intakes.
Finally, service clearances should be maintained in
rooftop design to insure safe access to the unit. Unit
clearances are designed so that technicians have enough
space between units, building walls, and edges of
building to gain access safely. In cases where space is
limited, please call your local York representative for
additional information.
The clearances shown are to provide
adequate condenser airflow and ser-
vice access to inside the unit. Addi-
tional clearance should be considered
for component replacement such as
compressors, evaporator coils, and
supply or exhaust fans.
• Be sure the supporting structures will not obstruct
the duct, gas or wiring connections.
LOCATION
While it is a common practice to op-
erate the fan as soon as possible (air
movement during construction) on the
job site, the incomplete ductwork and
missing diffuser grilles will greatly
reduce air resistance and will allow
the fan to operate beyond design pa-
rameters. This practice may result in
water carry over and flooding of the
unit. Also, the supply fan motor may
overamp and become damaged.
Of the many factors that can effect the location of
equipment, some of the most important to consider are
Structural, Acoustical and Service clearances. Proper
attention should be made at the design stage to ensure
proper structural support. In cases where equipment is
being replaced, be aware of building design to insure
support is adequate for the application.
The next most important consideration in applying roof
top equipment is that of sound from the equipment.
Special care should be made to keep the roof top unit
LD13267
NOTES:
4. 8' service access recommended on one side.
5. Economizer and exhaust hoods, where applicable, are folded
inside unit for shipment.
1. 10' clearance minimal over the top of the condensing unit.
2. Only one adjacent wall can exceed unit height.
3. 12' clearance required to adjacent units.
6. Dim. is to outside of lifting lugs.
FIG. 2-1 – UNIT CLEARANCES
18
JOHNSON CONTROLS
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
RIGGING AND HANDLING
Proper rigging and handling of the equipment is
mandatory during unloading and setting it into position
to retain warranty status. All lifting lugs must be used
to prevent twisting and damage to the unit.
Care must be taken to keep the unit in the upright
position during rigging and to prevent damage to the
water-tight seams in the unit casing.Avoid unnecessary
jarring or rough handling.
2
Typical rigging using proper spreader bars and cables
is shown in Figure 2-3. See Figure 2-2 for number
and location of the lifting lugs by unit size. It is also
mandatory that an experienced and reliable rigger be
selected to handle unloading and final placement of
the equipment. The rigger must be advised that the unit
contains internal components and that it be handled in
an upright position. Care must be exercised to avoid
twisting the equipment structure.
00543vip
FIG. 2-3 – UNIT RIGGING
Unit weights are listed under Table 2-2 in this manual.
These weights must be referred to when selecting a crane
for rigging and figuring roof weight loads. Contact your
JOHNSON CONTROLS Sales Office if you have any
questions regarding unit weights.
ꢒ
ꢋꢉ
ꢌ
ꢏ
ꢐ
ꢚ
ꢔ
ꢆ
ꢙ
ꢋ
ꢑ
ꢓ
ꢎ
ꢍ
ꢁꢂꢃꢄꢅꢆꢇꢀꢗꢇꢕꢘꢃꢈ
LD13272
UNIT
LENGTH
INCHES
DIMENSION
5-6
UNIT SIZE
TONS
1-2
3-4
7-8
9-10
50 - 61 STD CABINET
339
16.91
79.21
147.93
207.81
315.04
FIG. 2-2 – LIFTING LUG LOCATIONS
JOHNSON CONTROLS
19
Installation
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
UNIT WEIGHTS
TABLE 2-2 – UNIT WEIGHTS - 050-061 MODELS
MODEL SIZE
050
051
060
061
BASIC UNIT*
7433
7433
7800
7819
ECONOMIZERS
NO OUTSIDE AIR
240
446
240
446
240
446
240
446
25% OUTSIDE AIR FIXED POSITION MAUAL
DAMPER
25% OUTSIDE AIR 2 POSITION ACTUATED
DAMPER
476
476
476
476
476
476
476
476
FULL MODULATION WITH MINIMUM POSITION
POWER EXHAUSTS
FAN, MOTOR, MODULATING DAMPER AND HOOD
FAN, MOTOR, VFD, BAROMETRIC DAMPER AND
HOOD
501
506
501
506
501
506
501
506
GAS HEAT
375 MBH
162
324
486
162
324
486
162
324
486
162
324
486
750 MBH
1125 MBH
OPTIONS
OPEN PERIMETER CURB
CONDENSER COIL WIRE GUARD
COPPER CONDENSER COILS (ADDITIONAL)
12” RIGID FILTERS (ADDITIONAL)
544
64
544
64
544
64
544
64
516
319
516
319
773
319
773
319
*UNIT INCLUDES FC FAN W/ 20 HP MOTOR, VFD AND 2” THROWAWAY FILTERS
Center of Gravity
B
A
C
Condenser
Coil End
92
Y
D
X
339
LD08298
TABLE 2-3 – UNIT CENTER OF GRAVITY
050
051
MODEL
X
Y
X
Y
BASIC UNIT
184.1
191.0
187.4
50.2
49.9
50.0
184.1
191.0
187.4
50.2
49.9
50.0
BASIC UNIT W/ ECON.
BASIC UNIT W/ ECON. & HEATING
BASIC UNIT W/ ECON. & HEATING & POWER
EXHAUST
194.9
49.5
194.9
49.5
060
061
MODEL
X
Y
X
Y
BASIC UNIT
179.8
186.7
183.5
49.9
49.7
49.8
179.6
186.5
183.2
50.0
49.7
49.8
BASIC UNIT W/ ECON.
BASIC UNIT W/ ECON. & HEATING
BASIC UNIT W/ ECON. & HEATING & POWER
EXHAUST
190.9
49.3
190.7
49.3
JOHNSON CONTROLS
20
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
UNIT WEIGHTS (CONTINUED)
TABLE 2-4 – UNIT CORNER WEIGHTS - 050-061 MODELS
050
051
MODEL
A
B
C
D
A
B
C
D
BASIC UNIT
1835
2039
2118
2366
2201
2417
2521
2751
1852
1873
2041
2034
1545
1580
1715
1750
1835
2039
2118
2366
2201
2417
2521
2751
1852
1873
2041
2034
1545
1580
1715
1750
BASIC UNIT W/ ECON.
BASIC UNIT W/ ECON. & HEATING
BASIC UNIT W/ ECON. & HEATING & POWER
EXHAUST
2
060
061
MODEL
A
B
C
D
A
B
C
D
BASIC UNIT
1894
2097
2177
2424
2244
2461
2565
2795
1986
2008
2175
2168
1676
1711
1846
1881
1893
2096
2176
2423
2250
2466
2570
2801
1997
2018
2185
2178
1680
1715
1850
1885
BASIC UNIT W/ ECON.
BASIC UNIT W/ ECON. & HEATING
BASIC UNIT W/ ECON. & HEATING & POWER
EXHAUST
Unit Placement
• Elevated – Elevated roof curbs or dunnage steel
can be used to support the unit in order to raise it
to specific heights. When this type of placement
is required, be sure to keep unit access in mind.
Cat walks or other forms of unit access may be
required to one or both sides of the unit, depend-
ing on your area of the country and the local codes
that are enforced. Please check with local officials
to ensure the application conforms to local codes
and regulations.
• Ground Level Locations – It is important that
the units be installed on a substantial base that
will not settle, causing strain on the refrigerant
lines and sheet metal and resulting in possible
leaks. A one piece concrete slab with footers
extended below the frost line is highly recom-
mended.Additionally, the slab should be isolated
from the main building foundation to prevent
noise and vibration transmission to the building
structure.
For ground level installations, precautions should
be taken to protect the unit from tampering by, or
injury to, unauthorized persons. Erecting a fence
around the unit is common practice.
JOHNSON CONTROLS
21
Installation
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
ROOF CURB INSTALLATION
YORK offers an optional roof curb designed specifically
for the eco2 foot print. This curb comes as an open
condenser model and is shipped disassembled and
requires field assembly during installation. Refer to
the Installation Manual that is shipped with the roof
curb for specific instructions. For bottom supply and
return openings, the curb has matching connections to
ease installation.
The curb should be located according to the location
recommendations above, and properly sealed to prevent
moisture and air leakage into and out of the duct system.
Flexible collars should be used when connecting the
duct work to prevent unit noise transmission and
vibration into the building. The roof curb drawings
contained in the Johnson Controls literature are not
intended as construction documents for field fabrication
of a roof curb. Johnson Controls will not be responsible
for the unit fit up, leak integrity, or sound level with
field fabricated roof curbs.
Construction documents for field fabricated roof curbs
are available upon request.
Wood or fiber cant strips, roofing
felts, roofing material, caulking and
curb-to-roof fasteners are to be field
supplied.
JOHNSON CONTROLS
22
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
PHYSICAL DATA
TABLE 2-5 – PHYSICAL DATA – 050-061 MODELS
UNIT SIZE
050
051
060
061
GENERAL DATA
LENGTH WITHOUT HOOD (INCHES)
WIDTH (INCHES)
339
92
339
92
339
92
339
92
HEIGHT (INCHES)
UNIT EER/ IPLV
82
82
82
82
10.3 / 10.9
10.2 / 10.6
10.1 / 10.4
10.1 / 10.3
UNIT EER/ IPV GAS HEAT
COMPRESSOR DATA (SEE TABLE 2-6)
QUANTITY
2
4
SCROLL
4
4
SCROLL
4
4
SCROLL
4
4
SCROLL
4
TYPE
UNIT CAPACITY STEPS
REFRIGERANT (410A)
SYSTEM 1
50 lbs - 0 oz
50 lbs - 0 oz
50 lbs - 0 oz
50 lbs - 0 oz
58 lbs - 11 oz
58 lbs - 11 oz
58 lbs - 11 oz
58 lbs - 11 ozs
SYSTEM 2
SUPPLY FAN
QUANTITY
TYPE
1
FC
1
FC
1
FC
1
FC
SIZE
28 - 28
28 - 28
28 - 28
28 - 28
MOTOR SIZE RANGE (HP)
AIR FLOW RANGE (CFM) COOLING MIN.
STATIC PRESSURE RANGE (TOTAL)
OPTIONAL SUPPLY FAN
QUANTITY
10 - 40
10,000 - 22,500
1.0” - 6.0”
10 - 40
10,000 - 22,500
1.0” - 6.0”
10 - 40
12,500 - 24,000
1.0” - 6.0”
10 - 40
10,000 - 24,000
1.0” - 6.0”
1
AF
1
AF
1
AF
1
AF
TYPE
SIZE
28
28
28
28
MOTOR SIZE RANGE (HP)
AIR FLOW RANGE (CFM) COOLING MIN.
STATIC PRESSURE RANGE (TOTAL)
EXHAUST FAN
10 - 40
10,000 - 22,500
1.0” - 8.0”
10 - 40
10,000 - 22,500
1.0” - 8.0”
10 - 40
10,000 - 24,000
1.0” - 8.0”
10 - 40
10,000 - 24,000
1.0” - 8.0”
QUANTITY FANS/MOTORS
TYPE
2 / 1
FC
2 / 1
FC
2 / 1
FC
2 / 1
FC
SIZE
18 - 18
18 - 18
18 - 18
18 - 18
MOTOR SIZE RANGE (HP)
AIR FLOW RANGE (CFM)
STATIC PRESSURE RANGE (TOTAL)
EVAPORATOR COIL
SIZE (SQUARE FEET)
ROWS/FPI
5 - 20
4,000 - 22,500
0.1” - 1.5”
5 - 20
4,000 - 22,500
0.1” - 1.5”
5 - 20
4,000 - 24,000
0.1” - 1.5”
5 - 20
4,000 - 24,000
0.1” - 1.5”
52
3 / 17
52
3 / 17
52
4 / 17
52
4 / 17
CONDENSER COIL
SIZE (SQUARE FEET)
ROWS/FPI
88
2 / 17
88
2 / 17
88
3 / 17
88
3 / 17
CONDENSER FANS
QUANTITY
4
PROP.
36
4
PROP.
36
4
PROP.
36
4
PROP.
36
TYPE
DIAMETER (INCHES)
MOTOR HP
2
2
2
2
FILTERS - 2” THROWAWAY (PRE-FILTER POSITION)
QUANTITY
8 / 12
25X16 / 25X20
61.6
8 / 12
25X16 / 25X20
61.6
8 / 12
25X16 / 25X20
61.6
8 / 12
25X16 / 25X20
61.6
SIZE (LENGTH X WIDTH) (IN.)
TOTAL FILTER FACE AREA (SQUARE FEET)
FILTERS - 2” CLEANABLE (PRE-FILTER POSITION)
QUANTITY
8 / 12
25X16 / 25X20
63.9
8 / 12
25X16 / 25X20
63.9
8 / 12
25X16 / 25X20
63.9
8 / 12
25X16 / 25X20
63.9
SIZE (LENGTH X WIDTH) (IN.)
TOTAL FILTER FACE AREA (SQUARE FEET)
JOHNSON CONTROLS
23
Installation
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
PHYSICAL DATA (CONTINUED)
TABLE 2-5 – PHYSICAL DATA - 050-061 MODELS (CONTINUED)
UNIT SIZE
FILTERS - 2” PLEATED, 30% EFFICIENT (PRE-FILTER POSITION)
QUANTITY
050
051
060
061
8 / 12
8 / 12
25X16 / 25X20
63.9
8 / 12
25X16 / 25X20
63.9
8 / 12
25X16 / 25X20
63.9
SIZE (LENGTH X WIDTH) (IN.)
25X16 / 25X20
63.9
TOTAL FILTER FACE AREA (SQUARE FEET)
FILTERS -12” RIGID 65%, 2” 30% PREFILTER (PRE-FILTER POSITION)
QUANTITY
1 / 4 / 9
16X20/25X16/
25X20
1 / 4 / 9
16X20/25X16/
25X20
1 / 4 / 9
16X20/25X16/
25X20
1 / 4 / 9
16X20/25X16/
25X20
SIZE (LENGTH X WIDTH) (IN.)
TOTAL FILTER FACE AREA (SQUARE FEET)
43.0
43.0
43.0
43.0
FILTERS -12” RIGID 95%, 2” 30% PREFILTER (PRE-FILTER POSITION)
QUANTITY
1 / 4 / 9
16X20/25X16/
25X20
1 / 4 / 9
16X20/25X16/
25X20
1 / 4 / 9
16X20/25X16/
25X20
1 / 4 / 9
16X20/25X16/
25X20
SIZE (LENGTH X WIDTH) (IN.)
TOTAL FILTER FACE AREA (SQUARE FEET)
44.6
44.6
44.6
44.6
FILTERS - 2” CARBON (PRE-FILTER POSITION)
QUANTITY
8 / 12
25X16 / 25X20
63.9
8 / 12
25X16 / 25X20
63.9
8 / 12
25X16 / 25X20
63.9
8 / 12
25X16 / 25X20
63.9
SIZE (LENGTH X WIDTH) (IN.)
TOTAL FILTER FACE AREA (SQUARE FEET)
FILTERS - 12” RIGID 95% IN POST-FILTER POSITION
QUANTITY
1 / 3 / 9
16X20/25X16/
25X20
1 / 3 / 9
16X20/25X16/
25X20
1 / 3 / 9
16X20/25X16/
25X20
1 / 3 / 9
16X20/25X16/
25X20
SIZE (LENGTH X WIDTH) (IN.)
TOTAL FILTER FACE AREA (SQUARE FEET)
41.8
41.8
41.8
41.8
GAS FURNACES
375 MBH / 300 MBH / 1 STEP
750 MBH / 600 MBH / 2 STEPS
1125 MBH / 900 MBH / 3 STEPS
STAGED FURNACE SIZES (INPUT/OUTPUT/STEPS)
GAS PRESSURE RANGE
375 MBH
4.5-13.5" WC
7,500
4.5-13.5" WC
7,500
4.5-13.5" WC
11,500
4.5-13.5" WC
11,500
AIRFLOW RANGE
750 MBH
14,000
21,000
40.0 °F
0.0 °F
14,000
21,000
40.0 °F
0.0 °F
14,000
21,000
40.0 °F
0.0 °F
14,000
21,000
40.0 °F
0.0 °F
(MIN HEATING)
1125 MBH
MINIMUM OA TEMP FOR MECH. CIG.
LOW AMBIENT OPTION MIN. OA TEMP
TABLE 2-6 – PHYSICAL DATA - COMPRESSORS
COMPRESSORS UTILIZED
COMPRESSOR NOMINAL TONS
SYSTEM 1 SYSTEM 2
“COMPR “COMPR “COMPR “COMPR “COMPR “COMPR “COMPR “COMPR “STAGE “STAGE “STAGE “STAGE
CAPACITY %
SYSTEM 1
SYSTEM 2
# 1”
# 2”
# 3”
# 4”
# 1”
# 2”
# 3”
# 4”
1”
2”
3”
4”
050
051
060
061
ZP137
ZP137
ZP182
ZP182
ZP120
ZP137
ZP137
ZP137
ZP137
ZP137
ZP182
ZP182
ZP120
ZP137
ZP137
ZP154
13.58
13.58
17.95
17.95
12.53
13.58
13.30
13.30
13.58
13.58
17.95
17.60
12.53
13.58
13.30
14.86
26.0
25.0
28.7
28.2
52.0
50.0
57.4
55.8
76.0
75.0
78.7
76.7
100.0
100.0
100.0
100.0
MODEL
JOHNSON CONTROLS
24
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
GENERAL ARRANGEMENT DRAWING – 050-061 MODELS
BOTTOM SUPPLY / BOTTOM RETURN
2
O A
O A
LD08295
FIG. 2-4 – GENERAL ARRANGEMENT DRAWING
JOHNSON CONTROLS
25
Installation
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
GENERAL ARRANGEMENT DRAWINGS (CONTINUED)
BOTTOM SUPPLY / SIDE RETURN
O A
O A
FIG. 2-4 – GENERAL ARRANGEMENT DRAWING (CONT.)
26
LD08370
JOHNSON CONTROLS
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
GENERAL ARRANGEMENT DRAWINGS (CONTINUED)
BOTTOM SUPPLY / REAR RETURN
2
O A
O A
LD08296
FIG. 2-4 – GENERAL ARRANGEMENT DRAWING (CONT.)
JOHNSON CONTROLS
27
Installation
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
CURB LAYOUT DRAWING / 050-061 MODELS
333.69
41.19
66.08
35.10
21.00
66.19
84.50
71.83
1.75
TYP
229.56
14.00
LD08297
NOTES:
1. Unit must be installed square and level.
2. Curb configuration for “bottom” return and “bottom” supply.
3, These drawings are not intended as construction documents for the field fabricated roof curbs. Johnson Controls will not be responsible for
the unit fit up, leak integrity, or sound level for installation using field fabricated roof curbs.
4. The YPAL unit does not have a base pan under the condensing section of the unit. Field fabricated roof curbs must have a cap on the top of
the condensing section of the curb to prevent moisture from entering the space. The cap design must be sloped away from the supply duct
opening to the end of the unit for the drainage of the moisture off of the top of the cap.
FIG. 2-5 – GENERAL ARRANGEMENT DRAWING
JOHNSON CONTROLS
28
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
ELECTRICAL DATA
ELECTRICAL SERVICE SIZING
In order to use the electrical service required for
the cooling only eco2 rooftop, use the appropriate
calculations listed below from U.L. 1995. Based on the
configuration of the rooftop, the calculations will yield
different MCA (minimum circuit ampacity), and MOP
(maximum overcurrent protection).
Using the following load definitions and calculations,
determine the correct electrical sizing for your unit. All
concurrent load conditions must be considered in the
calculations, and you must use the highest value for any
combination of loads.
• LOAD3 is the current of the electric heaters
– zero for cooling only units.
• LOAD4 is the sum of any remaining currents
greater than or equal to 1.0 amp.
Use the following calculations to determine MCA
and MOP for units supplied with a single-point power
connection:
MCA = (1.25 x LOAD1) + LOAD2 + LOAD3 + LOAD4
MOP = (2.25 x LOAD1) + LOAD2 + LOAD3 + LOAD4
If the MOP does not equal a standard current rating
of an overcurrent protective device, then the marked
maximum rating is to be the next lower standard rating.
However, if the device selected for MOP is less than the
MCA, then select the lowest standard maximum fuse
size greater than or equal to the MCA.
2
Load Definitions:
• LOAD1 is the current of the largest motor – com-
pressor or fan motor.
• LOAD2 is the sum of the remaining motor cur-
rents that may run concurrently with LOAD1.
TABLE 2-7 – COMPRESSOR DATA - R410A
NOMINAL VOLTAGE
MODEL
MODEL
208-230/3/60
RLA*
460/3/60
575/3/60
LRA
239
245
239
245
245
245
245
245
245
340
245
340
300
340
245
340
RLA*
17.9
18.6
17.9
18.6
18.6
18.6
18.6
18.6
18.6
26.9
18.6
26.9
22.4
25.0
18.6
25.0
LRA
125
125
125
125
125
125
125
125
125
172
125
172
150
172
125
172
RLA*
12.8
14.7
12.8
14.7
14.7
14.7
14.7
14.7
14.7
23.7
14.7
23.7
19.8
23.7
14.7
23.7
LRA
80
1A
1B
2A
2B
1A
1B
2A
2B
1A
1B
2A
2B
1A
1B
2A
2B
ZP120
ZP137
ZP121
ZP137
ZP137
ZP137
ZP137
ZP137
ZP137
ZP182
ZP137
ZP182
ZP154
ZP182
ZP137
ZP182
33.3
48.0
33.3
48.0
48.0
48.0
48.0
48.0
48.0
55.7
48.0
55.7
51.3
55.7
48.0
55.7
100
80
050
100
100
100
100
100
100
132
100
132
109
132
100
132
051
060
061
TABLE 2-8 – POWER SUPPLY VOLTAGE LIMITS
POWER SUPPLY
208/230V/3PH/60HZ
460V/3PH/60HZ
MINIMUM VOLTAGE
MAXIMUM VOLTAGE
187
414
518
253
506
632
575V/3PH/60HZ
JOHNSON CONTROLS
29
Installation
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
ELECTRIC DATA (CONTINUED)
TABLE 2-9 – SUPPLY AND EXHAUST FAN MOTOR DATA - ODP
HIGH EFFICIENCY
PREMIUM EFFICIENCY
NOMINAL VOLTAGE
NOMINAL VOLTAGE
MOTOR
HP
MOTOR
HP
208/3/60
FLA
14.0
21.7
28.2
41.0
53.0
66.0
84.0
106.0
230/3/60
FLA
13.8
20.0
26.0
38.0
48.0
62.0
72.0
98.0
380/3/60
FLA
8.3
13.3
17.5
24.5
32.0
39.0
46.0
59.0
460/3/60
FLA
6.9
10.0
13.0
19.0
24.0
31.0
36.0
49.0
575/3/60
FLA
5.3
208/3/60
FLA
13.8
20.0
26.0
37.4
49.4
63.3
74.1
97.5
230/3/60
FLA
13.2
19.4
25.0
35.4
47.0
60.0
70.0
92.0
460/3/60
FLA
6.6
575/3/60
FLA
5.2
5
5
7.5
10
15
20
25
30
40
8.2
7.5
10
15
20
25
30
40
9.7
7.4
11.0
16.2
19.8
23.8
29.0
38.8
12.5
17.7
23.5
30.0
35.0
46.0
10.3
14.1
18.9
24.2
28.0
37.4
TABLE 2-10 – SUPPLY AND EXHAUST FAN MOTOR DATA - TEFC
HIGH EFFICIENCY
PREMIUM EFFICIENCY
NOMINAL VOLTAGE
NOMINAL VOLTAGE
MOTOR
HP
MOTOR
208/3/60
FLA
15.4
21.2
27.5
40.0
54.0
64.0
78.0
101.0
230/3/60
FLA
14.2
19.6
25.6
37.0
50.0
60.0
72.0
94.0
380/3/60
FLA
8.1
460/3/60
FLA
7.1
575/3/60
FLA
5.4
208/3/60
FLA
13.6
21.0
26.0
38.9
51.0
63.3
77.0
99.0
230/3/60
FLA
13.0
18.8
25.0
37.0
48.0
60.0
72.0
92.0
460/3/60
FLA
6.5
575/3/60
FLA
5.2
HP
5
5
7.5
10
15
20
25
30
40
12.0
16.8
23.8
30.0
39.0
46.0
57.0
9.8
8.2
7.5
10
15
20
25
30
40
9.4
8.0
12.8
18.5
25.0
30.0
36.0
47.0
11.4
15.3
19.1
25.0
29.6
38.0
12.5
18.5
24.0
30.0
36.0
46.0
10.0
14.8
19.0
23.9
29.0
36.8
TABLE 2-11 – CONDENSER FAN MOTOR RLA - STANDARD FAN
208V/3PH/60HZ
230V/3PH/60HZ
460V/3PH/60HZ
3.1
575V/3PH/60HZ
2.5
RLA EACH MOTOR
7.3
6.2
QUANTITY OF
MODEL
208V/3PH/60HZ
230V/3PH/60HZ
460V/3PH/60HZ
575V/3PH/60HZ
FANS
50-61 TONS
4
29.2
24.8
12.4
10.0
TABLE 2-12 – CONDENSER FAN MOTOR RLA - LOW SOUND FAN (FUTURE OPTION)
208V/3PH/60HZ
230V/3PH/60HZ
460V/3PH/60HZ
575V/3PH/60HZ
2.5
RLA EACH MOTOR
7.3
6.2
3.1
QUANTITY OF
MODEL
208V/3PH/60HZ
230V/3PH/60HZ
460V/3PH/60HZ
575V/3PH/60HZ
FANS
50-61 TONS
4
32.4
27.6
13.6
12.0
TABLE 2-13 – MISCELLANEOUS ELECTRICAL DATA
NOMINAL VOLTAGE
DESCRIPTION
208 / 230V
AMPS
2.4
460V
AMPS
1.1
575V
AMPS
0.9
380V-60
AMPS
2
CONTRL X’FMR. 500 VA
CONVENIENCE OUTLET
GAS HEAT
9.6
4.4
3.5
N/A
9.6
4.4
3.5
5.3
JOHNSON CONTROLS
30
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
ELECTRIC DATA (CONTINUED)
TABLE 2-14 – ELECTRIC HEAT
NOMINAL VOLTAGE
KW
208/3/60
AMPS
230/3/60
AMPS
460/3/60
AMPS
575/3/60
AMPS
2
40
80
96
193
260
—
96
193
260
—
48
96
40
80
108
150
130
181
109
151
TABLE 2-15 – AIRFLOW AND ENTERING AIR/AMBIENT LIMITATIONS
Limitations
Model Size
51 60
10000 - 10000 - 12500 - 12500 -
50
61
Minimum
Airflow at
22500
22500
24000
24000
Standard Design
Conditions.
CFM*
(min to max)
Entering Wet
Bulb Temp F°
(min/max)
57/75
68/90
57/75
68/90
50/120
0/120
57/75
68/90
50/120
0/120
57/75
68/90
50/120
0/120
Entering Dry
Bulb Temp F°
(min/max)
Ambient Temp F° 50/120
without Low
Amb option
Ambient Temp F°
with Low Amb
option
0/120
* Cooling Only Units
JOHNSON CONTROLS
31
Installation
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
FILTERS
into the supply duct and/or causing water damage in
the building. A trap must be installed to prevent this
condensate water build-up (see Figures 2-6 & 2-7).
Two-inch “throwaway” filters are standard and factory
installed in a filter rack located prior to the evaporator
coil. Any optional pre-filters ordered with the unit will
be shipped inside the unit, but must be field installed.
The unit can also be ordered with an extended cabinet
and 95% efficient post-filters. These post-filters are
installed at the factory.
Under high latent load conditions condensate may
form in the base and side rails of the unit. The unit is
designed to contain this moisture and prevent it from
leaking into the conditioned space. In order to dispose
of this condensate, two condensate drain connections
are located on the side rails on each side of the unit
and in the base rail on the return end of the unit. There
are five (5) condensate drains on the unit. Since these
connections are also under negative pressure, they must
be trapped using the same design criteria as the main
drain pan.
Pre-filters must always be installed ahead of the
evaporator coil. Post and pre-filters must be kept clean
and replaced with the same size and type as shipped with
the unit. Dirty filters will reduce the capacity of the unit
and may result in frosted coils and safety shutdowns.
Required filter sizes and quantities are shown in Table
2-6. The unit should never be operated for any length
of time without the proper filters installed in the unit.
"H" must be at least
1 inch plus fan total
static pressure
BASE
RAILS
TRAP
DRAIN
NIPPLE
NO.1 - FAN OFF
BASE
RAILS
"X" = 1/2 "H"
NO. 2 - TRAP CONDITION WHEN FAN STARTS
LD05370-1
BASE
RAILS
FIG. 2-7 – TRAP DETAIL FOR DRAW THROUGH
APPLICATION
COOLING COIL
DRAIN PAN
Condensate Drain Trap
NO. 3 - FAN RUNNING AND CONDENSATE
LD13269
For “Draw-through” applications install a trapped
condensate drain line at unit drain connection (see
Figure 2-7 according to all governing codes. “H”
dimension must be at least 1 inch greater than design
Total Static Pressure (TSP) of fan.
FIG. 2-6 – DRAIN TRAP SHOWING WATER
LOCATION DURING DRAW THROUGH
OPERATION STAGES
CONDENSATE DRAIN
The trap and drain lines should be protected from
freezing. Plumbing must conform to local codes. Use
a sealing compound on male pipe threads. Install
condensate drain lines from the 1-1/4 inch NPT female
connections on the unit to an open drain.
Condensate Drain Piping
The eco 2 cooling coils are located in the units so that
the supply air is drawn through them. This results in
the condensate being subjected to negative (-) static
pressure. Unless some means of pressure equalization is
provided in the condensate drains, the air rushing back
through the drainpipe will cause the condensate to build
up in the base rails.As the unit continues to operate, the
accumulated water will be carried with the air stream,
overfilling the base rails causing possible water leaks
The unit must be properly trapped and
charged with water before the units
are started.
JOHNSON CONTROLS
32
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
AIR HOODS FOR ECONOMIZER
There are two (2) economizer outside air intake hoods
provided with the unit. The front and rear hoods are
made operational per the following instructions:
The thermostat should be mounted on an inside wall
approximately 56” above the floor where it will not be
subject to drafts, sun exposure or heat from electrical
fixtures or appliances.
• Remove the screws holding the economizer hood
shipping covers in place. Discard covers.
• Apply a bead of RTV sealer along the edge of
both hoods and each pivot joint to prevent water
leakage.
• Rotate the hoods out (each hood is hinged).
Secure the hoods with screws along the top and
sides.
Note that 24 VAC terminal (R) on terminal block P1
of the Simplicity control board must be used as the 24
VAC source for the input to the thermostat. Use of any
power source external to the controller will result in
damage to the Unit Controller.
2
Fan input
• Seal any unused screw holes with RTV or by
replacing the screw.
By closing a contact between terminal (R) and (G) on
terminal block P1 on the Simplicity control board the
supply fan can be turned on. This function is typically
used on CV units and is included with most room
thermostats.
AIR HOODS FOR FIXED OUTSIDE AIR
(UNITS WITHOUT ECONOMIZER)
The hoods must be installed per the above instructions.
The dampers may be adjusted by loosening the thumb
screw, turning the lever to the desired position, and
retightening the thumb screw.
Note that 24 VAC terminal (R) on terminal block P1
of the Simplicity control board must be used as the 24
VAC source for the input to (G). Use of any power
source external to the controller will result in damage
to the Unit Controller.
AIR HOODS FOR EXHAUST AIR
Space Sensor
No hoods are required for the exhaust air outlet.
A space sensor can be used in lieu of a thermostat as
the primary means of control on a CV unit. The space
sensor is connected to terminals (ST) and (GND) of
terminal block P8 on the Simplicity control board.
FIELD WIRING
Figure 2-8 shows the field wiring to the Simplicity
control board. All field control wiring is field supplied
and installed.
A space sensor with a 20,000 potentiometer can be
used to reset the space temperature set point. The
space temperature reset is connected to terminals (SSO)
and (GND) of terminal P8 on the Simplicity control
board.
Thermostat
Athermostat (4 stage cool and 3 stage heat) can be used
on CV and VAV units. On CV units the thermostat is
the primary means of control for the unit. The three
thermostat heating inputs connect to the P2 terminal
block on the Simplicity control board to terminals W1,
W2, andW3. The four thermostat cooling inputs connect
to the P2 and P3 terminal block on the Simplicity control
board to terminals Y1, Y2, Y3, and Y4.
When mounting a space sensor, it should be located on
an inside wall approximately 56” above the floor where
it will not be subject to drafts, sun exposure, or heat
from electrical fixtures or appliances.
Shielded wire must be used that is
grounded at the control panel only.
JOHNSON CONTROLS
33
Installation
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
CO2 Sensor
Smoke Purge Input
The addition of a field installed CO2 sensor is required
for Demand Ventilation operation. The default input
span for the control is 0 to 2,000 ppm with an output
voltage range of 0 to 10 VDC. The field will need to
supply an external power supply for the sensor. This is in
addition to the two wires connect to the unit. The sensor
connects to terminals (DV+) and (DV-) of terminal
block P20 on the Simplicity control board. The wiring
to the sensor should be a twisted shield pair grounded
on one end.
A contact closure input (PURGE) is provided to place
the unit in smoke purge mode. When the contact is
closed the unit will operate as follows:
• Turn off all heating and cooling operation
• Set the outdoor air damper output to 100%
• Close the return to 0%
• Turn the supply fan on
• On VAV units set the supply fan output to
100%
• Turn the power exhaust fan on
• On VFD driven exhaust fans set the exhaust fan
output to 100%
Occupied / Unoccupied Input
A contact closure input to terminal (OCC) of the P1
terminal block on the Simplicity control board is
provided for hard-wiring an external device such as a
central time clock, a thermostat with scheduling, or a
manual switch to switch the unit from Unoccupied to
Occupied mode.
Note that 24 volts terminal (R) on the Simplicity
control board must be used as the 24 VoltAC source for
switch the contact to the Unit Controller Smoke Purge
(PURGE) input. Use of any power source external to the
controller will result in damage to the Unit Controller.
Closed Circuit – Occupied
Open Circuit – Unoccupied
BAS Economizer Input
The Simplicity control board has the capability to
control the economizer damper through a 2 – 10 Volt
DC input. Refer to BAS Economizer Input information
contained in Section 5 of the manual for additional
information on the programming and operation of this
feature.
Note that 24 VAC terminal (R) on terminal block P1
of the Simplicity control board must be used as the 24
VAC source for the input to (OCC). Use of any power
source external to the controller will result in damage
to the Unit Controller.
Shutdown Input
The 2 to 10 VDC input connects to terminals (BAS
ECON +) and (BAS ECON –) at terminal block P3 of
the Simplicity control board
A jumper is installed between terminal “R” and “SD1”
on the Simplicity control board. To install a hard-wired
shutdown circuit, remove the jumper between the two
terminals and connect a switch between the terminals.
The switch must be closed for operation and open for
shutdown. Opening the switch removes the 24 VAC
power to the Unit Controller.
Fault Output
The Simplicity control board has the capability out
sending a positive half wave 24 VAC output whenever
an alarm is present. It is capable of driving a 25 ma load.
This is design to connect to a fault light on a commercial
thermostat. This output originates at terminal (X) at
terminal block P1 on the Simplicity control board.
Closed Circuit – Normal Operation
Open Circuit – Shutdown
Note that 24 VAC terminal (R) on terminal block P1
of the Simplicity control board must be used as the 24
VAC source for the input to (SD). Use of any power
source external to the controller will result in damage
to the Unit Controller.
JOHNSON CONTROLS
34
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
COMMUNICATION
VAV Heat Relay Output
The Simplicity Unit Controller is designed to
communicate using Modbus Client protocol. Through
the use of a ModLINC translator the unit can also
communicate using BACnet MS/TP protocol.
This is a 24 VDC output that is turned on when the
unit is in the heating mode. The field can use this as
a signal to trigger the opening of the VAV boxes for
heating operation. This feature uses two ¼ inch male
tabs identified as (VAV OPEN +) and (VAV OPEN -)
on the Simplicity control board.
2
Through the use of a FREEnet Serial or USB adapter
the Simplicity Unit Controller can be connected directly
to a computer. Multiple units can be daisy chained
together and through the use of the adapter connected to
a computer or a network. This allows remote monitoring
of the unit as well as the ability to change settings and
options from a remote location.
Supply Air Temperature Reset
An external 0 to 10 VDC input can be applied to
terminals (REM+) and (REM-) at terminal block P19
on the Simplicity control board to reset the supply air
temperature set point for VAV operation. The units
follows interprets the voltage input as follows:
Connection to the unit is done through either of two
RS-485 connections. The P4 terminal block has screw
connections with terminal A being the – and terminal
B being the +. The P5 connecter is designed to allow
the mating connector from the FREEnet Serial or USB
adapter to be plugged in.
Below 1.0 VDC – the blower is de-energized
Below 1.5 VDC – the cooling and heating is
disabled
At 2.0 VDC – the control uses the lower set
point
See Table 6-1 for parameter points list.
Between 2.0 VDC and 10 VDC the change in set
point is proportional to the change in voltage.
DIRTY FILTER SWITCH
At 10.0 VDC – the control uses the upper set
point
On units with a dirty filter switch option, an adjustable
differential pressure switch is installed to monitor the
pressure drop across the filters. When the pressure
drop across the filters exceeds the setting of the switch,
the switch closes sending a 24-volt signal to the Unit
Controller. The Unit Controller posts a warning in
the service memory buffer; but will not shut down the
unit.
JOHNSON CONTROLS
35
Installation
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
FIELD CONTROL WIRING CONNECTIONS
Wiring Notes:
1. Wiring shown indicates typical wiring. Refer to the IOM manual for more detailed wiring methods and options.
2. All wiring is Class 2, low voltage.
3. Maximum power available from the 24 VAVC terminal is 40 VA.
4. Use shielded wire where shown.
10 WIRE THERMOSTAT
C (Common)
R (24 VAC)
C
R
FAULT
LIGHT
(Optional)
X
G
G (Fan)
W1 (Heating Stage 1)
W2 (Heating Stage 2)
W3 (Heating Stage 3)
Y1 (Cool Stage 1)
W1
W2
W3
Y1
Y2
Y2 (Cool Stage 2)
Y3 (Cool Stage 3)
Y3
Y4 (Cool Stage 4)
Y4
SPACE SENSOR
RESET
20K ADJUST
POTENTIOMETER
COM SET
SPACE
SENSOR
10K TYPE III
THERMISTOR
SUPPLY AIR
TEMP RESET
0-10 VDC
Use Shielded
Wire
GND
CO2 SENSOR
(Field Supplied)
0-2000 PPM
(Field Supplied)
SSO
COM
TMP
DV+
REM -
Use
Shielded
Wire
0-10 VDC OUTPUT
Shutdown
Use Shielded Wire
ST
REM +
DV-
R
SD1
R
OCC
VAV HEAT RELAY
PURGE
VAV OPEN +
24 VDC
RELAY
(Field Supplied)
BAS ECONOMIZER
INPUT
BAS ECON +
VAV OPEN -
0-10 VDC
(Field Supplied)
BAS ECON -
Use shielded wire
LD13002
FIG. 2-8 – FIELD CONTROL WIRING CONNECTIONS
36
JOHNSON CONTROLS
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
POWER WIRING
POWER WIRING
The following calculations apply to electrical data for
the rooftop unit. All concurrent load conditions must
be considered in the calculations, and you must use the
highest value for any combination of loads.
Field wiring to the unit must conform to provisions
of National Electrical Code (NEC) ANSI / NFPA 70-
Latest Edition and / or local ordinances. The unit must
be electrically grounded in accordance with the NEC
and / or local codes. Voltage tolerances, which must be
maintained during starting and running conditions, are
indicated on the unit data plate.
2
Minimum CircuitAmpacity (MCA) is based on 125%
of the rated load amps for the largest motor plus 100%
of the rated load amps for all other loads included in the
circuit, per N.E.C. Article 440-34.
The internal wiring harnesses furnished with this unit
are an integral part of the design certified unit. Field
alteration to comply with electrical codes should not
be required. If any of the wire supplied with the unit
must be replaced, replacement wire must be of the type
shown on the wiring diagram and the same minimum
gauge as the replaced wire.
The minimum recommended disconnect switch is based
on 115% of the rated load amps for all loads included
in the circuit, per N.E.C.
Maximum overcurrent protection is based upon 225%
of the rated load amps for the largest motor plus 100%
of the rated load amps for all other loads included in
the circuit, per N.E.C. Article 440-22. If the maximum
overcurrent protection does not equal a standard current
rating of an overcurrent protective device, then the
marked maximum rating is to be the next lower standard
rating. However, if the device selected for maximum
overcurrent protection is less than the MCA, then select
the lowest standard maximum fuse size greater than or
equal to the MCA.
Power supply to the unit must be NEC Class 1 and must
comply with all applicable codes. A disconnect switch
must be provided (factory option available). The switch
must be separate from all other circuits. Wire entry at
knockout openings requires conduit fittings to comply
with NEC and/or Local Codes.
Refer to Figures 2-9, 2-10 & 2-11 for typical field wiring
andtotheappropriateunitwiringdiagrammountedinside
control doors for control circuit and power wiring
information.
Figures 2-9, 2-10 & 2-11 show the power wiring that
must be field supplied and installed. See Table 2-16 for
the allowable conductor wire size for the electrical lugs
in the unit.
ELECTRICAL SERVICE SIZING
Electrical service required for the cooling only eco2
rooftop, use the appropriate calculations listed below
from U.L. 1995. Based on the operating mode and
configuration of the rooftop, the calculations will
yield different MCA (minimum circuit ampacity), and
MOP (maximum overcurrent protection). MCA and
Overcurrent Protection Device Data is supplied on
the unit data plate. Also refer to Table 2-7, 2-9, 2-10,
2-11, 2-12, 2-13 and 2-14, Electrical Data.
For dual point power connections, TB1 in the power
panel supplies the all unit compressors and condenser
fans. TB2 in the power panel supplies power to the unit
supply, return and exhaust fans, and control circuitry.
All wiring must conform to the Na-
tional Electrical Code (NEC) and
local codes that may be in addition to
NEC.
JOHNSON CONTROLS
37
Installation
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
SINGLE-POINT POWER SUPPLY WIRING
1L1 1L2
1L3
Line 1
Line 2
Line 3
LD13003
Field Power
Supply
Earth
Ground
NOTES:
1. All field wiring must be provided through a field-supplied fused disconnect switch to the unit terminals (or optional molded
disconnect switch).
2. All electrical wiring must be made in accordance with all N.E.C. and/or local code requirements.
3. Minimum Circuit Ampacity (MCA) is based on U.L. Standard 1995, Section 36.14 (N.E.C. Section 440-34).
4. Maximum Dual Element Fuse size is based on U.L. Standard 1995, Section 36.15 (N.E.C. Section 440-22).
5. Use copper conductors only.
FIG. 2-9 – SINGLE-POINT POWER SUPPLY WIRING
JOHNSON CONTROLS
38
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
SINGLE-POINT POWER SUPPLY WIRING
WITH NON-FUSED DISCONNECT SWITCH
2
LD13004
Line 1
Line 2
Line 3
Field Power
Supply
Earth
Ground
NOTES:
1. All field wiring must be provided through a field-supplied fused disconnect switch to the unit terminals (or optional molded
disconnect switch).
2. All electrical wiring must be made in accordance with all N.E.C. and/or local code requirements.
3. Minimum Circuit Ampacity (MCA) is based on U.L. Standard 1995, Section 36.14 (N.E.C. Section 440-34).
4. Maximum Dual Element Fuse size is based on U.L. Standard 1995, Section 36.15 (N.E.C. Section 440-22).
5. Use copper conductors only.
6. On units with an optional disconnect switch, the supplied disconnect switch is a “Disconnecting Means” as defined in the N.E.C. Section 100,
and is intended for isolating the unit from the available power supply to perform maintenance and troubleshooting. This disconnect switch is
not intended to be a Load Break Device.
FIG. 2-10 – SINGLE-POINT POWER SUPPLY WIRING WITH NON-FUSED DISCONNECT
JOHNSON CONTROLS
39
Installation
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
DUAL-POINT POWER SUPPLY WIRING
GND
Line 1
Line 2
Line 3
Field Power
Supply #2
Earth
Ground
LD13005
Line 1
Line 2
Line 3
Field Power
Supply #1
Earth
Ground
NOTES:
1. All field wiring must be provided through a field-supplied fused disconnect switch to the unit terminals (or optional molded
disconnect switch).
2. All electrical wiring must be made in accordance with all N.E.C. and/or local code requirements.
3. Minimum Circuit Ampacity (MCA) is based on U.L. Standard 1995, Section 36.14 (N.E.C. Section 440.34).
4. Maximum Dual Element Fuse size is based on U.L. Standard 1995, Section 36.15 (N.E.C. Section 440.22).
5. Use copper conductors only.
FIG. 2-11 – DUAL-POINT POWER SUPPLY WIRING
JOHNSON CONTROLS
40
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
CONTROLS
2
TABLE 2-16 – THREE PHASE POWER SUPPLY CONDUCTOR SIZE RANGE
050-061 Models
Supply
Voltage
Single Point
TB
Single Point
Disconnect
Dual Point TB
TB 1
TB 2
208V
230V
(2*) 250 kcmil-500 kcmil
(2*) 250 kcmil-500 kcmil
6 AWG-400 kcmil
(2*) 2 AWG-500 kcmil
(2*) 2 AWG-500 kcmil
6 AWG-350 kcmil
6 AWG-350 kcmil
6 AWG-350 kcmil
6 AWG-400 kcmil
6 AWG-400 kcmil
14 AWG-2/0
6 AWG-350 kcmil
6 AWG-350 kcmil
14 AWG-2/0
380V-60
460V
6 AWG-400 kcmil
14 AWG-2/0
14 AWG-2/0
575V
6 AWG-400 kcmil
14 AWG-2/0
14 AWG-2/0
JOHNSON CONTROLS
41
Installation
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
TRANSDUCER PNEUMATIC TUBING
Static Pressure Control Plastic Tubing
(Pneumatic Tubing)
Duct static transducers (all VAV units) and any unit with
an optional building pressure control transducer, require
pneumatic tubing to be field supplied and installed.
Both the duct static transducer (VAV only) and optional
building pressure transducer are mounted behind the
right hand damper door. All wiring from the transducers
is factory installed.
If the unit is equipped with both a building pressure
transducer and a duct static transducer, a “tee” will
be factory installed, and both the Duct Static Pressure
Transducer and building pressure will be connected to
the “tee” - both building static pressure transducer and
duct static transducer will use the same factory supplied
atmospheric pressure probe.
Duct Static Transducer
The “low” side connection of the
duct static or building pressure trans-
ducers are shipped with the pneumatic
tubing factory installed and routed, to
the external factory pressure tap.
Plastic tubing (3/16" ID) must be run from the high
pressure tap of the transducer to a static pressure tap
(field supplied) in the supply duct, located at a point
where constant pressure is desired. This is normally
2/3rds of the way down the duct, before the first take
off.
Building Pressure Transducer
Plastic tubing (3/16” ID) must be run from the high
pressure tap of the building static pressure transducer
to a static pressure tap (field supplied), located in the
conditioned space. The tap should be placed in a
location where over pressurization will cause a problem,
for example, in the lobby area where excessive pressure
will cause the doors to remain open. The tap should
never be placed above the ceiling.
Static Pressure Probe Installation
On units with duct static transducers (VAV units) and
any unit with an optional building pressure, a factory
supplied Static Pressure Probe must be field installed at
the top of the rear corner post on the unit - see Figure.
2-12.
The factory supplied atmospheric pressure probe and
associated mounting hardware are shipped inside the
unit control panel. The hardware consists of a mounting
bracket and a short section of pneumatic tubing. The
pneumatic tubing must be field installed from a factory
pressure tap (next to the mounting location for the
static pressure probe) to the atmospheric pressure
probe (see Installation Instructions, Form XXX.XX-
XX).
JOHNSON CONTROLS
42
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
2
Filter
Comparttmmeenntt
EEccoonnoommiizzer
CCoommppaarrtment
LD13127
FIG. 2-12 – ATMOSPHERIC SENSOR PROBE
The atmospheric probe should be mounted on the support post on the control side
of the unit between the Economizer and the Filter compartment.
JOHNSON CONTROLS
43
Installation
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
DUCT SYSTEM
Installation of elbows, discharge
damper and other abrupt flow area
changes installed directly at the fan
outlet will cause system losses. These
losses must be taken into account
during the design phase and must be
added to any field measurements.
Duct Connection Guidelines
All intake and discharge air duct connection to the
unit may be made directly to the unit. These air duct
connections should be on flexible material and should
be installed so they are sufficiently loose. Duct runs
and transitions must be made carefully to hold friction
loss to a minimum. Avoid short turns, and duct elbows
should contain splitters or turning vanes.
SOUND AND VIBRATION TRANSMISSION
All roof mounted air handling units generate some
sound and vibration, which may or may not require
some special treatment of the air conditioned space. The
noise generated by the air handling unit is dependent
on the speed of the fan, the amount of air the fan is
moving, the fan type and the static efficiency of the fan.
In applications where sound and vibration transmissions
may be objectionable, good acoustical engineering
practices must be incorporated in the system design.
Duct work connected to the fan discharge should run in a
straight line for at least two equivalent outlet diameters.
Never deadhead the discharge into the flat surface of
a plenum.
Refer to Table 2-17 and 2-18 for available supply and
return duct connection configuration.
TABLE 2-17 – SUPPLY AIR DUCT CONNECTION
CONFIGURATIONS
The eco2 unit is designed for lower sound levels than
competitive units by using flexible fan connections,
fan spring isolators, double-wall construction, multiple
fan options, and lower speed and horsepower fans. For
VAV applications, VFDs are used instead of inlet guide
vanes. Additional sound attenuation can be obtained
using compressor sound blankets and field-supplied
sound attenuators when necessary.
SUPPLY AIR
UNIT CONFIGURATION
BOTTOM LEFT RIGHT
COOLING ONLY
√
√
√
√
√
COOL/GAS HEAT 375-750
MBH
√
N/A
N/A
50-61 TONS
COOL/GAS HEAT 1125 MBH
N/A
TABLE 2-18 – RETURN AIR DUCT CONNECTION
CONFIGURATIONS
Even with these equipment design features, the
acoustical characteristics of the entire installation must
never be overlooked.Additional steps for the acoustical
characteristics of a rooftop installation should be
addressed during the design phase of a project to avoid
costly alterations after the installation of the equipment.
During the design phase of a project, the designing
engineer should consider, at a minimum, the impact of
the equipment location, rooftop installation, building
structure, and duct work.
SUPPLY AIR
UNIT CONFIGURATION
BOTTOM LEFT RIGHT
NO EXHAUST
√
√
√
BAROMETRIC RELIEF
DAMPER
√
√
N/A
50-61 TONS
POWERED EXHAUST FAN
RETURN FAN
√
√
√
N/A
N/A
N/A
Discharge
RIGHT
Return
FRONT
FRONT
LEFT
BOTTOM
NOTE:
This diagram is provided as a visual reference of the eco2 discharge & return air openings & locations for all sizes. Please refer to Fig 2-4 for exact
size & location of panels and openings.
LD08045
JOHNSON CONTROLS
44
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
GAS HEATING
GAS PIPING
UNIT BASERAIL
FACTORY
PIPING
Proper sizing of the gas piping depends on the cubic feet
per hour of gas flow required, specific gravity of the gas
and the length of run. National Fuel Gas Code Z223.1
– latest Edition should be followed in all cases unless
superseded by local codes or gas company requirements.
Refer to Table 2-19.
UNION (For Servicing)
1/8" NPT PLUG
MANUAL GAS
VALVE
1-1/2" FPT
ROOF
CURB
PITCH POCKET
2
DRIP LEG
The heating value of the gas may differ with locality.
The value should be checked with the local gas utility.
LD11765A
ROOF
FIG. 2-13 – TYPICAL GAS PIPING CONNECTION
TABLE 2-19 – PIPE SIZES
NOMINAL IRON PIPE SIZE
LENGTH IN
Gas Piping Recommendations
1-1/2 IN.1
2 IN.1
3,050
2,100
1,650
1,450
1,270
1,150
1,050
990
FEET
10
20
30
40
50
60
70
80
1,600
1,100
890
1. A drip leg and a ground joint union must be in-
stalled in the gas piping.
2. When required by local codes, a manual shut-off
valve will have to be installed outside of the unit.
3. Use wrought iron or steel pipe for all gas lines. Pipe
dope should be applied sparingly to male threads
only.
760
1
Maximum capacity of pipe in cubic feet of gas per
Natural gas may contain some pro-
pane. Propane being an excellent
solvent will quickly dissolve white
lead or most standard commercial
compounds. Therefore, a special pipe
dope must be applied when wrought
iron or steel pipe is used. Shellac
base components such as Gaskolac
or Stalastic, and compounds such as
Rectorseal #5, Clyde’s or John Crane
may be used.
hour (based upon a pressure drop of 0.3 inch water
column and 0.6 specific gravity gas).
There may be a local gas utility re-
quirement specifying a minimum
diameter for gas piping. All units re-
quire a 1-1/2-inch pipe connection at
the entrance fitting. Line size should
not be sized smaller then the entrance
fitting size.
GAS CONNECTION
4. All piping should be cleaned of dirt and scale by
hammering on the outside of the pipe and blow-
ing out the loose particles. Before initial start-up,
be sure that all of the gas lines external to the unit
have been purged of air.
5. The gas supply should be a separate line and in-
stalled in accordance with all safety codes as pre-
scribed under “Limitations” listed in the beginning
of this section. After the gas connections have been
completed, open the main shutoff valve admitting
gas pressure to the mains. Check all joints for
leaks with soap solution or other material suitable
for the purpose. NEVER USE A FLAME!
The gas supply line should be routed within the space
and penetrate the roof at the gas inlet connection of
the unit. The gas piping can enter the unit through an
opening in the base of the gas heat section. Many local
codes require that a shut off valve be located external to
the unit. In these cases it is easier to run the gas piping
on the roof and enter the unit through the side of the
base rail. Typical supply piping arrangements are shown
in Figure 2-13.
JOHNSON CONTROLS
45
Installation
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
6. The furnace and its individual manual shut-off
valve must be disconnected from the gas supply
piping system during any pressure testing of that
system at test pressures in excess of 0.5 PSIG.
Disconnect gas piping from unit when
leak testing at pressures greater than
0.5 PSIG. Pressures greater than 0.5
PSIG will cause gas valve damage
resulting in a hazardous condition.
If gas valve is subjected to pressure
greater than 0.5 PSIG, it must be
replaced.
7. A 1/8 inch N.P.T plugged tapping, accessible for
test gage connection, must be installed immedi-
ately upstream of the gas supply connection to the
furnace.
COMBUSTION VENT
The combustion vent assembly is shipped in the return
air section of the unit. The combustion vent assembly
must be mounted over the flue gas outlet fixed panel
located to the right of the gas heat access door. Install
as follows:
1. Remove the combustion vent assembly from the
return compartment.
2. Remove the vertical row of six screws on either
side of the flue gas outlet fixed panel.
3. Mount the combustion vent assembly over the flue
gas outlets and attach to the gas outlet fixed panel
using the screws removed in step 2.
4. See Figure 2-14 for the proper orientation of the
combustion vent. The internal baffle(s) must direct
the flue gases upward.
LD11766
FIG. 2-14 – COMBUSTION VENT
JOHNSON CONTROLS
46
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
SECTION 3 – START-UP
CHECKING THE SYSTEM PRIOR TO INITIAL START
(NO POWER)
To protect warranty, this equipment
must be installed and serviced by an
authorized JOHNSON CONTROLS
service mechanic or a qualified service
person experienced in air handling
and condenser unit installation.
Installation must comply with all ap-
plicable codes, particularly in regard
to electrical wiring and other safety
elements such as relief valves, HP
cut-out settings, design working pres-
sures and ventilation requirements
consistent with the amount and type
of refrigerant charge.
Unit Checks
1.Inspect the unit for shipping or installation dam-
age.
2.Visually check for refrigerant piping leaks.
3.The compressor oil level should be maintained so
that an oil level is visible in the sight glass. The
oil level can only be tested when the compressor is
running in stabilized conditions, guaranteeing that
there is no liquid refrigerant in the lower shell of the
compressor. In this case, the oil must be between
1/4 and 3/4 in the sight glass. At shutdown, the oil
level can fall to the bottom limit of the oil sight
glass.
3
Lethal voltages exist within the Con-
trol Panel. Before servicing, open and
tag all disconnect switches.
4.Check the control panel to assure it is free of for-
eign material (wires, metal chips, etc.).
5.Visually inspect field wiring (power and control).
Wiring MUST meet N.E.C. and local codes.
6.Check tightness of terminal lugs inside the power
panel on both sides of the contactors, overloads,
fuses, and power connections.
Reference publication Form 100.50-
SU1 (507) “Quick Startup Guide” for
additional information.
CRANKCASE HEATERS
7.Verify fuse sizing in main circuits.
8.Verify field wiring for thermostat (if applicable),
optional zone sensor, etc.
9.Verify all applicable pneumatic tubing has been
field installed for Duct Static Pressure Transducers
(VAV units), optional building pressure transducer
for power exhaust option, and outdoor static pres-
sure prove.
With power applied to the rooftop unit, the crankcase
heater for each compressor will be ON whenever the
compressor is not running. The heater is interlocked into
the compressor motor contactor and is not controlled
by the microprocessor.
The purpose of the crankcase heater is to prevent
the migration of refrigerant to the crankcase during
shutdown, assuring proper lubrication of the compressor
on start-up.
10. Supply exhaust and return fan isolators spring bolts
are removed (refer to Figure 3-1).
11. Verify proper bearing and locking collar torque
values on supply and exhaust fans (refer to Main-
tenance section of manual).
12. Verify proper drive alignment of supply and ex-
haust fans (refer to Maintenance section of man-
ual).
Anytime power is removed from the unit for more than
an hour, the crankcase heater should be left on for 24
hours prior to start.
Power must be applied to the rooftop
unit 24 hours prior to starting the unit
compressors. Failure to observe this
requirement can lead to compressor
damage and voiding of the compressor
warranty.
JOHNSON CONTROLS
47
Startup
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
13. Verify proper belt tension of supply fan, exhaust
fan or return fan (refer to Maintenance section of
manual). Belts must be checked after 24 hours of
initial operation.
The supply, exhaust and return fans
have tie down bolts are installed at the
factory to prevent movement in the fan
assemblies during shipment. THESE
HOLD DOWN BOLTS MUST BE
REMOVEDPRIORTOOPERATION
OF THE ABOVE FANS. There are
eight bolts per assembly two at each
comer of the fan skids, front and rear.
The bolt locations are shown in Figure
3-1. The bolt heads are red in color
and a label identifies their location in
the unit.
14. Manually rotate condenser fan blades, supply
exhaust and return blower wheels and motors, to
assure freedom of movement.
15. Verify proper condensate drain trap installation
(refer to Figure 2-6). Fill traps with water prior to
unit start-up.
16. If applicable, verify installation of air filters (refer
to Installation section for size and quantity).
Fan Hold
EXHAUST FAN ASSEMBLY
Brackets
LD13268
Fan Hold Down Brackets (4)
SUPPLY FAN ASSEMBLY
FIG. 3-1 – FAN HOLD DOWN BRACKETS
JOHNSON CONTROLS
48
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
17. Verify Variable Frequency Drive setpoints for VAV
unit Supply Fan and optional Variable Frequency
Drive Exhaust and/or Return Fan drives. The Sup-
ply Fan VFD is located to the right of the electrical
control box in the supply fan blower compartment.
Refer to separate manual for VFD operation sup-
plied with the unit.
18. If equipped, open suction line ball valve, discharge
line ball valve, and liquid line ball valve for each
refrigerant system.
The eco2 rooftop unit uses hermetic scroll compressors,
which only pump in one direction. Therefore, it is
necessary to verify proper rotation at unit start-up.
Operation of the compressor in the reverse direction
will not pump, and cause the compressor to cycle on
internal overload. Operating the compressor in reverse
for “extended” periods can result in failure of the
compressor.
To verify proper rotation, monitor the suction and
discharge pressures of the respective refrigerant
circuit when the compressor cycles on. If the discharge
pressure increases and suction pressure decreases as the
compressor cycles on, the compressor is properly phased
and operating in the correct rotation.
UNIT CHECKS – POWER APPLIED
1.Apply 3-phase power and verify its value. Volt-
age imbalance should be no more than 2% of the
average voltage.
2.Verify programmed units Setpoints (refer to “Quick
Compressor Oil Level Check
3
Start-Up Guide”, Form 100.50-SU3).
The oil level can only be tested when the compressor is
running in stabilized conditions, to ensure that there is
no liquid refrigerant in the lower shell of the compressor.
When the compressor is running in stabilized conditions,
the oil level must be between 1/2 and 3/4 in the oil sight
glass. Note: at shutdown, the oil level can fall to the
bottom limit of the oil sight glass.
3.Verify correct fan rotation – fan should rotate in
direction of arrow on fan housing.
4.Insure proper compressor rotation - see following
instruction on Verifying Compressor Rotation.
Verifying Compressor Rotation
This unit uses scroll compressors,
which will only operate in one di-
rection. Failure to observe these steps
could lead to compressor failure.
JOHNSON CONTROLS
49
Startup
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
INITIAL START-UP
Checking Superheat and Subcooling
An R-410A temperature and pressure chart lists the
associated saturation temperature in one column, with
the associated pressure in another column. As a result,
only one temperature/pressure column is needed to show
the relationship.
After all of the preceding checks have been completed
and the control panel has been programmed as required,
the unit may be placed into operation.
1.Place the Unit Switch in the control panel to the
ON position.
2.With a demand, the supply fan will cycle on, and
permit compressor operation if the air proving
pressure switch for the supply fan has closed.
3.The first compressor will start. After several
minutes of operation, a flow of refrigerant will
be noted in the sight glass, the vapor in the sight
glass will clear, and there should be a solid column
of liquid visible in the sightglass when the TXV
stabilizes.
Subcooling (R-410A)
When the refrigerant charge is correct, there will be no
vapor in the liquid sight glass with the system operating
under full load conditions.
The subcooling temperature of each system can be
calculated by recording the temperature of the liquid
line at the outlet of the condenser and subtracting it
from the saturation temperature listed in Table 3-1, for
the corresponding discharge pressure. If the rooftop unit
does not have an access port for liquid access, subtract
the condenser coil pressure drop value from the table
on this page from the discharge pressure to determine
the equivalent saturation temperature.
4.Allow the compressor to run a short time, being
ready to stop it immediately if any unusual noise
or adverse conditions develop.
5.Check the system operating parameters by checking
evaporator superheat and condensing subcooling.
Connect a gauge manifold set to the Schrader ser-
vice valve connections on the liquid and common
suction line in the condensing section of the unit.
After the system is running and the pressures have
stabilized, measure the temperature at the liquid
and common suction lines near the Schrader ser-
vice valves. Calculate evaporator superheat and
condensing subcooling. The subcooling, should be
approximately 15.0 ˚F and the superheat should be
12.0 ˚F. Repeat the above process for each of the
refrigerant systems.
Example:
On a YPAL 050 the discharge pressure is 388 PSIG
and the
liquid temperature is 95 °F
Liquid Pressure = Discharge Pressure (388 PSIG)
- 33.0 PSIG
Saturation Temperature for 355 PSIG = 108°F
Minus the liquid line temp
Liquid Line Subcooling of
= 95°F
= 13°F
6.With an ammeter, verify that each phase of the con-
denser fans, compressors, supply fan, and exhaust
fan are within the RLA/FLA as listed on the unit
data plate.
The subcooling should be 15°F at design conditions.
Superheat (R-410A)
The superheat should be checked only after steady
state operation of the unit has been established, the
discharge air temperature has been pulled down to
within the control range, and the unit is running in a
fully loaded condition.
Refrigerant Charge
This rooftop unit comes fully charged from the factory
with refrigerant R-410A as standard.
CONDENSER COIL PRESSURE DROP
YPAL050
33 PSIG
YPAL051
39 PSIG
YPAL060
24 PSIG
YPAL061
27 PSIG
The superheat is calculated as the difference between the
actual temperature of the refrigerant gas in the suction
line and the temperature corresponding to the Suction
Pressure as shown in Table 3-1.
JOHNSON CONTROLS
50
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
Leak Checking
Example:
Leak check compressors, fittings and piping to assure
no leaks. Verify the evaporator distributor tubes do not
have bare copper touching each other or are against a
sheet metal edge. If you are leak checking a unit charged
with R-410A make sure the leak test device is capable
of sensing refrigerant R-410A.
The suction pressure is 130 PSIG and the
suction line temperature is 57 °F
Suction Line Temperature
= 57°F
Saturation Temperature for 130 PSIG = 45°F
Evaporator Superheat
= 12°F
When adjusting the expansion valve, the adjusting
screw should be turned not more than one turn at a time,
allowing sufficient time (approximately 15 minutes)
between adjustments for the system and the thermal
expansion valve to respond and stabilize.
If the unit is functioning satisfactorily during the
initial operating period, no safeties trip and the unit
controls are functioning properly, the rooftop unit is
ready to be placed into operation.
The superheat setting should be adjusted to 12°F at
design conditions.
3
JOHNSON CONTROLS
51
Startup
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
TABLE 3-1 –R410-A PRESSURE / TEMPERATURE CHART
PSIG
0
TEMP ˚F
-60
-58
-54
-50
-46
-42
-39
-36
-33
-30
-28
-26
-24
-20
-18
-16
-14
-12
-10
-8
PSIG
78
TEMP ˚F
20
21
24
26
29
32
34
36
39
41
43
45
47
49
51
53
57
60
64
67
70
73
76
78
80
83
85
88
90
92
95
97
101
108
112
118
134
149
159
2
80
4
85
6
90
8
95
10
12
14
16
18
20
22
24
26
28
30
32
34
36
38
40
42
44
46
48
50
52
54
56
58
60
62
64
66
68
70
72
74
76
100
105
110
115
120
125
130
135
140
145
150
160
170
180
190
200
210
220
225
235
245
255
265
275
285
295
305
325
355
375
405
500
600
700
-6
-4
-3
-2
0
1
3
4
6
7
8
10
11
13
14
15
16
17
19
JOHNSON CONTROLS
52
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
GAS HEAT MODELS
Pre-Start Checks:
• When starting up these units, it is imperative
that ALL gas fittings within the unit (in addition
to the field installed gas connections) are leak
checked with a soap solution as part of the unit
commissioning process. The heat section must
be fired when checking the joints on the manifold
side of the gas valve. If any leaks are detected,
the leaks must be repaired immediately and all
joints rechecked.
• The heat section has two roll out switches mount-
ed above the burners. The purpose of the roll
out switch is to protect the gas heat section from
flame roll out, flame burning outside the heat
exchanger. A restriction in the heat exchanger
or breach in the flue passages could result in a
roll out situation. The roll out switch is a manual
reset device.
• The unit has two high temperature limit switches.
One located at the heat exchanger vestibule panel
and the other located in the area of the heat ex-
changer return bend. These limits are automatic
reset devices. If the limit opens the ignition
control will de-energize the gas valve. On staged
gas heat, as soon as the limit closes the ignition
control will reinitiate the ignition sequence. If the
limit opens on a modulating gas heat section the
Unit Controller will lockout the heat section.
• Verify wiring inside the burner compartment to
insure the wiring/terminals are tight and securely
connected to the components, such as the ignition
control, flame sensor, gas valve, rollout switches
and igniter.
3
• The gas heat start up sequence begins with a 30
second prepurge. The next step in the sequence
is the closure of the air proving switch. The heat
section has a combustion air-proving switch.
This switch must close before the ignition se-
quence can initiate. If the air-proving switch is
closed after the 30 second prepurge the ignition
control will energize the spark igniter and open
the gas valve.
• The control circuit is tested in the factory to insure
that all of these steps are followed, however, natu-
ral gas is not actually introduced to the system in
the plant; nitrogen is used in its place.
Post Start Checks:
• The furnace ignition control uses flame rectifi-
cation as verification of burner operation. The
minimum allowable flame current for operation
is 0.7 dc microamps.
When a signal is received at the gas heat control mod-
ule from the Unit Controller, verify:
• Combustion blower starts and runs for 30 seconds
before the spark is initiated.
• Spark igniter sparks.
• Gas valve opens.
• Burners light from right to left, in a 2.5 second
time frame; that each one lights in sequential order
from right to left; and establishes stable flame im-
mediately upon ignition.
• If the furnace ignition control does not prove
flame in 7 seconds, it will turn off the spark signal
and close the gas valve. It will wait 30 seconds
and then initiate a second ignition sequence. If
flame is not proven during the second 7 second
trial for ignition the control will turn off the spark
signal, close the gas valve, wait 30 seconds and
initiate a third ignition sequence. If flame recti-
fication is not proven on the third try, the ignition
control will lock out.
• Check for gas leaks in the unit piping as well as
the supply piping.
• Check for correct manifold gas pressures. See
“Manifold Gas Pressure Adjustment” in this Sec-
tion.
JOHNSON CONTROLS
53
Startup
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
Manifold Gas Pressure Adjustment
• Check the supply pressure. It must be within the
limitations shown in Table 3-2. Supply pressure
should be checked with all gas appliances in the
building at full fire. At no time should the standby
gas pressure exceed 13.5" WC, nor the operating
pressure drop below 4.5" WC for natural gas or
11.0" WC for propane. If the gas pressure is out-
side these limits, contact the installing mechanical
contractor for corrective action.
• Small adjustments to the manifold gas pressure
can be made by following the procedure outlined
below. Refer to Figure 3-2 for the high and low
fire pressure regulator adjustment locations.
• Turn the gas off to the unit.
• Use a 3/16 inch Allen wrench to remove the 1/8
inch NPT plug from the outlet pressure tap of the
valve.
• The flame is stable, with flame present only at the
end of the burner, no burning is occurring inside
the burner. There should be little yellow tipping
of the flame.
• Install a brass adapter to allow the connection of
a hose to the outlet pressure tap of the valve.
• Connect the hose to a manometer capable of read-
ing the required manifold pressure value.
• There may be some smoke thru the flue, due to
tooling oil burning off of the heat exchanger tub-
ing.
• Turn the gas back on.
• Place the heat section into high fire operation.
• Compare the high fire manifold pressure to Table
TABLE 3-2 – LOW FIRE / HIGH FIRE PRESSURES
3-2.
LINE PRESSURE
MANIFOLD PRESSURE
LOW FIRE HIGH FIRE
+/- 0.3 “WC +/- 0.3 “WC
TYPE OF
GAS
• To adjust the high fire manifold pressure remove
the cap from the high fire pressure regulator. Use
a 3/32Allen wrench to make the manifold pressure
adjustment. To increase the manifold pressure,
turn the screw clockwise; to decrease the manifold
pressure, turn the screw counterclockwise. Place
your finger over the adjustment opening while
verifying the manifold pressure.
MINIMUM MAXIMUM
NATURAL
4.5 “WC
13.5 “WC
13.5 “WC
1.2 “WC
4.2 “WC
3.5 “WC
10.0”WC
PROPANE 11.0 “WC
HIGH FIRE PRESSURE
REGULATOR
• Place the heat section into low fire operation.
REGULATOR VENT COVER
• Compare the low fire manifold pressure to Table
3-2.
• To adjust the low fire manifold pressure remove
the cap from the low fire pressure regulator. Use
a 3/32 inch Allen wrench to make the manifold
pressure adjustment. To increase the manifold
pressure, turn the screw clockwise; to decrease
the manifold pressure, turn the screw counter-
clockwise. Place your finger over the adjustment
opening while verifying the manifold pressure.
LOW FIRE
PRESSURE
REGULATOR
TWO STAGE
PRESSURE
REGULATOR
• Turn the heat off.
INLET
LD11760a
• Turn the gas off.
FIG. 3-2 – MANIFOLD GAS PRESSURE
ADJUSTMENT
• Remove the brass tubing adapter and replace the
plug in the outlet pressure tap.
TABLE 3-3 – GAS HEAT PERFORMANCE DATA
GAS INPUT CAPACITY MAXIMUM OUTPUT CAPACITY
AIRFLOW
MIN.
7,500
14,000
21,000
TEMP. RISE
(°F)
UNIT
(BTU/HR X 1000)
(BTU/HR X 1000)
MAX.
24,000
24,000
24,000
375
750
300
600
900
40
40
40
50-61
1125
JOHNSON CONTROLS
54
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
SECTION 4 – MAINTENANCE
Oil Analysis: Use York Type “T” POE oil (clear) for
units charged with R-410A refrigerant. The type of
refrigerant and amount per system is listed on the unit
rating plate. A change in the oil color or odor may
be an indication of contaminates in the refrigeration
system. If this occurs, an oil sample should be taken
and analyzed. If contaminations are present, the system
must be cleaned to prevent compressor failure. This can
be accomplished through the installation of oversized
suction and liquid line driers. The driers may have to be
changed several times to clean up the system depending
on the degree of contamination.
Make sure power is removed from
the unit before performing the main-
tenance items contained in this sec-
tion.
GENERAL
Aplanned program of regularly scheduled maintenance
will return dividends by averting possible costly and
unexpected periods of down time. It is the responsibility
of the owner to provide the necessary maintenance
for the air handling units and coils. If a system failure
occurs due to improper maintenance during the warranty
period, JOHNSON CONTROLS will not be liable
for costs incurred to return the unit to satisfactory
operation.
Never use the scroll compressor
to pump the refrigerant system down
into a vacuum. Doing so will cause
internal arcing of the compressor
motor, which will result in failure of
compressor.
PERIODIC MAINTENANCE – MONTHLY
Fan Bearing Lubrication
4
Filters
Add grease slowly with shaft rotating until a slight
bead forms at the seals. If necessary, re-lubricate while
bearing is stationary. The fan data plate (attached to
the fan scroll) lists the type of grease that must be used
for lubricating the bearings. Refer to Table 4-1 for
lubricating schedule.
Check the cleanliness of the filters and replace or clean
as required.
Linkages
Examine the damper and operator linkages to insure
that each is free and operating smoothly.
Re-lubrication is generally accompanied by a temporary
rise in operating temperature. Excess grease will be
purged at seals.
Compressors
Oil Level Check: The oil level can only be tested when
the compressor is running in stabilized conditions, to
ensure that there is no liquid refrigerant in the lower
shell of the compressor. When the compressor is running
in stabilized conditions, the oil level must be between
1/4 and 3/4 in the oil sight glass. Note: at shutdown,
the oil level can fall to the bottom limit of the oil sight
glass.
Recommended Lubricant for Fan Bearings
A Lithium / Petroleum base grease conforming to an
NLGI Grade II consistency is normally used. Lubricant
must be free of any chemical impurities such as free
acid or free alkali, dust, rust, metal particles or abrasive.
This light viscosity, low torque grease is rust inhibited
and water resistant, has a temperature range of -30°F
to +200°F with intermittent highs of +250°F. Lubricate
bearings as required by the severity of required duty.
TABLE 4-1 – FAN BEARING – LUBRICATION INTERVALS
RELUBRICATION SCHEDULE (MONTHS) BALL BEARING PILLOW BLOCKS
SPEED (RPM)
500 1000 1500 2000 2500 3000 3500
4000
4500
SHAFT DIA
1/2” thru 1-11/16”
1-15/16” thru 2-7/16”
2-11/16” thru 2-15/16”
3-7/16” thru 3-15/16”
6
6
5
3
3
2
2
2
1
6
5
4
5
4
3
4
3
2
2
2
1
2
1
1
1/2
1/2
1/4
1/4
1/2
1/2
1/2
JOHNSON CONTROLS
55
Maintenance
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
PERIODIC MAINTENANCE – YEARLY
Condenser Coils
Dirt should not be allowed to accumulate on the
condenser coil surfaces. Cleaning should be as often
as necessary to keep coil clean.
Check the fan wheels and inspect the drain pan for
sludge and foreign material. Clean if required.
Observe the operation of all dampers and make any
necessary adjustments in linkage and blade orientation
for proper operation.
PERIODIC MAINTENANCE – THREE TO SIX MONTHS
Disconnect and lock-out power from
the unit anytime service is being per-
formed on the fan section. Failure to
do so could result in serious injury or
death due to the fan turning on while
work is in progress.
Entire Unit Inspection
In addition to the checks listed in this section, periodic
overall inspections of the unit should be accomplished
to ensure proper equipment operation. Items such as
loose hardware, component operation, refrigerant leaks,
unusual noises, etc. should be investigated and corrected
immediately.
Squealing belts during starting is
caused by slipping belts that are not
tensioned properly.
Sheave Alignment:
To check sheave alignment, a straight edge or a piece of
string can be used. If the sheaves are properly aligned,
the string or straight edge will touch at all points, as
indicated in Figure. 4-1. Rotating the sheaves will
determine if the sheave is wobbly or the drive shaft is
bent.Alignment error must be corrected to avoid bearing
and belt failure.
Motor Bearing Lubrication
Bearings must be re-lubricated periodically to assure
long life. Motor bearing should be lubricated yearly,
but may need lubrication more frequently, depending
on severe operating conditions.
CORD TIED
TO SHAFT
Belt Tension
Adjust the belt tension if necessary. Required belt
tension data is supplied on the fan “skid” data plate,
attached to the fan housing. Never use a belt dressing
on the belts. If belts slip with the proper tension, use a
good grade of belt cleanser to clean the belts. Refer to
Figures 4-1.
CORD TOUCHING SHEAVES AT
POINTS INDICATED BY ARROWS
LD07634
FIG. 4-1 – SHEAVE ALIGNMENT
Belts
Never use excessive belt tension,
as this could result in damaging
the bearing, motor pulleys or motor
base. See drive label on fan housing
adjacent to drive for specific details
on tension.
New belts should be re-checked after 24 hours of
operation. On multiple belt adjustable pulleys, the pitch
depth should be checked to insure identical belt travel,
power transfer and wear. Adjustable motor bases are
provided for belt adjustment.
Motor pulleys and blower shaft pulleys are locked
in position with either set screws or split taper lock
bushings. All set screws and/or taper lock bolts must
be checked for tightness and alignment before putting
equipment into operation.
When it is necessary to replace one belt in a given set,
the entire set of belts must be replaced.
JOHNSON CONTROLS
56
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
An incorrectly aligned and tensioned belt can
substantially shorten belt life or overload blower and
motor bearings, shortening their life expectancy. A belt
tensioned too tightly can overload the motor electrical,
causing nuisance tripping of the motor overloads and/or
motor failure and/or shaft failure.
Belt Replacement
Always replace belts as a set. Follow the steps below
to replace belts:
1.Release the tension on the belts by loosening the
adjusting nuts on the fan motor.
2.Remove old belts and recheck the sheave alignment
with a straight edge.
3.Install the new belts on the sheaves.
LD06354
FIG. 4-3 – BELT TENSIONING GAUGE
Belt Tensioning:
Never place the belts on the sheaves by using a
screwdriver to pry the belt over the rim of the sheave.
This will permanently damage the belts.
Belt tension information is included on the fan skid data
plate as shown in Figure. 4-2. Sample data plate shows
4.3 lbs pressure at .30 inches deflection.
A Browning Belt tension gauge is used in Figure. 4-3
to properly tension belts.
4
FIG. 4-2 – FAN DATA PLATE - BELT TENSION00494vip
JOHNSON CONTROLS
57
Maintenance
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
Filter Drier Replacement
The filter/drier should be replaced any time work is
performed on the refrigerant circuit. The rooftop unit
comes with sealed type (non-replaceable) cores as
standard. If the unit is not equipped with the optional
valve package (suction, discharge, & liquid line valves),
the refrigerant will need to be recovered with a recovery
machine to replace the filter/drier.
If the unit is equipped with a valve package, the unit
can be pumped down by closing the liquid line ball
valve (prior to the filter/drier) while the unit is running,
initiating a unit pump-down. The unit will shut off when
the mechanical low-pressure switch opens. When the
unit shuts down, close the ball valve located after the
filter/drier and remove power from the unit to prevent
the unit from running. Once the filter/drier core has been
replaced, the filter/drier section should be evacuated via
the Schrader access valve located next to the filter/drier
prior to opening the ball valves and restoring the unit
to normal operation.
LD06355
FIG. 4-4 – EXAMPLE OF FC FAN SHAFT/WHEEL
MARKING
4.Loosen and remove set screws on both bearing
locking collars. Inspect and, if necessary, re-
place.
5.Loosen and remove set screws from both sides of
the wheel hub. Inspect and, if necessary, replace.
Never shut the discharge valve while
the unit is running. Doing so could
cause a rupture in the discharge line
or components, resulting in death or
serious injury.
6.Using a rubber mallet or brass bar, slowly drive
the shaft in one direction until the set screw marks
on the shaft are fully exposed. File the marks
completely smooth. Drive the shaft in the opposite
direction and file smooth the set screw marks. Con-
tinue to clean the shaft of all dirt and residuals.
7.To remove the key, use a rubber mallet or brass bar
to drive the shaft and wheel in one direction. Drive
the key in the opposite direction using a nail set or
smaller size key stock until the key is completely
free of the wheel. Be sure that key does not get
bent by allowing it to ride up the key way edge.
The slightest bend will prevent quick assembly.
Should this occur, replace the key stock.
8.Remove the shaft, supporting the weight of the
wheel, particularly for larger diameter wheels. Do
not allow the weight of the shaft to be supported
by one bearing as you disassemble.
9.Remove the wheel through the discharge or outlet
area of the blower housing.
Never close the suction line ball valve
with the compressor running. Doing
so will cause the compressor to pump-
down into a vacuum and damage the
compressor due to internal arcing.
Forward Curved Fans
The forward curved fan wheel must be removed through
the fan discharge opening. The location of other clamps,
fan wheel, and shaft must be marked so each of these
components can be reassembled in the same location
- see Figure 4-4. This will preserve the balance of the
rotating assembly. Proceed with the following steps:
1.Disconnect all duct work or guards attached to the
blower housing to permit unobstructed access.
2.Remove the cut off plate attached at the discharge
or blast area of the blower housing.
3.Thoroughly clean the shaft of all grease and rust
inhibitor. Be careful not to contaminate the bearing
grease. Use emery cloth to remove all rust or the
wheel may become “locked” to the shaft.
10. Reassemble in reverse order, centering the wheel
between the edges of the inlet venturi. If bearings
were removed or replaced, be sure to reuse any
shim stock found between the mounting support/
plate and bearing housings.
11. Torque all hardware.
JOHNSON CONTROLS
58
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
Mounting Details –
Disconnect and lock-out power from
the unit anytime service is being per-
formed on the fan section. Failure to
do so could result in serious injury or
death due to the fan turning on while
work is in progress.
1.Check the shaft - it should be straight, free of burrs
and full size. Be sure the bearing is not seated on
a worn section of shafting.
2.Make certain any set screws are not obstructing
the bearing bore.
Fan Motor
3.Align the bearing in its housing and slide the bear-
ing into position on shaft - never hammer the ends
of the inner race. If necessary, use a brass bar or
pipe against the inner race to drift bearing into
place - never hit the housing, as bearing damage
may result. Make sure there is lubricant between
the bearing outer ring and the housing.
1.Shut off unit power and lock out.
2.Disconnect and tag power wires at motor
terminals.
3.Loosen motor base-to-mounting-rail attaching
bolts.
4.Mark belt as to position. Remove and set aside
belts.
5.Remove motor bracket hold down bolts.
6.Remove motor pulley and set aside.
7.Remove motor.
4.Fasten the bearing housing to the unit mounting
support with hex head cap screws, washers, new
lock washers and hex nuts before securing the bear-
ing to the shaft. This permits the bearing to align
itself in position along the shaft and eliminates any
possibility of cramping loads.
8.Install new motor. Reassemble by reversing steps
1 - 6. Be sure to reinstall multiple belts in their
original position. Use a complete new set if re-
quired. Do not stretch belts over sheaves. Review
the sections on motor and sheave installation,
sheave alignment, and belt tensioning discussed
previously.
9.Reconnect motor leads and restore power. Check
fan for proper rotation as described in Start-Up
Check List.
5.Rotate the shaft to make certain it turns freely.
6.Bearings may employ one of several different
methods to lock the bearing to the shaft.
4
Shaft should be free from burrs. If old
shaft is used, be sure a ball bearing is
not seated on worn section and shaft
is not bent.
There are various degrees of self-alignment in bearings
of the same manufacturer. The force required for the
self-alignment of the bearings used in JOHNSON
CONTROLS manufactured units has been specified
and is closely monitored at the factory. If it is necessary
to purchase a bearing locally, be sure it can be worked
around in the housing with a short shaft made of wood
or other soft material placed in the bearing.
Fan Shaft Bearings
General – When removing and replacing the bearings,
care should be taken to ensure that the area where the
bearings fit on the shaft does not become scored or
damaged. The shaft in this area should be thoroughly
cleaned before the bearing is removed and again before
the new bearing is installed.
JOHNSON CONTROLS
59
Maintenance
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
Prior to installing the bearing on the shaft, it should
be worked around in the housing to make sure that
self-alignment will be obtained where the bearing is
installed. After the shaft journal has been inspected for
cleanliness, metal chips or burrs, the bearing is slipped,
not forced, onto the shaft. Forcing the bearing onto the
shaft by the use of flange, pillow block, or outer ring
will damage the bearing internally. Force applied in this
way transmits the load to the inner race through the balls
in the bearing. Since the bearings are not designed for
axial loading, the sides of the races in which the balls
turn can be damaged. If the bearing cannot be made to
slip onto the shaft by pressing on the inner ring of the
bearing, check the shaft for burrs. Install the bearing so
the part of the inner race, which receives the locking
collar or contains setscrews, is toward the outside of
the unit.
Eccentric Type
An eccentric self-locking collar is turned and driven
with a punch in the direction of shaft rotation to lock
the bearing inner ring to the shaft. See Figure 4-7.
SEAL ASSEMBLY
RECESSED CAM OR SELF-
OUTER RING
LOCKING COLLAR
INNER RING
SELF LOCKING COLLAR
BALLS AND RACEWAY
CAM OR INNER RING
FIG. 4-6 – BEARING WITH ECCENTRIC CAM
If the grease fitting must be changed on bearings that
utilize a locking pin under the fitting, it is important
to properly replace it. If an adapter or grease fitting of
improper size and length is used, the locking pin may
be either too tight or loose and can affect the alignment
and re-lubrication of the bearing.
When the eccentric collar is engaged to the cam on the
bearing inner ring and turned in direction of rotation, it
grips the shaft with a positive binding action. The collar
is then locked in place with the setscrew provided in
the collar.
Bearing Lock Devices
The self-locking collar is placed on the shaft with its
cam adjacent to the cam on the end of the bearing’s wide
inner ring. In this position, with collar and bearing cams
disengaged, the collar’s bore is concentric with that of
the bearing’s inner ring. The wide inner ring is loose
on the shaft. By turning the collar in the direction of
normal shaft rotation, the eccentric recessed cam will
drop over and engage with the corresponding cam on
the bearing inner, causing it to grip the shaft tightly with
a positive binding action. See Figure 4-6 & 4-7. Make
sure the two cams engage smoothly and the locking
collar is down flat against the shoulder of the inner ring.
The wide inner ring is now locked to the shaft. Using
a punch or similar tool in the drilled hole of the collar,
tap the tool lightly to lock the collar in the direction of
normal shaft rotation.
Various types of locking devices are used to secure
bearing(s) to the fan shaft. Refer to the instructions
packed with bearings for special information. Figure
4-5 is a typical bearing with a setscrew-type locking
device. The various locking devices can be classified
under basic types: eccentric locking type, concentric
locking type, and Skwezloc type.
Set
Screws
Lube
Fitting
Lock
Ring
Seal
As a final step, the setscrew is tightened. Torque per
Table 4-2. It exerts a wedging action to hold the collar
always in the engaged position, even under shock and
reversing loads.
Pillow
Block
To disassemble, loosen the setscrew and tap the collar
in the direction opposite shaft rotation.
Inner
Race
Outer
Race
00418VIP
FIG. 4-5 – BEARING WITH SETSCREW TYPE
LOCKING DEVICE
JOHNSON CONTROLS
60
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
TABLE 4-2 – SET SCREW TORQUE
SET
SCREW
DIA.
HEX. SIZE MIN. RECOMMENDED
ACROSS
FLATS
LBS.
TORQUE
INCH
FOOT
LBS.
LBS.
1/4 1/8
66 - 85
5.5 - 7.2
5/16
5/32
126 - 164
10.5 - 13.7
29.0 - 37.7
3/8 3/16
228 - 296
19.0 - 24.7
7/16
7/32
348 - 452
1/2 1/4
504 - 655
42.0 - 54.6
5/8 5/16
1104 - 1435 92.0 - 119.6
Torquing of Set-screws
1.Torque screw “A” to 1/2 recommended torque.
2.Torque screw “B” to full min. recommended
value.
3.Torque screw “A” to full recommended value.
After proper installation of the
bearing(s), run the unit for 10 to 15
minutes. Shut the unit down and lock
it out. Check for proper engagement
of locking collar and tightness of set
screw(s).
4
When replacing split bearings, refer to manufacturer’s
instruction provided with the bearing. It is extremely
important to ensure that proper radial clearances are
observed between the roller bearings and outer face.
Failure to make proper adjustments will cause premature
failure of the bearing.
grease fitting
BEARING INSTALLATION
seal
00536vip
FIG. 4-8 – SPLIT BEARING
JOHNSON CONTROLS
61
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
THIS PAGE INTENTIONALLY LEFT BLANK
JOHNSON CONTROLS
62
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
SECTION 5 – SEQUENCE OF OPERATION
UNIT TYPE
• An “Occupancy Command” can be entered into
the Simplicity Control using the Modbus com-
munication feature. In order to use this feature
“OCCUPIED INPUT ENABLED” must be en-
abled using Parameter 71 under the PROGRAM
key on the Simplicity control board or under the
SYSTEMS OPTIONS tab in the Simplicity PC
software package.
The Simplicity Control is capable of being configured
for either Constant Volume (CV) or Variable Air
Volume (VAV) operation. To configure the unit for
VAV operation a 10,000 to 20,000 ohm resister must be
installed on the P7 (CV/VAV) connector on the control
board. If no resister is installed the unit is configured
for CV operation. The control board should already be
configured from the factory based on the type of unit
that was ordered. However, this item should be verified
at the time of start up. This feature will also need to be
configured if a replacement control board is installed.
• Space Sensor with Unoccupied Override Button
– If the Override Button is pushed on the space
sensor the control will switch to the Occupied
mode until the Unoccupied Override Time has
expired. The Unoccupied Override Time can be
set between 0 and 240 minutes. The “UNOCCU-
PIED OVERRIDE TIME” can be programmed
by selecting Parameter 9 using the Simplicity
control board PROGRAM key or by using the
SYSTEMS OPTION tab in the Simplicity PC
software package.
OCCUPIED / UNOCCUPIED MODE
The unit can be placed in the occupied or unoccupied
mode by four different methods.
• Digital Input -Aswitch, external time clock, etc.
can be used to close a 24 voltAC circuit between
the “R” and “OCC” connection on the field con-
nection terminal block of the Simplicity control
board. When the circuit is closed, the unit is in
the Occupied mode. If the circuit is open, the
unit is in the unoccupied mode. In order to use
this feature “OCCUPIED INPUT ENABLED”
must be enabled using Parameter 71 under the
PROGRAM key on the Simplicity control board
or under the SYSTEMS OPTIONS tab in the
Simplicity PC software package.
CONSTANT VOLUME MODE (CV)
AConstant Volume (CV) unit can be controlled by four
methods:
5
• Stage thermostat
• Communicated Space Temperature
• Hardwired Space Temperature
• Stand Alone
• Internal Schedule – The Simplicity Control can
be programmed for a weekly schedule that al-
lows two occupied and two unoccupied times
for each day. The control can also be configured
for up to 20 Holiday schedules. The start date,
time, and number of days can be programmed in
for each holiday. The weekly schedule can be
programmed using the WEEKLY SCHEDULE
SETTINGS tab in the Simplicity PC software
package. The holiday schedule can be pro-
grammed using the HOLIDAY SCHEDULE
tab in the Simplicity PC software package. In
order to use this feature “OCCUPIED INPUT
ENABLED” must be disabled using Parameter
71 under the PROGRAM key on the Simplicity
control board or under the SYSTEMS OPTIONS
tab in the Simplicity PC software package.
The control is self-configuring based on the inputs that
are present. The controls means are listed in their order
of priority. If the Simplicity Control sees a thermostat
input it will respond to that input regardless of the status
of the Space Temperature input. This feature allows
the Service Technician to easily energize a cooling or
heating function for troubleshooting regardless of a
space temperature input.
As long as the Simplicity Control is receiving a space
temperature input from the BAS system, it will use
the communicated value instead of a hard wired space
temperature input.
The following parameters must be programmed to allow
cooling and/or heating operation:
JOHNSON CONTROLS
63
Sequence of Operation
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
Occupied Cooling
“COOLING MODE OPERATION ENABLED” – must
be enabled using Parameter 53 under the PROGRAM
key on the Simplicity control board or under the
COOLING SETUP tab in the Simplicity PC software
package.
• Y1 – First Stage of Cooling – 1st compressor
from System 1.
• Y2 – Second Stage of Cooling – 2nd compressor
from System 1.
“HEATING MODE ENABLED FOR OPERATION”
– must be enabled using Parameter 54 under the
PROGRAM key on the Simplicity control board or
under the HEATING SETUP tab in the Simplicity PC
software package.
• Y3 – Third Stage of Cooling – 1st compressor
from System 2.
• Y4 – Fourth Stage of Cooling – 2nd compressor
from System 2.
Thermostat Input
Unoccupied Cooling
The Simplicity Control is set up to receive the following
cooling/heating inputs from the thermostat:
Unoccupied cooling operation is the same as Occupied.
Aprogrammable thermostat would be required in order
to change the cooling temperature settings between
occupied and unoccupied.
The following System parameters must be programmed
through the simplicity control:
If the Simplicity Control receives both a “Y” cooling
call and “W” heating call at the same time the control
will function and operate in the heating mode.
“CV OCCUPIED COOLING SETPOINT” - This
parameter must be programmed to 99.0º F. This can be
programmed using parameter 10 under the PROGRAM
key on the Simplicity control board or under the
COOLING SETUP tab in the Simplicity PC software
package.
The YPAL 50 to 65-ton unit has four stages of
mechanical cooling available and it is recommended
that a four stage cooling thermostat be used. However,
a two stage cooling thermostat could be used by
connecting Y1 from the thermostat to Y1 and Y2 on
the Simplicity field connection terminal block and Y2
from the thermostat toY3 andY4 on the Simplicity field
connection terminal block.
“CV OCCUPIED HEATING SETPOINT” - This
parameter must be programmed to 45.0º F. This can be
programmed using parameter 11 under the PROGRAM
key on the Simplicity control board or under the
HEATING SETUP tab in the Simplicity PC software
package.
In this mode of operation, the Simplicity will operate
as a two-stage control. On the 50 to 65 ton unit the
compressors will be grouped as follows:
“CV UNOCCUPIED COOLING SETPOINT” - This
parameter must be programmed to 99.0º F. This can be
programmed using parameter 12 under the PROGRAM
key on the Simplicity control board or under the
COOLING SETUP tab in the Simplicity PC software
package.
• First stage – Compressors 1A and 1B – System
1 compressors – minimum 30 second delay be-
tween compressors.
• Second stage – Compressors 2A and 2B – Sys-
tem 2 compressors – minimum 30 second delay
between compressors.
“CV UNOCCUPIED HEATING SETPOINT” - This
parameter must be programmed to 45.0º F. This can be
programmed using parameter 13 under the PROGRAM
key on the Simplicity control board or under the
HEATING SETUP tab in the Simplicity PC software
package.
The unit uses tandem compressors,
two compressors for System 1 and two
compressors for System 2.
JOHNSON CONTROLS
64
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
Occupied Heating
Cooling Operation – Occupied or Unoccupied
The Simplicity Control will stage on the cooling as
follows:
There are three stages of heating available:
• W1 – First Stage of Heating
• W2 – Second Stage of Heating
• W3 – Third Stage of Heating
• At cooling start up
– If the space temperature is between 1.5° F and
1.9° F above the “CV OCCUPIED COOLING
SETPOINT” or “CV UNOCCUPIED COOL-
ING SETPOINT” the control will turn on the
first compressor from System 1 and turn on a
5 minute timer.
– If after 5 minutes the space temperature is
between 1.5° F and 1.9° F above the “CV
OCCUPIED COOLING SETPOINT” or “CV
UNOCCUPIED COOLING SETPOINT” the
control will bring on the second compressor
of System 1 and start a 5-minute timer.
OR
– If the space temperature is greater than 2.0° F
or more above the “CV OCCUPIED COOL-
ING SETPOINT” or “CV UNOCCUPIED
COOLING SETPOINT” the control will bring
on the first compressor from System 1 and
start a 3 minute timer. After 30 seconds, the
control will bring on the second compressor
from System 1.
See the Heating section of this manual for a description
of the heating staging.
Unoccupied Heating
Unoccupied heating operation is the same as Occupied.
Aprogrammable thermostat would be required in order
to change the heating temperature settings between
occupied and unoccupied.
Space Sensor – Hard Wired or Communicated
The following System Parameters must be programmed
through the Simplicity Control:
• “CV OCCUPIED COOLING SETPOINT” – us-
ing Parameter 10 under the PROGRAM key on
the Simplicity control board or under the COOL-
ING SETUP tab in the Simplicity PC software
package.
5
• If after 3 or 5 minutes the space temperature is
between 1.5° F and 1.9° F above the “CV OC-
CUPIED COOLING SETPOINT” or “CV UN-
OCCUPIED COOLING SETPOINT” the control
will bring on the first compressor from System 2
and start a 5 minute timer.
• “CV OCCUPIED HEATING SETPOINT” – us-
ing Parameter 11 under the PROGRAM key on
the Simplicity control board or under the HEAT-
ING SETUP tab in the Simplicity PC software
package.
• If after 3 or 5 minutes the space temperature
is 2.0° F or more above the “CV OCCUPIED
COOLING SETPOINT” or “CV UNOCCUPIED
COOLING SETPOINT” the control will bring
on the first compressor of System 2 and start a 3
minute timer.
• “CV UNOCCUPIED COOLING SETPOINT”
– using Parameter 12 under the PROGRAM
key on the Simplicity control board or under
the COOLING SETUP tab in the Simplicity PC
software package.
• If after 3 or 5 minutes the space temperature
is 1.5° F or more above the “CV OCCUPIED
COOLING SETPOINT” or “CV UNOCCUPIED
COOLING SETPOINT” the control will bring on
the second compressor of System 2.
• “CV UNOCCUPIED HEATING SETPOINT”
– using Parameter 13 under the PROGRAM
key on the Simplicity control board or under
the HEATING SETUP tab in the Simplicity PC
software package.
JOHNSON CONTROLS
65
Sequence of Operation
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
The Simplicity Control will stage off the cooling as
follows:
The Simplicity Control will stage off the heat as
follows:
• If the space temperature is within 0.5° F of the
“CV OCCUPIED COOLING SETPOINT” or
“CV UNOCCUPIED COOLING SETPOINT”
the control turns off the System 2 compressors,
if on, with a 30 second delay between the com-
pressors provided the minimum compressor run
times have been satisfied.
• When the space temperature is 2.4° F below the
“CV OCCUPIED HEATING” or “CV UNOC-
CUPIED HEATING SETPOINT” the third stage
of heating will turn off.
• When the space temperature is 1.9° F below the
“CV OCCUPIED HEATING” or “CV UNOC-
CUPIED HEATING SETPOINT” the second
stage of heat will turn off.
• If the space temperature is equal to or below the
“CV OCCUPIED COOLING SETPOINT” or
“CV UNOCCUPIED COOLING SETPOINT”
the control turns off the System 1 compressors
with a 30 second delay between the compressors
provided the minimum compressor run times
have been satisfied.
• When the space temperature is 0.1° F above the
“CV OCCUPIED HEATING” or “CV UNOC-
CUPIED HEATING SETPOINT” the first stage
of heating will turn off.
The Simplicity Control has the following heating timing
functions:
The Simplicity Control has the following timing cooling
functions:
• A minimum off time of 2 minutes.
• A minimum on time of 3 minutes.
• Minimum off time of 5 minutes.
• There is a 30 second time delay between stag-
• Minimum on time of 3 minutes – This param-
eter can be programmed from between 1 and 10
minutes using the COOLING SETUP tab of the
in the Simplicity PC software package.
es.
Stand Alone
Heating Operation – Occupied or Unoccupied
The following System Parameters must be programmed
through the Simplicity Control:
The Simplicity Control will stage on the heat as
follows:
• “CV OCCUPIED COOLING SETPOINT” – us-
ing Parameter 10 under the PROGRAM key on
the Simplicity control board or under the COOL-
ING SETUP tab in the Simplicity PC software
package.
• When the space temperature is 1.5° F – 1.9° F
below the “CV OCCUPIED HEATING” or “CV
UNOCCUPIED HEATING SETPOINT” the
control energizes the first stage of heat.
• “CV OCCUPIED HEATING SETPOINT” – us-
ing Parameter 11 under the PROGRAM key on
the Simplicity control board or under the HEAT-
ING SETUP tab in the Simplicity PC software
package.
• When the space temperature is 2.0° F – 2.4° F
below the “CV OCCUPIED HEATING” or “CV
UNOCCUPIED HEATING SETPOINT” the
control energizes the second stage of heat.
• When the space temperature is 2.5° F or more
below the “CV OCCUPIED HEATING” or “CV
UNOCCUPIED HEATING SETPOINT” the
control energizes the third stage of heat.
• “CV UNOCCUPIED COOLING SETPOINT”
– using Parameter 12 under the PROGRAM
key on the Simplicity control board or under
the COOLING SETUP tab in the Simplicity PC
software package.
JOHNSON CONTROLS
66
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
• “CV UNOCCUPIED HEATING SETPOINT”
– using Parameter 13 under the PROGRAM
key on the Simplicity control board or under
the HEATING SETUP tab in the Simplicity PC
software package.
• If after 3 or 5 minutes the return air temperature
is 1.5° F or more above the “CV OCCUPIED
COOLING SETPOINT” or “CV UNOCCUPIED
COOLING SETPOINT” the control will bring on
the second compressor of System 2.
• “SPACE SENSOR FAULT OVERIDE EN-
ABLED” must be turned on – using Parameter
8 under the PROGRAM key on the Simplicity
control board or under the SYSTEM OPTIONS
tab in the Simplicity PC software package.
The Simplicity Control will stage off the cooling as
follows:
• If the return air temperature is within 0.5° F of
the “CV OCCUPIED COOLING SETPOINT”
or “CV UNOCCUPIED COOLING SETPOINT”
the control turns off the System 2 compressors,
if on, with a 30 second delay between the com-
pressors provided the minimum compressor run
times have been satisfied.
Cooling Operation – Occupied or Unoccupied
The Simplicity Control will stage on the cooling as
follows:
• If the return air temperature is equal to or below
the “CV OCCUPIED COOLING SETPOINT”
or “CV UNOCCUPIED COOLING SETPOINT”
the control turns off the System 1 compressors
with a 30 second delay between the compressors
provided the minimum compressor run times
have been satisfied.
• At cooling start up
– If the return air temperature is between 1.5°
F and 1.9° F above the “CV OCCUPIED
COOLING SETPOINT” or “CV UNOCCU-
PIED COOLING SETPOINT” the control
will turn on the first compressor from System
1 and turn on a 5 minute timer.
– If after 5 minutes the return air temperature
is between 1.5° F and 1.9° F above the “CV
OCCUPIED COOLING SETPOINT” or “CV
UNOCCUPIED COOLING SETPOINT” the
control will bring on the second compressor
of System 1 and start a 5-minute timer.
OR
– If the return air temperature is greater than
2.0° F or more above the “CV OCCUPIED
COOLING SETPOINT” or “CV UNOCCU-
PIED COOLING SETPOINT” the control
will bring on the first compressor from System
1 and start a 3 minute timer. After 30 seconds,
the control will bring on the second compres-
sor from System 1.
The Simplicity Control has the following timing cooling
functions:
• Minimum off time of 5 minutes.
• Minimum on time of 3 minutes – This param-
eter can be programmed from between 1 and 10
minutes using the COOLING SETUP tab of the
in the Simplicity PC software package.
5
Heating Operation – Occupied or Unoccupied
The Simplicity Control will stage on the heat as
follows:
• When the return air temperature is 1.5° F – 1.9°
F below the “CV OCCUPIED HEATING” or
“CV UNOCCUPIED HEATING SETPOINT”
the control energizes the first stage of heat.
• If after 3 or 5 minutes the return air temperature
is between 1.5° F and 1.9° F above the “CV
OCCUPIED COOLING SETPOINT” or “CV
UNOCCUPIED COOLING SETPOINT” the
control will bring on the first compressor from
System 2 and start a 5 minute timer.
• When the return air temperature is 2.0° F – 2.4°
F below the “CV OCCUPIED HEATING” or
“CV UNOCCUPIED HEATING SETPOINT”
the control energizes the second stage of heat.
• If after 3 or 5 minutes the return air temperature
is 2.0° F or more above the “CV OCCUPIED
COOLING SETPOINT” or “CV UNOCCUPIED
COOLING SETPOINT” the control will bring
on the first compressor of System 2 and start a 3
minute timer.
• When the return air temperature is 2.5° F or more
below the “CV OCCUPIED HEATING” or “CV
UNOCCUPIED HEATING SETPOINT” the
control energizes the third stage of heat.
JOHNSON CONTROLS
67
Sequence of Operation
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
The Simplicity Control will stage off the heat as
follows:
• “VAV COOLING SUPPLY AIR TEMP LOWER
SETPOINT” – using Parameter 24 under the
PROGRAM key on the Simplicity control board
or under the COOLING SETUP tab in the Sim-
plicity PC software package.
• When the return air temperature is 2.4° F below
the “CV OCCUPIED HEATING” or “CV UN-
OCCUPIED HEATING SETPOINT” the third
stage of heating will turn off.
The Simplicity Control initiates compressor operation
as follows:
• When the return air temperature is 1.9° F below
the “CV OCCUPIED HEATING” or “CV UN-
OCCUPIED HEATING SETPOINT” the second
stage of heat will turn off.
• The Simplicity Control will turn compressors on
and off based of the difference between the sup-
ply air temperature and the cooling set point.
• When the return air temperature is 0.1° F above
the “CV OCCUPIED HEATING” or “CV UN-
OCCUPIED HEATING SETPOINT” the first
stage of heating will turn off.
• With no thermostat call or a Y1 first stage
call the Simplicity Control will control to the
“VAV COOLING SUPPLY AIR TEMP UPPER
SETPOINT”. The Y1 input is not required to
initiate compressor operation.
The Simplicity Control has the following heating timing
functions:
• When there is a Y2, Y3, or Y4 call from the
thermostat the Simplicity Control will control to
the “VAV COOLING SUPPLY TEMP LOWER
SETPOINT”.
• A minimum off time of 2 minutes.
• A minimum on time of 3 minutes.
• The control uses a 5-degree dead band around
the cooling “VAV COOLING SUPPLY TEMP
UPPER SAT SETPOINT” or “VAV COOLING
SUPPLY AIR TEMP LOWER SETPOINT”.
• There is a 30 second time delay between stag-
es.
VARIABLE AIR VOLUME (VAV)
• When the supply air temperature is 5.0° F
or more above the cooling “VAV COOLING
SUPPLY TEMP UPPER SAT SETPOINT” or
“VAV COOLING SUPPLY AIR TEMP LOWER
SETPOINT” the Simplicity Control will energize
the first compressor.
A Variable Air Volume (VAV) unit can be controlled
by four methods:
• Stage thermostat
• Communicated Space Temperature
• Hardwired Space Temperature
• Stand Alone - Return Air Temperature
• The control records the supply air temperature
right before the compressor is turned on and
compares it to the supply air temperature after 5
minutes of operation.
• Asecond compressor will be turned on if both of
Cooling - Occupied with Thermostat
the following criteria are met:
– The supply air temperature is still 5.0° F or
more above the “VAV COOLING SUPPLY
TEMP UPPER SAT SETPOINT” or “VAV
COOLING SUPPLY AIR TEMP LOWER
SETPOINT”.
The following System Parameters must be programmed
through the Simplicity Control for VAV operation:
• “VAV COOLING SUPPLY AIR TEMP UPPER
SETPOINT” – using Parameter 23 under the
PROGRAM key on the Simplicity control board
or under the COOLING SETUP tab in the Sim-
plicity PC software package.
JOHNSON CONTROLS
68
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
– The Simplicity Control uses the temperature
difference calculated when the first com-
pressor was turned on to verify the supply
air temperature will not drop 5.0° F or more
below the cooling “VAV COOLING SUPPLY
TEMP UPPER SAT SETPOINT” or “VAV
COOLING SUPPLY AIR TEMP LOWER
SETPOINT”. If turning a compressor on
would result in the specified drop in supply
air temperature, the second compressor will
not be turned on.
Any W thermostat input will energize all the available
heat stages with a 30 second delay between stages.
Occupied Cooling with Hard Wired or Communi-
cated Space Sensor
The following System Parameters must be programmed
through the Simplicity Control for VAV operation with
a space sensor:
• “VAV COOLING SUPPLY AIR TEMP UPPER
SETPOINT” – using Parameter 23 under the
PROGRAM key on the Simplicity control board
or under the COOLING SETUP tab in the Sim-
plicity PC software package.
• The same logic will be used to stage on compres-
sor 3 and 4.
The Simplicity Control turns off compressor operation
as follows:
• “VAV COOLING SUPPLY AIR TEMP LOWER
SETPOINT” – using Parameter 24 under the
PROGRAM key on the Simplicity control board
or under the COOLING SETUP tab in the Sim-
plicity PC software package.
• The supply air temperature is 5.0° F or more
below the “VAV COOLING SUPPLY TEMP
UPPER SAT SETPOINT” or “VAV COOLING
SUPPLY AIR TEMP LOWER SETPOINT”.
• “VAV SUPPLY AIR TEMP RESET SETPOINT”
– using Parameter 25 under the PROGRAM
key on the Simplicity control board or under
the COOLING SETUP tab in the Simplicity PC
software package.
• It has been more than 5-minutes since the last
compressor was turned on.
• The compressors will be turned off in the reverse
order they were turned on.
Cooling – Unoccupied with Thermostat
The Simplicity Control will control the operation of the
compressors as follows:
The operation is the same as Occupied Cooling with a
Thermostat except:
5
• Ifthespacetemperatureis2.0°Formoreabovethe
“VAV SUPPLY AIR TEMP RESET SETPOINT”
the control will use the “VAV COOLING SUPPLY
AIR TEMP LOWER SETPOINT”.
• A Y1 call will energize the supply fan.
• The Simplicity Control will not bring on compres-
sors until the supply air temperature is 5.0° F or
more above the “VAV COOLING SUPPLY TEMP
UPPER SAT SETPOINT” or “VAV COOLING
SUPPLY AIR TEMP LOWER SETPOINT”.
• If the space temperature is not 2.0° F or more
above the “VAV SUPPLY AIR TEMP RESET
SETPOINT” the control will use the “VAV
COOLING SUPPLY AIR TEMP UPPER
SETPOINT”.
• Both of the above criteria must be met before the
• If the control is using the “VAV COOLING
SUPPLY AIR TEMP LOWER SETPOINT” per
above the space temperature must be equal to or
less than the “VAV SUPPLY AIR TEMP RESET
SETPOINT” before the control would switch to
the “VAV COOLING SUPPLY AIR TEMP UP-
PER SETPOINT”.
Simplicity Control will bring on compressors.
Occupied or Unoccupied Heating with a Thermo-
stat
The following parameter must be programmed through
the Simplicity Control:
• The control uses a 5-degree dead band around the
cooling “VAV COOLING SUPPLY AIR TEMP
UPPER SETPOINT” or “VAV COOLING SUP-
PLY AIR TEMP LOWERT SETPOINT”.
• “VAV OCCUPIED HEATING ENABLED”
– must be turned on using Parameter 26 under
the PROGRAM key on the Simplicity control
board or under the HEATING SETUP tab in the
Simplicity PC software package.
JOHNSON CONTROLS
69
Sequence of Operation
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
Heating – Occupied with a Hard Wired or Com-
municated Space Sensor
• When the supply air temperature is 5.0° F or more
above the cooling “VAV UPPER COOLING SAT
SETPOINT” or “VAV LOWER COOLING SAT
SETPOINT” the Simplicity Control will energize
the first compressor.
The following parameter must be programmed into the
Simplicity Control:
• The control records the supply air temperature
right before the compressor is turned on and
compares it to the supply air temperature after 5
minutes of operation.
• “VAVOCCUPIED HEATING ENABLED” –This
must be turned on using Parameter 26 under the
PROGRAM key on the Simplicity control board
or under the HEATING SETUP tab in the Sim-
plicity PC software package.
• A second compressor will be turned if both of
the following criteria are met:
– The supply air temperature is still 5.0° F or
more, greater then the “VAV UPPER COOL-
ING SAT SETPOINT” or “VAV LOWER
COOLING SAT SETPOINT”.
– The Simplicity Control uses the temperature
difference calculated when the first compres-
sor was turned on to verify the supply air tem-
perature will not drop 5.0° F or more below
the cooling “VAV UPPER COOLING SAT
SETPOINT” or “VAV LOWER COOLING
SAT SETPOINT”. If turning on a compressor
would result in the specified drop in supply
air temperature, the second compressor will
not be turned on.
• “MORNING WARM-UP/ VAV RETURN AIR
TEMP SETPOINT” – using Parameter 29 under
the PROGRAM key on the Simplicity control
board or under the HEATING SETUP tab in the
Simplicity PC software package.
• “VAV OCCUPIED HEATING SETPOINT” – us-
ing Parameter 27 under the PROGRAM key on
the Simplicity control board or under the HEAT-
ING SETUP tab in the Simplicity PC software
package.
The unit will initiate Occupied Heating when the
following criteria is met:
• The same logic will be used to stage on compres-
• The space temperature is 2.0° F less than the
sor 3 and 4.
“VAV OCCUPIED HEATING SETPOINT”.
• The return air temperature is 0.1° F below the
“MORNING WARM UP / VAV RETURN AIR
TEMP SETPOINT”.
The Simplicity Control turn off compressor operation
as follows:
• The supply air temperature is 5.0° F or more
below the ““VAV COOLING SUPPLY TEMP
UPPER SAT SETPOINT” or “VAV COOLING
SUPPLY AIR TEMP LOWER SETPOINT”.
The unit will terminate Occupied Heating when the:
• The return air temperature is equal to the
“MORNING WARM UP RAT SETPOINT”.
• It has been more than 5-minutes since the last
compressor was turned on.
The “VAV OCCUPIED HEATING SETPOINT” should
always be set below the “MORNING WARM UP RAT
SETPOINT”.
• The compressors will be turned off in the reverse
order they were turned on.
Cooling – Unoccupied with a Hard Wired or Com-
municated Space Sensor
Heating – Unoccupied with a Hard Wired or Com-
municated Space Sensor
The Simplicity Control cannot operate unoccupied
cooling with this method of control.
The Simplicity Control cannot operate unoccupied
heating with this method of control.
JOHNSON CONTROLS
70
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
Occupied Cooling – Stand Alone
• The control uses a 5-degree dead band around the
cooling “VAV COOLING SUPPLY AIR TEMP
UPPER SETPOINT” or “VAV COOLING SUP-
PLY AIR TEMP LOWERT SETPOINT”.
• When the supply air temperature is 5.0° F or more
above the cooling “VAV UPPER COOLING SAT
SETPOINT” or “VAV LOWER COOLING SAT
SETPOINT” the Simplicity Control will energize
the first compressor.
• The control records the supply air temperature
right before the compressor is turned on and
compares it to the supply air temperature after 5
minutes of operation.
• Asecond compressor will be turned on if both of
the following criteria are met:
The following System Parameters must be programmed
through the Simplicity Control for VAV Stand Alone
operation:
• “VAV COOLING SUPPLY AIR TEMP UP-
PER SETPOINT” – using Parameter 23 under
the PROGRAM key on the Simplicity control
board or under the COOLING SETUP tab in the
Simplicity PC software package.
• “VAV COOLING SUPPLYAIR TEMPLOWER
SETPOINT” – using Parameter 24 under the
PROGRAM key on the Simplicity control board
or under the COOLING SETUP tab in the Sim-
plicity PC software package.
• “VAV SUPPLYAIR TEMPRESET SETPOINT”
– using Parameter 25 under the PROGRAM
key on the Simplicity control board or under
the COOLING SETUP tab in the Simplicity PC
software package.
• “SPACE SENSOR FAULT OVERRIDE EN-
ABLED” must be turned on – using Parameter
8 under the PROGRAM key on the Simplicity
control board or under the SYSTEM OPTIONS
tab in the Simplicity PC software package.
– The supply air temperature is still 5.0° F or
more, greater then the “VAV UPPER COOL-
ING SAT SETPOINT” or “VAV LOWER
COOLING SAT SETPOINT”.
– The Simplicity Control uses the temperature
difference calculated when the first compres-
sor was turned on to verify the supply air tem-
perature will not drop 5.0° F or more below
the cooling “VAV UPPER COOLING SAT
SETPOINT” or “VAV LOWER COOLING
SAT SETPOINT”. If turning on a compressor
would result in the specified drop in supply
air temperature, the second compressor will
not be turned on.
5
The Simplicity Control will control the operation of the
compressors as follows:
• The same logic will be used to stage on compres-
sor 3 and 4.
• If the return air temperature is 2.0° F or more
above the “VAV SUPPLY AIR TEMP RESET
SETPOINT” the control will use the “VAV
COOLING SUPPLY AIR TEMP LOWER
SETPOINT”.
The Simplicity Control turns off compressor operation
as follows:
• If the return air temperature is not 2.0° F or
more above the “VAV SUPPLY AIR TEMP
RESET SETPOINT” the control will use the
“VAV COOLING SUPPLY AIR TEMP UPPER
SETPOINT”.
• If the control is using the “VAV COOLING
SUPPLYAIR TEMP LOWER SETPOINT” per
above the return air temperature must be equal
to or less than the “VAV SUPPLY AIR TEMP
RESET SETPOINT” before the control would
switch to the “VAV COOLING SUPPLY AIR
TEMP UPPER SETPOINT”.
• The supply air temperature is 5.0° F or more
below the ““VAV COOLING SUPPLY TEMP
UPPER SAT SETPOINT” or “VAV COOLING
SUPPLY AIR TEMP LOWER SETPOINT”.
• It has been more than 5-minutes since the last
compressor was turned on.
• The compressors will be turned off in the reverse
order they were turned on.
JOHNSON CONTROLS
71
Sequence of Operation
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
Cooling – Unoccupied Stand Alone
Heating – Unoccupied Stand Alone
The Simplicity Control cannot operate unoccupied
cooling with this method of control.
The Simplicity Control cannot operate unoccupied
heating with this method of control.
Heating – Occupied Stand Alone
CONDENSER FAN OPERATION
The following parameters must be programmed into
the Simplicity Control:
A call for the operation of compressor 1A or 1B will
close an output at terminal CF1 of the P13 connector.
This 24 VAC output energizes the 6M contactor and
turns on condenser fan 1. This 24 VAC output is also
sent to pressure switch PS3. If the discharge pressure
rises above 360 psig the PS3 switch closes and energizes
the 7M contactor. The 7M contactor then energizes
condenser fan 2. If the discharge pressure decreases
below 300 psig the PS3 switch opens and de-energizes
condenser fan 2.
• “VAV OCCUPIED HEATING ENABLED”
– This must be turned on using Parameter 26
under the PROGRAM key on the Simplicity
control board or under the HEATING SETUP
tab in the Simplicity PC software package.
• “MORNING WARM-UP/ VAV RETURN AIR
TEMP SETPOINT” – using Parameter 29 under
the PROGRAM key on the Simplicity control
board or under the HEATING SETUP tab in the
Simplicity PC software package.
• “VAV OCCUPIED HEATING SETPOINT” – us-
ing Parameter 27 under the PROGRAM key on
the Simplicity control board or under the HEAT-
ING SETUP tab in the Simplicity PC software
package.
• “SPACE SENSOR FAULT OVERRIDE EN-
ABLED” must be turned on – using Parameter
8 under the PROGRAM key on the Simplicity
control board or under the SYSTEMS OPTIONS
tab in the Simplicity PC software package.
A call for the operation of compressor 2A or 2B will
close an output at terminal CF2 of the P13 connector.
This 24 VAC output energizes the 8M contactor and
turns on condenser fan 3. This 24 VAC output is also
sent to pressure switch PS4. If the discharge pressure
rises above 360 psig the PS4 switch closes and energizes
the 9M contactor. The 9M contactor then energizes
condenser fan 4. If the discharge pressure decreases
below 300 psig the PS4 switch opens and de-energizes
condenser fan 4.
COOLING COMPRESSOR LOCKOUT
This feature prevents operation of mechanical cooling
when the outdoor temperature is below this set point.
The unit will initiate Occupied Heating when the
following criteria are met:
• “OUTDOORAIRTEMPCOOLINGLOCKOUT”
- this parameter can be set using the COOLING
SETUP tab in the Simplicity PC software pack-
age. This parameter should never be programmed
less then 45.0º F
• The return air temperature is 2.0° F less than the
“VAV OCCUPIED HEATING SETPOINT”.
• The return air temperature is 0.1° F below the
“MORNING WARM UP / VAV RETURN AIR
TEMP SETPOINT”.
Sequence of Operation
The “VAV OCCUPIED HEATING SETPOINT” should
always be set below the “MORNING WARM UP RAT
SETPOINT”.
• If the outdoor temperature is 1.0º F below the
“OUTDOOR AIR TEMP COOLING LOCK-
OUT” the Simplicity Elite control will prevent
compressor operation.
The unit will terminate Occupied Heating when:
• When the outdoor temperature is 1.0º F above
the “OUTDOOR AIR TEMP COOLING LOCK-
OUT” compressor operation will be permitted.
• The return air temperature is equal to the
“MORNING WARM UP RAT SETPOINT”.
JOHNSON CONTROLS
72
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
Configuration (Jumpers and Potentiometers)
• If the outdoor air temperature is less then the
economizer supply air temperature set point,
compressors will not operate regardless of the
“OUTDOOR AIR TEMP COOLING LOCK-
OUT” set point.
The inverter is configured at the factory. The jumpers
must be in the positions shown in Table 5-2.
TABLE 5-2 – VFD JUMPERS
J2
J3
J4
J5
J6
J7
J8
J9
REMOVE
REMOVE
REMOVE
MIDDLE
MIDDLE
IN
-
LOW AMBIENT OPERATION
A condenser fan VFD can be installed on condenser
fan # l. When this is installed compressor system 1
(compressors 1A and 1B) can operate down to an
outdoor temperature of 0.0º F. The VFD is located in
an enclosure on the right hand side of the condenser
section, to the right of the system 2 compressors.
IN
IN FOR 60 HZ
REMOVE FOR 50 HZ
Potentiometer settings are also preset at the factory.
The potentiometers should be in the positions shown in
Table 5-3. The potentiometers do not have numerical
settings and are set according to the positions indicated.
DO NOT change potentiometer settings unless they do
not match the positioning of the potentiometers shown
in Figure 5-1. Modifying these settings may cause
damage to the unit, control problems, and/or poor
operating efficiency.
To enable low ambient operation when a condenser
fan VFD is installed, the following parameter must be
programmed:
“LOWAMBIENT KITINSTALLED” - is enabled
using Parameter 84 under the PROGRAM key
of the Simplicity Elite control board or under the
EQUIPMENT INSTALLATION tab in the Simplicity
PC software package.
Operation and Pressure Control Range
TABLE 5-3 – POTENTIOMETER SETTINGS
P1
P2
The VFD controls the speed of the fan based on a
discharge pressure setpoint and a differential range.
When discharge pressure reaches approximately 270
PSIG, the VFD will start the fan if the Unit Controller
is calling for compressor / condenser fan operation. The
binary outputs from the Unit Controller are as shown
in Table 5-1.
5
350 PSIG
6 O’CLOCK
80 PSIG
6 O’CLOCK
TABLE 5-1 – BINARY OUTPUTS
TERMINAL
CONDENSER
FAN
WIRE
#
CONNECTOR
CONTACTOR
#
1A
P13
1
423
6M
As soon as the contactor is energized, the VFD will be
activated and will begin to control. As the pressure rises
over the next 80 PSIG (270 – 350 PSIG); the fan speed
will increase to full speed at approximately 350 PSIG.
LD113008
P1
P2
FIG. 5-1 – CONDENSER FAN VFD POTENTIOMETER
SETTINGS
The VFD control input signal originates from the
discharge pressure transducer for the compressor system
it is controlling. The transducer signal feeds the VFD.
The VFD controls the fan speed based on discharge
pressure.
JOHNSON CONTROLS
73
Sequence of Operation
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
SUPPLY FAN OPERATION
– If “CONTINUOUS FAN OPERATION WITH
SENSOR” is turned on using Parameter 55
under the PROGRAM key on the Simplicity
control board, or under the FANS tab in the
Simplicity PC software package the supply
fan will operate continuously whenever the
unit is in the occupied mode.
Constant Volume (CV)
The following values need to be programmed:
“COOL, FAN ON DELAY” – Using parameter 4 under
the PROGRAM key on the Simplicity control board
or under the FAN tab in the Simplicity PC software
package.
∗ If “TURN OFF CONTINUOUS FAN
WHEN START HEAT” is turned on using
Parameter 7 under the PROGRAM key of
the Simplicity control board or under the
FANS tab in the Simplicity PC software
package the supply fan will shut down on
a call for heat and then start based on the
“HEAT, FAN ON DELAY” programmed
time.
“COOL, FAN OFF DELAY” – Using parameter 5 under
the PROGRAM key on the Simplicity control board
or under the FAN tab in the Simplicity PC software
package.
“HEAT, FAN ON DELAY” – Using parameter 2 under
the PROGRAM key on the Simplicity control board
or under the FAN tab in the Simplicity PC software
package.
The supply fan will be de-energized when:
• The supply fan has been on for 30 seconds and
anyone of the following occurs:
“HEAT, FAN OFF DELAY” – Using parameter 3 under
the PROGRAM key on the Simplicity control board
or under the FAN tab in the Simplicity PC software
package.
– When the 24-volt input to terminal “G” of
the Simplicity control terminal board is re-
moved.
– Any time the 24 volt input to terminal Y1,
Y2, Y3, Y4, W1, W2, or W3 of the Simplic-
ity control terminal board is removed and the
“COOL, FAN OFF DELAY” or “HEAT, FAN
OFF DELAY” have timed out. The “HEAT,
FAN OFF DELAY” timer does not start until
the control receives a signal that the gas valve
is de-energized.
– Any time there is a call for cooling or heating
operation by a space sensor is lost and the
“COOL, FAN OFF DELAY” or “HEAT, FAN
OFF DELAY” have timed out. The “HEAT,
FAN OFF DELAY” timer does not start until
the control receives a signal that the gas valve
is energized.
The supply will be energized when:
• The supply fan has been off for 10 seconds and
anyone of the following occurs:
– There is a 24 volt input to terminal “G” of the
Simplicity control terminal board.
– There is a 24 volt input to terminal Y1, Y2,
Y3, Y4, W1, W2, or W3 of the Simplicity con-
trol terminal board and the “COOL, FAN ON
DELAY” or “HEAT, FAN ON DELAY” have
timed out. The “HEAT, FAN ON DELAY”
timer does not start until the control receives
a signal that the gas valve is energized.
– There is a call for cooling or heating operation
initiated by a space sensor demand and the
“COOL, FAN ON DELAY” or “HEAT, FAN
ON DELAY” have timed out. The “HEAT,
FAN ON DELAY” timer does not start until
the control receives a signal that the gas valve
is energized.
– When the unit goes into the unoccupied mode
and there is no call for cooling or heating
operation.
JOHNSON CONTROLS
74
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
The Simplicity Control monitors the operation of the
supply fan by checking the status of a digital input from
an air proving switch. After 90 seconds of operation,
the Simplicity Control looks for a high state (24-volt
input) from the air proving switch circuit at the “APS”
connections at the P11 connector on the Simplicity
control board. If this input does not go to the high state
in this time frame the Simplicity Control will set anAir
Pressure Switch Unit Lockout,Alarm Code 24 and turn
off all outputs.
The supply fan will be de-energized when:
• The supply fan has been on for 30 seconds and
anyone of the following occurs:
– Any time the unit goes unoccupied and there
is no call for cooling or heating operation.
– Any time the 24 volt input to terminal Y1,
Y2, Y3, Y4, W1, W2, or W3 of the Simplic-
ity control terminal board is removed and the
“COOL, FAN OFF DELAY” or “HEAT, FAN
OFF DELAY” have timed out. The “HEAT,
FAN OFF DELAY” timer does not start until
the control receives a signal that the gas valve
is de-energized.
The Simplicity Control will retry the fan output every
30 minutes for three retries. If after three retires it still
cannot qualify the fan, it will continue the alarm and
lock out all heating and cooling operation. If the switch
closes during one of the restarts, the control will resume
normal operation and clear the active alarm.
The Simplicity Control monitors the operation of the
supply fan by checking the status of a digital input from
an air proving switch. After 90 seconds of operation,
the Simplicity Control looks for a high state (24-volt
input) from the air proving switch circuit at the “APS”
connections at the P11 connector on the Simplicity
control board. If this input does not go to the high state
in this time frame the Simplicity Control will set anAir
Pressure Switch Unit Lockout,Alarm Code 24 and turn
off all outputs. The Simplicity Control also monitors
the duct static pressure input during this time. If the
duct static pressure is above 0.05” WC the control will
generate a Air Pressure Switch Unit Lockout, Alarm
Code 24 but continue to operate.
An Air Pressure Switch Unit Lockout will also be
declared if the input goes low, for 2 seconds, during
normal supply fan operation.
The Simplicity Control also monitors the supply fan
operation in the off cycle. 90 seconds after the digital
output from the Simplicity control supply fan circuit
goes low (0 volts) the Simplicity Control checks the
status of the digital input from the air proving switch
circuit. If the state of the circuit remains high (24-volts)
the Simplicity Control will set an Air Pressure Switch
stuck closed, Alarm Code 25. As soon as the pressure
switch opens, the Simplicity Control will resume normal
operation.
5
The Simplicity Control will retry the fan output every
30 minutes for three retries. If after three retires it still
cannot qualify the fan, it will continue the alarm and
lock out all heating and cooling operation. If the switch
closes during one of the restarts, the control will resume
normal operation and clear the active alarm.
On a call for supply fan operation, the Simplicity
Control sends a 24 VAC signal from the FAN terminal
of the P13 connector to the supply fan relay.
Variable Air Volume (VAV)
An Air Pressure Switch Unit Lockout will also be
declared if the input goes low, for 2 seconds, during
normal supply fan operation.
The supply will be energized when:
• The supply fan has been off for 10 seconds and
The Simplicity Control also monitors the supply fan
operation in the off cycle. 90 seconds after the digital
output from the Simplicity Control supply fan circuit
goes low (0 volts) the Simplicity Control checks the
status of the digital input from the air proving switch
circuit. If the state of the circuit remains high (24-volts)
the Simplicity Control will set an Air Pressure Switch
stuck closed, Alarm Code 25. As soon as the pressure
switch opens the Simplicity Control will resume normal
operation.
anyone of the following occurs:
– The unit is in the occupied mode.
– The unit is in the Unoccupied heating or
cooling mode and there is a 24 volt input to
terminal Y1, Y2, Y3, Y4, W1, W2, or W3 of
the Simplicity control terminal board and the
“COOL, FAN ON DELAY” or “HEAT, FAN
ON DELAY” have timed out. The “HEAT,
FAN ON DELAY” timer does not start until
the control receives a signal that the gas valve
is energized.
JOHNSON CONTROLS
75
Sequence of Operation
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
VAV Supply Fan Speed Control
The following parameter must be programmed to allow
economizer operation:
The following values need to be programmed:
“DUCT PRESSURE SETPOINT” – Using parameter
30 under the PROGRAM key on the Simplicity control
board or under the FAN tab in the Simplicity PC
software package.
“ECONOMIZER INSTALLED” – must be enabled using
Parameter32underthePROGRAMkeyontheSimplicity
control board or under the ECONOMIZER/EXHAUST
tab in the Simplicity PC software package.
“DUCT PRESSURE SHUTDOWN SETPOINT”
– By using the FAN tab in the Simplicity PC software
package.
Dry Bulb
The following parameter must be programmed to allow
economizer operation:
The Simplicity Control uses a proportional-integral
control algorithm to maintain the “DUCT PRESSURE
SETPOINT” by varying the speed of the supply fan. As
the duct static pressure goes up the speed goes down.
“ECONOMIZER OUTSIDE AIR TEMP ENABLE
SETPOINT” – must be programmed using Parameter
39 under the PROGRAM key on the Simplicity control
board or under the ECONOMIZER/EXHAUST tab in
the Simplicity PC software package.
On a call for supply fan operation the Simplicity Control
sends a 24 VAC signal from the FAN terminal of the
P13 connector to the supply fan relay.
The economizer will become active and use outdoor air
for cooling when:
The Duct Static Pressure Transducer has a range of 0.0
to 5.0” WC. The transducer sends a 0.0 to 5.0 volt DC
signal to the Simplicity Control through the DP+ and
DP- connections at the P21 connector. The Simplicity
Control then sends a 2.0 to 10.0 volt DC signal to the
supply fan VFD through the VFD+, VFD- terminals at
connector P14 to vary the speed of the VFD.
• The outside air temperature is less then or equal
to the “ECONOMIZER OUTSIDE AIR TEMP
ENABLE SETPOINT”.
• The Simplicity Control has a demand for cooling
operation.
If the duct static pressure is equal to or greater than the
“DUCT PRESSURE SHUTDOWN SETPOINT” the
Unit Controller will turn off all outputs and lockout
until the control is reset.
• If the outdoor air temperature was above the
“ECONOMIZER OUTSIDEAIR TEMPENABLE
SETPOINT” when the cooling cycle was initi-
ated, the Simplicity Control will activate econo-
mizer operation when the outdoor air temperature
is 1.0° F below the “ECONOMIZER OUTSIDE
AIR TEMP ENABLE SETPOINT”.
ECONOMIZER
Economizer is used in the cooling mode only. As soon
as the unit switches into Occupied or Unoccupied
Cooling and the conditions are within the programmed
guidelines for economizer operation the Simplicity
Control will attempt to use outdoor air to lower the
supply air temperature to the active economizer set
point. The Simplicity Control can be configured to use
the following economizer control methods:
The economizer will become inactive and eliminate the
use of outdoor air for cooling when:
• The outside air temperature is 1.0° F greater than
the “ECONOMIZER OUTSIDE AIR TEMP EN-
ABLE SETPOINT”.
• The Simplicity Control does not have an Occu-
pied or Unoccupied cooling demand.
• Dry Bulb
• Single Enthalpy
• Dual Enthalpy
JOHNSON CONTROLS
76
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
Single Enthalpy
Dual Enthalpy
The following parameters must be programmed to allow
economizer operation:
The following parameter must be programmed to allow
economizer operation:
“ECONOMIZER OUTSIDE AIR ENTHALPY
SETPOINT” – must be programmed using Parameter
37 under the PROGRAM key on the Simplicity control
board or under the ECONOMIZER/EXHAUST tab in
the Simplicity PC software package.
“RETURN AIR HUMIDITY SENSOR INSTALLED”
– must be enabled using Parameter 38 under the
PROGRAM key on the Simplicity control board or
under the EQUIPMENT INSTALLATION tab in the
Simplicity PC software package.
“OUTSIDE AIR HUMIDITY SENSOR INSTALLED”
– must be enabled using Parameter 36 under the
PROGRAM key on the Simplicity control board or
under the EQUIPMENT INSTALLATION tab in the
Simplicity PC software package.
“DIFFERENTIALENTHALPYMODEENABLED”must
be turned ON under the ECONOMIZER/EXHAUST tab
in the Simplicity PC software package.
The economizer will become active and use outdoor air
for cooling when:
The economizer will become active and use outdoor air
for cooling when:
• The outside air enthalpy is 1.0 BTU/LB less then
the return air enthalpy.
• The outside air enthalpy is less then or equal to
the “ECONOMIZER OUTSIDE AIR ENTHALPY
SETPOINT”.
• The Simplicity Control has a demand for cooling
operation.
• The Simplicity Control has a demand for cooling
The economizer will become inactive and eliminate the
use of outdoor air for cooling when:
operation.
• If the outdoor air enthalpy was above the
“ECONOMIZER OUTSIDE AIR ENTHALPY
SETPOINT” when the cooling cycle was initiated
the Simplicity Control will activate economizer
operation when the outdoor air enthalpy is 1.0
BTU/LB below the “ECONOMIZER OUTSIDE
AIR ENTHALPY SETPOINT”.
• The outside air enthalpy is equal to or greater
5
than the return air enthalpy.
• The Simplicity Control does not have an Occu-
pied or Unoccupied cooling demand.
BAS ECONOMIZER OPERATION
The economizer will become inactive and eliminate the
use of outdoor air for cooling when:
This feature allows the outdoor/return air damper to be
controlled by an external 2 to 10 VDC input.
• The outside air enthalpy is 1.0 BTU/LB greater
than the “ECONOMIZER OUTSIDE AIR
ENTHALPY SETPOINT”.
The following parameters must be programmed to allow
BAS ECONOMIZER OPERATION:
“ECONOMIZER INSTALLED” - must be disabled using
Parameter32underthePROGRAMkeyontheSimplicity
Control board or under the ECONOMIZER/EXHAUST
tab in the Simplicity PC software package.
• The Simplicity Control does not have an Occu-
pied or Unoccupied cooling demand.
JOHNSON CONTROLS
77
Sequence of Operation
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
“OUTSIDE AIR HUMIDITY SENSOR INSTALLED”
- must be disabled using Parameter 36 under the
PROGRAM key on the Simplicity Control board or
under the EQUIPMENT INSTALLATION tab in the
Simplicity PC software package.
“ECONOMIZER SECOND STAGE SETPOINT”
– must be programmed using Parameter 34 under
the PROGRAM key on the Simplicity control board
or under the ECONOMIZER/EXHAUST tab in the
Simplicity PC software package.
“RETURN AIR HUMIDITY SENSOR INSTALLED”
- must be disabled using Parameter 38 under the
PROGRAM key on the Simplicity Control board or
under the EQUIPMENT INSTALLATION tab in the
Simplicity PC software package.
The Simplicity Control will try to modulate the outdoor
air damper and the compressors to maintain the supply
air temperature to +/- 1.0° F of the following set points
based on the method of control:
• With a Y1 input from a thermostat the Simplic-
ity Control will use the “ECONOMIZER FIRST
STAGE SETPOINT”.
“THIRD PARTY BAS ECONOMIZER INSTALLED”
must be enabled using Parameter 58 under the
PROGRAM key on the Simplicity Control board or
under the EQUIPMENT INSTALLATION tab in the
Simplicity PC software package.
• With a Y2, Y3, or Y4 input from a thermostat the
Simplicity Control will use the “ECONOMIZER
SECOND STAGE SETPOINT”.
• When the space temperature is 1.5° F to 1.9°
F above the “CV OCCUPIED COOLING
SETPOINT” or “CV UNOCCUPIED COOLING
SETPOINT” the Simplicity Control will use the
“ECONOMIZER FIRST STAGE SETPOINT”.
In order to use this feature a 2 to 10 VDC external signal
must be sent to the unit through the “BAS ECON +”
and “BAS ECON -” connections on the Unit Control
board.
Sequence of Operation
• When the space temperature is 2.0° F above the
“CV OCCUPIED COOLING SETPOINT” or
“CV UNOCCUPIED COOLING SETPOINT”
the Simplicity Control will use the “ECONO-
MIZER SECOND STAGE SETPOINT”.
The Unit Controller sends the 2 to 10 VDC input signal
directly to the analog output terminals “ECO +” and
“ECO -” to the damper actuator. A 2 VDC input from
the external source will result in a 2 VDC signal to the
damper actuator.
Variable Air Volume Economizer Set Point
If voltage is applied to the “BAS ECON
+” and “BAS ECON -” terminals be-
fore “THIRD PARTY BAS ECONO-
MIZER INSTALLED” is enabled the
Unit Controller can be damaged.
The Simplicity Control will try to modulate the outdoor
air damper and the compressors to maintain the supply
air temperature to +/- 1.0° F of the following set points
based on the method of control:
• With aY1 input from a thermostat the Simplicity
Control will use the “VAV COOLING SUPPLY
AIR TEMP UPPER SETPOINT”.
Constant Volume Economizer Set Point
The following parameter must be programmed to allow
economizer operation:
• With a Y2, Y3, or Y4 input from a thermostat the
Simplicity Control will use the “VAV COOLING
SUPPLY AIR TEMP LOWER SETPOINT”.
“ECONOMIZER FIRST STAGE SETPOINT” – must be
programmed using Parameter 33 under the PROGRAM
key on the Simplicity control board or under the
ECONOMIZER/EXHAUST tab in the Simplicity PC
software package.
• When the space temperature is less then 2.0°
F above the “VAV SUPPLY AIR TEMP RESET
SETPOINT” the Simplicity Control will use the
“VAV COOLING SUPPLY AIR TEMP UPPER
SETPOINT”.
JOHNSON CONTROLS
78
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
• When the space temperature is equal to or greater
than 2.0° F above the “VAV SUPPLY AIR TEMP
RESET SETPOINT” the Simplicity Control will
use the “VAV COOLING SUPPLY AIR TEMP
LOWER SETPOINT”.
• As long as the supply air temperature is 5.1° F
below the economizer set point and the Econo-
mizer PI output is low (damper at minimum
position setting) the Simplicity Control will turn
off compressors every 3-minutes until all the
compressor have been turned off.
Economizer / Compressor Operation
Economizer PI Loop (Proportional and Integral)
The Simplicity Control will use outdoor air without
compressor operation when the following is true:
The Simplicity Control uses a proportional and integral
logic (PI loop) to control the operation of the damper
actuator. The Simplicity Control monitors the change
in the supply air temperature to the economizer set point
verses changes to the output to the damper actuator.
When the supply air temperature is more then 2.0° F
from the economizer set point the Simplicity Control
will change the output to the economizer damper 1%
every 2 seconds. If the supply air temperature is within
+/- 2.0° F of the economizer set point the Simplicity
Control will change the output to the economizer
damper 0.5% every 2 seconds.
• Economizer is active.
• The outdoor air temperature is equal to or less
then the economizer set point.
The Simplicity Control will use outdoor air with
compressor operation when the following is true:
• Economizer is active.
• The outdoor air temperature is above the econo-
mizer set point.
ECONOMIZER LOADING
When outdoor air and compressor operation is available
the compressors operation will be controlled as
follows:
Economizer Loading is a programmable option that
can be used to place an artificial load on the unit to
prevent cycling a compressor off when the supply
air temperature approaches the “SUPPLY AIR TEMP
LIMIT COOLING SETPOINT”.
• If the supply air temperature is 5.1° F or more
above the economizer set point and the Econo-
mizer PI output is saturated (100%) the Simplic-
ity Control will turn on a compressor and start a
3 minute timer.
5
The following System Parameter must be
programmed:
• If after 3-minutes the temperature is still 5.1° F
above the economizer set point and the Econo-
mizer PI output is saturated (100%) the Simplic-
ity Control will bring on a second compressor and
start a three minute timer.
“ECONOMIZER LOADING ENABLE” – must be
enabled under the COOLING SETUP tab in the
Simplicity PC software package.
“SUPPLY AIR TEMP LIMIT COOLING SETPOINT”
must be programmed using the COOLING SETUP tab
in the Simplicity PC software package.
• This sequence would continue until all the com-
pressors on.
• If after the 3-minute timing the supply air tem-
perature is within +/- 5.0° F of the economizer
set point no change will be made to the number
of compressors operating.
“SUPPLY AIR TEMP LIMIT FOR COOLING” must
be enabled using the COOLING SETUP tab in the
Simplicity PC software package.
• If after the 3-minute timing the supply air tem-
perature is 5.1° F or more below the economizer
set point and the Economizer PI output is low
(dampers at the minimum position setting) the
Simplicity Control will turn off a compressor.
JOHNSON CONTROLS
79
Sequence of Operation
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
Constant Volume
• The unit must be configured as a Variable Air
Volume unit.
• The unit must be in an occupied or unoccupied
The following conditions must be met in order for
Economizer Loading to function:
cooling mode.
The sequence of operation is as follows:
• The outdoor air temperature must be greater than
the return air temperature.
• When the supply air temperature is 5.1° F less
than the “VAV COOLING SUPPLY TEMP UP-
PER SAT SETPOINT” or “VAV COOLING
SUPPLY AIR TEMP LOWER SETPOINT” the
economizer damper will start to open.
• Economizer must be installed but not active.
• A call for first stage compressor operation only
• The unit must be configured as a Constant Volume
unit.
• If the economizer damper opens 100% and the
supply air temperature is still 5.1° F less than
the “VAV COOLING SUPPLY TEMP UPPER
SAT SETPOINT” or “VAV COOLING SUPPLY
AIR TEMP LOWER SETPOINT” the Simplicity
Control will turn off the compressor close the
economizer damper to its minimum position.
• The unit must be in an occupied or unoccupied
cooling mode.
The sequence of operation is as follows:
• When the supply air temperature is 0.1° F less
than the “SUPPLY AIR TEMP LIMIT COOLING
SETPOINT” the economizer damper will start to
open.
• When the supply air temperature is between
“VAV COOLING SUPPLY TEMP UPPER SAT
SETPOINT” and the “VAV COOLING SUPPLY
TEMP UPPER SAT SETPOINT” plus 5.0° F
the economizer damper movement will stop and
maintain the current position.
• If the economizer damper opens 100% and the
supply air temperature is still 0.1° F less than
the “SUPPLY AIR TEMP LIMIT COOLING
SETPOINT” the Simplicity Control will turn off
the compressor per the Excessive SAT sequence
and close the economizer damper to its minimum
position.
• When the supply air temperature is between
“VAV COOLING SUPPLY TEMP LOWER SAT
SETPOINT” and the “VAV COOLING SUPPLY
TEMP LOWER SAT SETPOINT” plus 7.0° F
the economizer damper movement will stop and
maintain the current position.
• When the supply air temperature is between
“SUPPLY AIR TEMP LIMIT COOLING
SETPOINT” and the “SUPPLY AIR TEMP
LIMIT COOLING SETPOINT” plus 5.0° F the
economizer damper movement will stop and
maintain the current position.
• When the supply air temperature is equal to 5.1°
F or more above the “VAV COOLING SUPPLY
TEMP UPPER SAT SETPOINT” and 5 minutes
has expired since the economizer damper started
to open, the economizer damper will close back
to its minimum position and a second compressor
will come on.
• When the supply air temperature is equal to 5.1°
F or more above the “SUPPLY AIR TEMP LIMIT
COOLING SETPOINT” the economizer damper
will close back to its minimum position.
• When the supply air temperature is equal to 7.1°
F or more above the “VAV COOLING SUPPLY
TEMP LOWER SAT SETPOINT” and 5 minutes
has expired since the economizer damper started
to open, the economizer damper will close back
to its minimum position and a second compressor
will come on.
Variable Air Volume
The following conditions must be met in order for
Economizer Loading to function:
• The outdoor air temperature must be greater than
the return air temperature.
• Economizer must be installed but not active.
• A call for first stage compressor operation only.
JOHNSON CONTROLS
80
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
COMFORT VENTILATION
The following parameters must be programmed:
“COMFORT VENTILATION FOR COOLING
ENABLED” - must be enabled under the COOLING
SETUP tab in the Simplicity PC software package.
Comfort Ventilation is a Constant Volume control
mode that uses the economizer to control the supply
air temperature. When outdoor air conditions allow,
the economizer will modulate the outside / return air
mix to keep supply air temperatures within the upper
and lower Comfort Ventilation set points. The control
will modulate the economizer, and energize cooling or
heating if necessary, to keep the supply air temperature
within the Comfort Ventilation set points, even though
the space temperature requirements are satisfied.
“COMFORT VENTILATION FOR HEATING
ENABLED” - must be enabled under the HEATING
SETUP tab in the Simplicity PC software package.
“COMFORT VENTILATION UPPER SETPOINT” -
must be programmed under the COOLING SETUP or
HEATING SETUP tab in the Simplicity PC software
package.
The following criteria must be present in order for
Comfort Ventilation to function”:
“COMFORT VENTILATION LOWER SETPOINT” -
must be programmed under the COOLING SETUP or
HEATING SETUP tab in the Simplicity PC software
package.
• The unit can not be in an active heating or cooling
mode.
• The unit must have an economizer installed.
• The unit must be in the occupied mode.
• The unit should be placed in the continuous in-
door fan operation mode.
• The unit type must be Constant Volume.
TABLE 5-4 OPERATION DURING OFF CYCLE
OAT VS OAT COMFORT ZONE SAT VS SAT COMFORT ZONE ECON OPERATION HEAT STAGE COMP STAGE
BELOW
BELOW
BELOW
ABOVE
ABOVE
ABOVE
WITHIN
WITHIN
WITHIN
ABOVE
BELOW
WITHIN
ABOVE
BELOW
WITHIN
ABOVE
BELOW
WITHIN
OPEN
-
-
-
TURN ON
5
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
TURN ON
OPEN
-
-
-
-
-
-
OPEN
OPEN
-
TABLE 5-5 COMPRESSOR ON WHEN SPACE INPUT SATISFIED
OAT VS OAT COMFORT ZONE SAT VS SAT COMFORT ZONE ECON OPERATION HEAT STAGE COMP STAGE
BELOW
BELOW
BELOW
ABOVE
ABOVE
ABOVE
WITHIN
WITHIN
WITHIN
ABOVE
BELOW
WITHIN
ABOVE
BELOW
WITHIN
ABOVE
BELOW
WITHIN
OPEN
-
TURN OFF
TURN OFF
TURN OFF
LEAVE ON
LEAVE ON*
LEAVE ON
TURN OFF
TURN OFF
TURN OFF
-
TURN ON
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
OPEN
-
OPEN
OPEN
-
* If the economizer damper opens to 100%, the compressor will turn off and the economizer damper will remain
at 100%.
JOHNSON CONTROLS
81
Sequence of Operation
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
TABLE 5-6 HEAT STAGE ON WHEN SPACE INPUT SATISFIED
OAT VS OAT COMFORT ZONE SAT VS SAT COMFORT ZONE ECON OPERATION HEAT STAGE COMP STAGE
BELOW
BELOW
BELOW
ABOVE
ABOVE
ABOVE
WITHIN
WITHIN
WITHIN
ABOVE
BELOW
WITHIN
ABOVE
BELOW
WITHIN
ABOVE
BELOW
WITHIN
OPEN
LEAVE ON*
LEAVE ON
LEAVE ON
TURN OFF
TURN OFF
TURN OFF
TURN OFF
TURN OFF
TURN OFF
-
-
-
-
-
-
TURN ON
OPEN
-
-
-
-
-
-
OPEN
OPEN
-
EXCESSIVE SAT (SUPPLY AIR TEMPERATURE)
CONTROL
Sequence of Operation
Tables 5-4 thru 5-6 use the following definitions:
This feature is only available on Constant Volume
units. On a Constant Volume unit, the compressors
and heat stages are control by the space temperature
only, either by thermostat or zone sensor. As long as
the room device is calling for cooling or heating the
compressors or heating section does not control the
actual temperature of the supply air leaving the unit.
The enabling of this feature adds a means to prevent low
or high supply air temperatures from being delivered to
the conditioned space.
• SAT COMFORT ZONE – the temperature be-
tween the “COMFORT VENTILATION LOWER
SETPOINT” minus 1.0° F and the “COMFORT
VENTILATION UPPER SETPOINT” plus 1.0°
F.
• OAT COMFORT ZONE - the temperature be-
tween the “COMFORT VENTILATION LOWER
SETPOINT” and the “COMFORT VENTILA-
TION UPPER SETPOINT”.
• OAT – Outdoor Air Temperature.
• SAT – Supply Air Temperature.
Cooling
• ECON OPERATION – Economizer damper will
open to BRING SAT into the SAT COMFORT
ZONE.
The following System Parameters must be
programmed:
“SUPPLY AIR TEMP LIMIT FOR COOLING
ENABLED”- must be enabled using Parameter 14 under
the PROGRAM key on the Simplicity control board or
under the COOLING SETUP tab in the Simplicity PC
software package.
Conditions of Operation
• In order for compressor operation “COMFORT
VENTILATION FOR COOLING ENABLED”
must be enabled.
“SUPPLY AIR TEMP LIMIT COOLING SETPOINT”
– Using Parameter 15 under the PROGRAM key on
the Simplicity control board or under the COOLING
SETUP tab in the Simplicity PC software package.
• In order for heat stages to operate “COMFORT
VENTILATION FOR HEATING ENABLED”
must be enabled.
• Economizer operation will occur with either, or
both, “COMFORT VENTILATION FOR COOL-
ING ENABLED” or “COMFORT VENTILA-
TION FOR HEATING ENABLED” enabled.
If a single compressor is energized the control will
monitor the supply air temperature and respond as
follows:
JOHNSON CONTROLS
82
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
• The Simplicity Control will monitor the supply
air temperature and compare it to the “SUPPLY
AIR TEMP LIMIT COOLING SETPOINT”. If
the supply air temperature is 0.1° F or more below
this value and the compressor minimum run time
requirement has been met the Simplicity Control
will turn off the compressor.
• The Simplicity Control will continue to turn
off compressors every 3 minutes until the sup-
ply air temperature is equal to or greater than
the “SUPPLY AIR TEMP LIMIT COOLING
SETPOINT”.
• If after 10 minutes the supply air temperature
is equal to or greater than the “SUPPLY AIR
TEMP LIMIT COOLING SETPOINT” plus 5.1°
F the Simplicity Control will turn the staged off
compressor(s) back on provided there is still a
demand for the use of the staged off compres-
sor.
• The Simplicity Control then starts a 10-minute
timer.
• If after 10 minutes the supply air temperature is
equal to or greater than the “SUPPLY AIR TEMP
LIMIT COOLING SETPOINT” plus 5.1° F the
Simplicity Control will turn the compressor back
on provided there is still a demand for the staged
off compressor.
• If after 10 minutes the supply air temperature is
not less than the “SUPPLY AIR TEMP LIMIT
COOLING SETPOINT” plus 5.1° F the Simplic-
ity Control will keep the compressor(s) off until
the supply air temperature is equal to or greater
than the “SUPPLY AIR TEMP LIMIT COOLING
SETPOINT” plus 5.1° F. The Simplicity Control
will then turn the compressor(s) back on provided
there is still a demand for the staged off compres-
sor.
• If after 10 minutes the supply air temperature is
not less than the “SUPPLY AIR TEMP LIMIT
COOLING SETPOINT” plus 5.1° F Simplic-
ity Control will keep the compressor off until
the supply air temperature is equal to or greater
than the “SUPPLY AIR TEMP LIMIT COOLING
SETPOINT” plus 5.1° F. The Simplicity Control
will then turn the compressor back on provided
there is still a demand for the staged off compres-
sor.
Heating
The following System Parameters must be
programmed:
If multiple compressors are energized the control will
monitor the supply air temperature and respond as
follows:
5
“SUPPLY AIR TEMP LIMIT FOR HEATING
ENABLED”- must be enabled using Parameter 16 under
the PROGRAM key on the Simplicity control board or
under the HEATING SETUP tab in the Simplicity PC
software package.
• The Simplicity Control will monitor the supply
air temperature and compare it to the “SUPPLY
AIR TEMP LIMIT COOLING SETPOINT”. If
the supply air temperature is 0.1° F or more below
this value and the compressor minimum run time
requirement has been met the Simplicity Control
will turn off the compressor with the shortest run
time.
“SUPPLY AIR TEMP LIMIT HEATING SETPOINT”
– Using Parameter 17 under the PROGRAM key on the
Simplicity control board or under the HEATING SETUP
tab in the Simplicity PC software package.
• The Simplicity Control starts a 10 minute and 3
If a single heat stage is on the control will monitor the
supply air temperature and respond as follows:
minute timing sequence.
• If after 3 minutes, the supply air temperature
is still 0.1° F below the “SUPPLY AIR TEMP
LIMIT COOLING SETPOINT” the control will
turn off the next compressor with the shortest run
time.
• The Simplicity Control will monitor the supply
air temperature and compare it to the “SUPPLY
AIR TEMP LIMIT HEATING SETPOINT”. If the
supply air temperature is 0.1° F or more above
this value and the heat stage minimum run time
has been met the Simplicity Control will turn off
the heat stage.
JOHNSON CONTROLS
83
Sequence of Operation
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
• The Simplicity Control then starts a 3 minute
• If after 10 minutes the supply air temperature
is still greater than the “SUPPLY AIR TEMP
LIMIT HEATING SETPOINT” minus 10.1° F the
Simplicity Control will keep the heat stage(s) off
until the supply air temperature is equal to or less
than the “SUPPLY AIR TEMP LIMIT HEATING
SETPOINT” minus 10.1° F. The Simplicity Con-
trol will turn the heat stage(s) back on provided
there is still a demand for the staged off heat
stage.
timer.
• If after 3 minutes the supply air temperature is
equal to or less than the “SUPPLY AIR TEMP
LIMIT HEATING SETPOINT” minus 10.1° F the
Simplicity Control will turn the heat stage back
on provided there is still a demand for the staged
off heat stage.
• If after 3 minutes the supply air temperature is
not equal to or less than the “SUPPLY AIR TEMP
LIMIT HEATING SETPOINT” minus 10.1° F the
Simplicity Control will keep the heat section off
until the supply air temperature is equal to or less
than the “SUPPLY AIR TEMP LIMIT HEATING
SETPOINT” minus 10.1° F. The Simplicity Con-
trol will turn the heat stage back on provided there
is still a demand for the staged off heat stage.
SPACE SENSOR WITH SET POINT ADJUSTMENT
A space sensor with a 20 K ohm slide potentiometer
can be used to reset the Occupied Cooling and Heating
set points.
In addition to the use of a space sensor with the
slide potentiometer the following parameter must be
programmed:
If multiple heat stages are on the control will monitor
the supply air temperature and respond as follows:
“SPACE TEMPERATURE OFFSET RANGE” – The
offset range must be programmed using Parameter
56 under the PROGRAM key on the Simplicity Elite
control board or under the SYSTEMS OPTIONS tab
in the Simplicity Elite software package.
• The Simplicity Control will monitor the supply
air temperature and compare it to the “SUPPLY
AIR TEMP LIMIT HEATING SETPOINT”. If the
supply air temperature is 0.1° F or more above
this value and the heat stage minimum run time
requirement has been met the Simplicity Control
will turn off the heat section with the shortest run
time.
Sequence of Operation
As the slide potentiometer is moved the Occupied
Cooling and Heating set point is changed based on
the programmed “SPACE TEMPERATURE OFFSET
RANGE”. The “SPACE TEMPERATURE OFFSET
RANGE” can be set from 0 to 5.0° F. For example,
if the “SPACE TEMPERATURE OFFSET RANGE”
is programmed for 3.0° F and the resistance of the
potentiometer is lowered the Cooling and Heating set
points would be lowered up to 3.0° F. If the resistance
is increased the Cooling and Heating set points would
be increased up to 3.0° F.
• The Simplicity Control starts a 3 minute and
30 second timing sequence. If after 30 seconds
the supply air temperature is still 0.1° F above
the “SUPPLY AIR TEMP LIMIT HEATING
SETPOINT”, the control will turn off the next
heat stage with the shortest run time.
• The Simplicity Control will continue to turn off
heat stages every 30 seconds until the supply air
temperature is equal to or less than the “SUPPLY
AIR TEMP LIMIT HEATING SETPOINT”.
• If after 10 minutes the supply air temperature is
equal to or less than the “SUPPLY AIR TEMP
LIMIT HEATING SETPOINT” minus 10.1° F
the Simplicity Control will turn the heat stage(s)
back on provided there is still a demand for the
use of the staged off heat stage.
JOHNSON CONTROLS
84
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
SPACE SENSOR FAULT OVERRIDE ENABLE
The following parameter must be enabled in order to
use to feature:
The Unit Controller will self configure when it identifies
a space sensor has been installed. Once it identifies that
a space sensor is connected, if the input is then removed
the control will generate a Space Temperature Sensor
Alarm (19). When this occurs the unit will continue to
operate and will use the return air temperature input
in place of the space sensor. If the “SPACE SENSOR
FAULT OVERRIDE ENABLE” is turned on, the Alarm
is removed and the unit will continue to use the return
air temperature input until the space sensor input is
within range and “SPACE SENSOR FAULT OVERRIDE
ENABLE” has been turned off.
“REMOTE CONTROL INPUT ENABLE FOR THIRD
PARTY BAS” must be enabled using Parameter 22 under
the PROGRAM key of the Simplicity Elite control board
or under the SYSTEMS OPTIONS tab of the Simplicity
PC software package.
Sequence of Operation
The Simplicity Elite control will vary the active cooling
set point per the following:
• Reset voltage less than 1.5 volts DC – No com-
“SPACE SENSOR FAULT OVERRIDE ENABLE”
is enabled using parameter 8 under the PROGRAM
key of the Simplicity Elite control board or under the
SYSTEMS OPTIONS tab of the Simplicity software
package.
pressor operation.
• Reset voltage 1.5 to 2.0 volts DC - “VAV
COOLING SUPPLY AIR TEMP LOWER
SETPOINT”.
• Reset voltage 10.0 volts DC - “VAV COOLING
Sequence of Operation
SUPPLY AIR TEMP UPPER SETPOINT”.
• Reset voltage between 2.0 and 10.0 volts DC
– linearly between the “VAV COOLING SUP-
PLY AIR TEMP LOWER SETPOINT” and
“VAV COOLING SUPPLY AIR TEMP UPPER
SETPOINT”.
When the unit is configured as a Constant Volume unit
with space sensor the Simplicity Control will use the
same logic for controlling compressors, economizer,
and heating that it would use with a space sensor but
uses the return air temperature input instead of the
space sensor.
5
• The hard wired input is connected to the Sim-
plicity Elite control board at the “REM+” and
“REM-“ terminals of the P19 connector.
When unit is configured for VAV with space sensor,
the Simplicity Elite control will use the return air
temperature in place of the space sensor to reset between
the “VAV COOLING SUPPLY AIR TEMP UPPER
SETPOINT” and the “VAV COOLING SUPPLY AIR
TEMP LOWER SETPOINT” based on the return air
temperature in relation to the “VAV SUPPLY AIR TEMP
RESET SETPOINT”.
REDLINE
The feature can be used to temporally reduce the
electrical consumption of the unit by reducing the
number of compressor that are turned on. This feature is
only available as a communicated input to the Simplicity
Elite control. The BACnet name is SET_REDLINE and
the BACnet instance number is BV12. For Modbus use
address (HEX) 41L, address (DEC) 65L Bit 0.
REMOTE CONTROL
This feature can be used on a VAV unit to send a
hardwired 0 to 10 volts signal to the unit to vary the
supply air temperature set point between the “VAV
COOLING SUPPLY AIR TEMP LOWER SETPOINT”
and “VAV COOLING SUPPLY AIR TEMP UPPER
SETPOINT”. This feature will only work on a VAV
unit with space sensor control.
Sequence of Operation
If three or more compressors are energized when the
Simplicity Elite control receives this command the
Simplicity Control will turn off compressor number
3 and 4 if energized even if the minimum run time
requirement has not been met.
JOHNSON CONTROLS
85
Sequence of Operation
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
The Simplicity Elite control will keep the compressors
off line for 5 minutes. After 5 minutes, the Simplicity
Elite control will turn the compressor back on with a 30
second delay between compressors and resume normal
operation.
In order to use this feature a pressure switch must be
installed and the feature enabled. To enable the dirty
filter feature.
“DIRTY FILTER SWITCH INSTALLED” – must be
enabled using Parameter 51 under the PROGRAM
key of the Simplicity Elite control board or under the
EQUIPMENT INSTALLATION tab in the Simplicity
PC software package.
After 5 minutes Simplicity Elite control will reset this
communicated input back to “OFF” regardless of the
communicated status. To initiate another cycle the
communicated value would have to switch to the low
state “OFF” and then back to the high state “ON”.
Sequence of Operation
LOADSHED
The control monitors the voltage input at terminals
“FILT” at the P22 connector on the Simplicity Elite
control board. If the status goes high, 24 volt input,
for ten minutes the Simplicity Elite control will initiate
an Alarm 23 “Dirty Filter Switch Has Tripped” but the
operation of the unit will continue.
This feature can be used to temporally reduce the
electrical consumption of the unit by turning off all the
active compressors. The feature is only available as a
communicated input to the Simplicity Elite control. The
BACnet name is SET_LOADSHED and the BACnet
instance number is BV13. For Modbus use address
(HEX) 41L, address (DEC) 65L Bit 1.
As soon as the 24-volt input is removed from the input
terminals, the alarm will turn off.
Sequence of Operation
METRIC OPERATION
When this feature is turned on all the temperature data
will be converted to metric.
If compressors are energized when the Simplicity Elite
control receives this command the Simplicity Elite
control will turn off all compressor immediately, even
if the minimum run time requirement has not been met
for the compressor.
The following must be enabled for Metric Operation:
“METRIC OPERATION”- must be enabled using
Parameter 57 under the PROGRAM key on the
Simplicity Elite control board.
The Simplicity Elite control will keep the compressors
off line for 5 minutes. After 5 minutes, the Simplicity
Elite control will turn the compressor back on and
resume normal information. The same compressors that
were running before the Loadshed input was received
will be turned back on with a 30 second delay between
compressors.
INTELLI-START
This feature can be used to energize the heating or
cooling function of the unit to bring the temperature of
the space up to the “CV OCCUPIED COOLING” and
“CV OCCUPIED HEATING” set points prior to the
start of the occupied period.
After 5 minutes, Simplicity Elite control will reset this
communicated input back to “OFF” regardless of the
communicated status. To initiate another cycle the
communicated value would have to switch to the low
state “OFF” and then back to the high state “ON”.
The following parameter must be programmed in order
to use this feature:
DIRTY FILTER
“INTELLI-START OPERATION ENABLE” – must be
enabled under the SYSTEMS OPTIONS tab of the
Simplicity PC software package.
Aadjustable differential pressure switch can be a added
to the unit to monitor the filters and initiate an alarm
when the pressure drop across the filters become greater
than the setting of the switch. When the switch closes,
the alarm will be initiated.
The following criteria must be met for Morning Warm-
up operation:
JOHNSON CONTROLS
86
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
– The Simplicity Elite control will record the
space temperature and how long it takes to
bring the space temperature to the “CV OC-
CUPIED COOLING” set point.
– When the “CV OCCUPIED COO0LING” set
point is reached the Simplicity Elite control
will divide the elapsed time into 5-minute
increments.
• Intelli-Start will only work on a Constant Volume
system using a space sensor.
• Intelli-Start will only work when the internal
scheduling feature is used. It will not work using
a hard wired or communicated Occupied com-
mand.
• Intelli-Start will only function during the first
occupied period of each day.
– The Simplicity Elite control will determine
how many 0.1° F the temperature was above
the “CV OCCUPIED COOLING” set point
Sequence of Operation
– The Simplicity Elite control will then cal-
culate how many 0.1° F were satisfied per
5-minute increment.
First day of heating or cooling operation
• Two hours prior to the start of the occupied period
the Simplicity Control will compare the space
temperature to the “CV OCCUPIED COOLING”
or the “CV OCCUPIED HEATING” set points.
– This number will be recalculated each day.
– The Simplicity Elite control also records the
outdoor temperature when the above calcula-
tions are made.
• Heating operation
– If the space temperature is 1.5° F or more
below the “CV OCCUPIED HEATING” set
point the Simplicity Elite control will stage on
the heat using the normal heating with space
sensor logic.
– The Simplicity Elite control will record the
space temperature and how long it takes to
bring the space temperature to the “CV OC-
CUPIED HEATING” set point.
Subsequent Operation
• Each morning two hours before the scheduled
occupied start time the Simplicity Elite control
looks at the space temperature and the “CV OC-
CUPIED COOLING” and “CV OCCUPIED
HEATING” set points and determines if there is
a need for cooling or heating operation.
• Based on which need is identified the Simplicity
Elite control will calculate the number of 0.1°
F increments the space temperature is from set
point and multiple this value time the previous
days calculation on the number of 0.1° F the unit
can satisfy in 5 minutes. This will determine
how many minutes prior to the beginning of the
occupied period the control will need to start the
heating or cooling operation.
– When the “CV OCCUPIED HEATING” set
point is reached the Simplicity Elite control
will divide the elapsed time into 5-minute
increments.
– The Simplicity Elite control will determine
how many 0.1° F the temperature was below
the “CV OCCUPIED HEATING” set point.
– The Simplicity Elite control will then cal-
culate how many 0.1° F were satisfied per
5-minute increment.
5
• If cooling mode is selected the Simplicity Elite
control will also compare the current outdoor
temperature to the outdoor temperature recorded
during the previous days start up period.
– This number will be recalculated each day.
– The Simplicity Elite control also records the
outdoor temperature when the above calcula-
tions are made.
– If the current outdoor air temperature is
10.0° F or more above the previous day the
Simplicity Elite control will add 5 minutes to
the above calculated recovery time for every
10.0° F difference.
• Cooling operation
– If the space temperature is 1.5° F or more
above the “CV OCCUPIED COOLING” set
point the Simplicity Elite control will stage on
cooling operation using the normal Cooling
with space sensor logic.
JOHNSON CONTROLS
87
Sequence of Operation
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
The following criteria must be met for Morning Warm-
up operation:
• If heating mode is selected the Simplicity Elite
control will also compare the current outdoor
temperature to the outdoor temperature recorded
during the previous start up period.
• Morning Warm-up will only work on a VAV
– If the current outdoor air temperature is 10.0°
F or more below the previous day the Simplic-
ity Elite control will add 5inutes to the above
calculated recovery time for every 10.0° F
difference.
system.
• Morning Warm-up will only work when the in-
ternal scheduling feature is used. It will not work
using a hard wired or communicated Occupied
command.
• The outdoor damper will be kept closed during
this period unless it is being used to meet the oc-
cupied cooling space temperature requirement.
• Morning Warm-up will only function during the
first occupied period of each day.
• Even if the space temperature satisfies the “CV
OCCUPIED COOLING” and “CV OCCUPIED
HEATING” set points the unit will not switch
to the occupied mode until the calculated warm
up / cool down time has expired. However, the
supply fan will remain energized during this
time. If the space temperature rises above the
“CV OCCUPIED COOLING”, or below the “CV
OCCUPIED HEATING” set points during this
time the cooling or heating will cycle back on.
Sequence of Operation
• One hour before the beginning of the occupied
period the Simplicity Elite control will energize
the supply fan circuit.
• The Simplicity Elite control will keep the econo-
mizer damper closed.
• After 5 minutes of supply fan operation the Sim-
plicity Elite control will compare the return air
temperature to the “MORNING WARM-UP/VAV
RETURN AIR TEMP SETPOINT”.
MORNING WARM-UP
• If the return air temperature is 2.0° F or more
below the “MORNING WARM-UP/VAVRETURN
AIR TEMP SETPOINT” the Simplicity Elite
control will energize all the available heat.
This feature can be used to energize the heating section
of the unit to bring the temperature of the space up to
conditions prior to the start of the occupied period.
• If the return air temperature is not 2.0° F or
more below the “MORNING WARM-UP/VAV
RETURN AIR TEMP SETPOINT” the Simplicity
Elite control will continue supply fan operation
while continuing to monitor the return air tem-
perature.
The following parameters must be programmed in order
to use this feature:
“MORNING WARM-UP ENABLE” – must be enabled
using Parameter 28 under the PROGRAM key of the
Simplicity Elite control board or under the HEATING
SETUP tab of the Simplicity PC software package.
• When the return air temperature is equal to or
above the “MORNING WARM-UP/VAV RE-
TURN AIR TEMP SETPOINT” heating operation
will be de-energized.
“MORNING WARM-UP/VAV RETURN AIR TEMP
SETPOINT” - must be programmed using Parameter
29 under the PROGRAM key of the Simplicity Elite
control board or under the HEATING SETUP tab of
the Simplicity PC software package.
• During this time the heat will cycle on and off
based on the comparison of the return air tem-
perature to the “MORNING WARM-UP/VAV
RETURN AIR TEMP SETPOINT”.
“HEATING MODE ENABLED FOR OPERATION”
– must be enabled using Parameter 54 under the
PROGRAM key of the Simplicity Elite control board
or under the HEATING SETUP tab of the Simplicity
PC software package.
• After one hour of operation the Simplicity Elite
control will go into the Occupied mode and open
the economize to the minimum position.
• Heating operation will continue until the return
air temperature is equal to or above the “MORN-
ING WARM-UP/VAV RETURN AIR TEMP
SETPOINT”.
JOHNSON CONTROLS
88
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
HYDRONIC HEAT
The following parameters must be programmed to use
Hydronic Heat:
The normal output to the valve is 2 VDC for 0% opening
of the hydronic valve and 10 VDC for 100% opening of
the hydronic valve. If the following is enabled:
“HEATING MODE ENABLED FOR OPERATION”
must be enabled using Parameter 54 under the
PROGRAM key of the Simplicity Elite control board
or under the HEATING SETUP tab in the Simplicity
PC software package.
“HYDRONIC HEAT ACTUATOR VALVE REVERSE
ACTING” must be enabled using Parameter 21 under
the PROGRAM key of the Simplicity Elite control board
or under the HEATING SETUP tab in the Simplicity
PC software package.
“HYDRONIC HEATING ENABLED” must be enabled
using Parameter 18 under the PROGRAM key of the
Simplicity Elite control board or under the HEATING
SETUP tab in the Simplicity PC software package.
Under this condition, the normal output to the valve is
10 VDC for 0% opening of the hydronic valve and 0
VDC for 100% opening of the hydronic valve.
HYDRONIC HEAT FREEZE STAT
“HYDRONIC HEATING STAGE #1 SUPPLY AIR
SETPOINT” must be programmed using Parameter
19 under the PROGRAM key of the Simplicity Elite
control board or under the HEATING SETUP tab in
the Simplicity PC software package.
All hydronic heat units are equipped with a freeze stat
that monitors the temperature of the return air. The
switch action is normally closed and opens when the
return air temperature is less the 40.0º F. The 24 VAC
signal to the freeze stat originates at terminal FSP on
the control board. The 24 VAC input from the freeze
stat enters the control at the FSI terminal.
“HYDRONIC HEATING STAGE #2 SUPPLY AIR
SETPOINT” must be programmed using Parameter
20 under the PROGRAM key of the Simplicity Elite
control board or under the HEATING SETUP tab in
the Simplicity PC software package.
When the freeze stat input is lost, the Simplicity Control
will send a 10 VDC signal to the valve (direct acting), 2
VDC (reverse acting) to open the valve. The valve will
continue to drive open for 5 minutes, even if the freeze
stat circuit remakes. If the freeze stat circuit closes and
the 5 minute timing has expired, the unit will return to
normal operation.
Sequence of Operation
5
On Constant Volume units whenever there is a call for
the 1st stage of heating operation the Simplicity Elite
control will vary a 2 to 10 VDC output to the hydronic
valve to try and maintain the supply air temperature to
within +/- 1.0° F of the “HYDRONIC HEATING STAGE
#1 SUPPLY AIR SETPOINT”. The output to the valve
can be found at terminal “HWV+” and “HWV-“ at
connector P14 on the Simplicity Elite control board.
If the supply fan is operating and the outdoor damper
is open the Simplicity Control will close the damper
during the above sequence.
VENTILATION
On Constant Volume units whenever there is a call for
the 2nd stage of heating operation the Simplicity Elite
control will vary a 2 to 10 VDC output to the hydronic
valve to try and maintain the supply air temperature to
within +/- 1.0° F of the “HYDRONIC HEATING STAGE
#2 SUPPLY AIR SETPOINT”.
The unit can be ordered / programmed for the following
ventilation options:
• None.
• Manual.
• Fixed Minimum – Economizer option required.
On a VAV unit whenever there is a call for heat the
Simplicity Elite control will vary the 2 to 10 VDC output
to the hydronic valve to try and maintain the supply
air temperature to within 1º F of the “HYDRONIC
HEATING STAGE #2 SUPPLYAIR SETPOINT”
• Demand Ventilation – Economizer option re-
quired.
JOHNSON CONTROLS
89
Sequence of Operation
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
Manual
Demand Ventilation
This option uses a manually adjustable outdoor air
damper that can set in a fixed position to control the
amount of outdoor air that is brought into the building
for ventilation. As long as the supply fan is operative,
ventilation air will be brought into the building. To
adjust the damper:
In this mode the Simplicity Elite control monitors the
CO2 level in the conditioned space. The Simplicity
Elite control modulates the outdoor air damper beyond
the “ECONOMIZER MINIMUM POSITION” in order
to keep the CO2 level within +/- 100 PPM of the “IAQ
SETPOINT”.
In order to use this feature a CO2 sensor must be installed
in the conditioned space and connected to “DV+” and
the “DV-“ terminals of the P20 connector.
• Loosen the wing nut that holds the adjustment
handle in a fixed position.
• Move the handle to the desired position.
• Tighten the wing nut to hold the handle in the
The following parameters must be programmed to
enable Demand Ventilation:
desired position.
“ECONOMIZER INSTALLED” – must be enabled
using Parameter 32 under the PROGRAM key
on the Simplicity Elite control board or under the
ECONOMIZER/EXHAUST tab in the Simplicity PC
software package.
Fixed Minimum
The following parameters must be programmed to
enable Fixed Minimum Ventilation:
“ECONOMIZER INSTALLED” – must be enabled
using Parameter 32 under the PROGRAM key
on the Simplicity Elite control board or under the
ECONOMIZER/EXHAUST tab in the Simplicity PC
software package.
“ECONOMIZER MINIMUM POSITION” – must be
programmed using Parameter 35 under the PROGRAM
key on the Simplicity Elite control board or under the
ECONOMIZER/EXHAUST tab in the Simplicity PC
software package.
“ECONOMIZER MINIMUM POSITION” – must be
programmed using Parameter 35 under the PROGRAM
key on the Simplicity Elite control board or under the
ECONOMIZER/EXHAUST tab in the Simplicity PC
software package.
“DEMAND VENTILATION (IAQ) ENABLED” – must
be enabled using Parameter 40 under the PROGRAM
key of the Simplicity Elite control board or under the
COMFORT / DEMAND VENTILATION tab in the
Simplicity PC software package.
Sequence of Operation
“IAQ SENSOR RANGE” - must be programmed
using Parameter 41 under the PROGRAM key on the
Simplicity Elite control board or under the COMFORT
/ DEMAND VENTILATION tab in the Simplicity PC
software package.
The damper will open to the programmed
“ECONOMIZER MINIMUM POSITION” whenever
the following conditions are met:
“IAQ SETPOINT” - must be programmed using
Parameter 42 under the PROGRAM key on the
Simplicity Elite control board or under the COMFORT
/ DEMAND VENTILATION tab in the Simplicity PC
software package.
• The unit is in the occupied mode.
• There must be a 24-volt output from the Simplic-
ity Elite control to the supply fan control circuit.
The output is contained at the “FAN” terminal
of connector P13 on the Simplicity Elite control
board.
“MAXIMUM IAQ ECONOMIZER POSITION” – must
be programmed under the COMFORT / DEMAND
VENTILATION tab in the Simplicity PC software
package.
• When the economizer becomes active the position
of the dampers are controlled by the Economizer
PI logic which could move the dampers beyond
the “ECONOMIZER MINIMUM POSITION”;
however, the Economizer PI logic can never
close the dampers less then the “ECONOMIZER
MINIMUM POSITION”.
JOHNSON CONTROLS
90
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
Definitions
• If the CO2 level in the conditioned space is
greater then the “IAQ SETPOINT” + 100 PPM
the outdoor air damper will open, but never more
than the “MAXIMUM IAQ ECONOMIZER PO-
SITION”.
“IAQ SENSOR RANGE” –This establishes the span the
Simplicity Elite control uses in PPM. 0 PPM would be
equal to a 0 volts input to the Simplicity Elite control,
“IAQ SENSOR RANGE” would be equal to 10 volts
input to the Simplicity Elite control. The “IAQ SENSOR
RANGE” must match the PPM range of the sensor
installed in the conditioned space.
• If the CO2 level in the conditioned space is less
then the “IAQ SETPOINT” - 100 PPM the out-
door air damper will close, but never less then
the “ECONOMIZER MINIMUM POSITION”.
“IAQ SETPOINT” – This is the conditioned space CO2
level the Simplicity Elite control is trying to maintain.
VENTILATION LOW AMBIENT MINIMUM POSITION
RESET
“MAXIMUM IAQ ECONOMIZER POSITION” – This
is the maximum damper position the Simplicity Elite
control will allow the damper to open while in a Demand
Ventilation mode no matter how great a differential is
between the conditioned space CO2 level and the “IAQ
SETPOINT”.
This feature allows the control to reset the minimum
ventilation set point to a lower value when the outdoor
temperature is cold. This assists in keeper the supply air
temperature from dropping because of a fixed ventilation
requirement when the outdoor temperature drops.
Sequence of Operation
To use this feature the following parameters need to be
programmed:
The damper will open to the programmed
“ECONOMIZER MINIMUM POSITION” whenever
the following conditions are met:
“LOW AMBIENT ECONOMIZER SETPOINT” – this
parameter is programmed under the ECONOMIZER/
EXHAUST tab in the Simplicity PC software
package.
• The unit is in the occupied mode.
• There must be a 24-volt output from the Simplic-
ity Elite control to the supply fan control circuit.
The output is contained at the “FAN” terminal
of connector P13 on the Simplicity Elite control
board.
“LOW AMBIENT ECONOMIZER MINIMUM
POSITION” – this parameter is programmed under
the ECONOMIZER/EXHAUST tab in the Simplicity
PC software package.
5
• When the economizer becomes active the position
of the dampers are controlled by the Economizer
PI logic which could move the dampers beyond
the “ECONOMIZER MINIMUM POSITION”;
however, the Economizer PI logic can never
close the dampers less then the “ECONOMIZER
MINIMUM POSITION”.
Sequence of Operation
When “LOW AMBIENT ECONOMIZER SETPOINT”
is programmed to 0 the feature is disabled. To
use this feature programmed this parameter to the
outdoor temperature at which you want the Simplicity
Elite control to switch to the “LOW AMBIENT
“ECONOMIZER MINIMUM POSITION”. This
parameter can be programmed between 0 and 60.0° F.
If the above criteria are met, the Simplicity Elite control
will then monitor the CO2 level in the conditioned space
and vary the position of the outdoor air damper between
the “ECONOMIZER MINIMUM POSITION” and the
“MAXIMUM IAQ ECONOMIZER POSITION” based
on the following:
The parameter “LOW AMBIENT ECONOMIZER
MINIMUM POSITION” needs to be programmed to the
minimum position of the damper when the temperature
is below the “LOW AMBIENT ECONOMIZER
SETPOINT”. This parameter can be programmed
between 0 and 99%. It would normally be programmed
less then the “ECONOMIZER MINIMUM POSITION”
parameter.
• The Simplicity Elite control will try to maintain
the CO2 level in the conditioned space to +/- 100
PPM of the “IAQ SETPOINT”.
JOHNSON CONTROLS
91
Sequence of Operation
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
When the outdoor temperature is equal to or less than
the “LOW AMBIENT ECONOMIZER SETPOINT” the
Simplicity Elite control will set the minimum position
of the outdoor damper to the programmed “LOW
AMBIENT ECONOMIZER MINIMUM POSITION”
setting.
“ECONOMIZER DAMPER POSITION FOR EXHAUST
FAN TO TURN OFF” – must be programmed
using Parameter 49 under the PROGRAM key
on the Simplicity Elite control board or under the
ECONOMIZER/EXHAUST tab in the Simplicity PC
software package.
When the outdoor temperature is 1.0° F or more above
the “LOW AMBIENT ECONOMIZER SETPOINT” the
Simplicity Control will set the minimum position of the
outdoor damper to the programmed “ECONOMIZER
MINIMUM POSITION” setting.
Sequence of Operation
When the output to the economizer damper is equal
to or greater then the “ECONOMIZER DAMPER
POSITION FOR EXHAUST FAN TO TURN ON” the
Simplicity Elite control closes the output to the exhaust
fan motor. The output is at the “EXH” terminal of the
P13 connector.
EXHAUST FAN OPERATION
The Simplicity Elite control can be configured for the
following types of exhaust fan operation:
When the output to the economizer damper is equal to
or less then the “ECONOMIZER DAMPER POSITION
FOR EXHAUST FAN TO TURN OFF” the Simplicity
Elite control open the output to the exhaust fan motor.
• On/Off Control Based On Outdoor Damper Posi-
tion.
• On/Off Control Based On Building Pressure.
The minimum run time is 10 seconds and the minimum
off time is 60 seconds.
• Modulating Damper with Fixed Speed Ex-
haust.
On/Off Control Based on Building Pressure
• Modulating Exhaust with a VFD.
On/Off Control Based on Outdoor Damper Posi-
tion
This exhaust option uses a standard motor without any
type of speed control and a barometric damper.
The following System Parameters must be programmed
through the Simplicity Elite control:
This exhaust option uses a standard motor without any
type of speed control and a barometric damper.
“POWER EXHAUST INSTALLED” – must be turned
on using Parameter 43 under the PROGRAM key
on the Simplicity Elite control board or under the
ECONOMIZER/EXHAUST tab in the Simplicity PC
software package.
The following System Parameters must be programmed
through the Simplicity Elite control:
“POWER EXHAUST INSTALLED” – must be turned
on using Parameter 43 under the PROGRAM key
on the Simplicity Elite control board or under the
ECONOMIZER/EXHAUST tab in the Simplicity PC
software package.
“BUILDING STATIC PRESSURE SENSOR
INSTALLED” – must be turned on using Parameter 85
under the PROGRAM key on the Simplicity Elite control
board or under the EQUIPMENT INSTALLATION tab
in the Simplicity PC software package.
“ECONOMIZER DAMPER POSITION FOR
EXHAUST FAN TO TURN ON” – must be programmed
using Parameter 48 under the PROGRAM key
on the Simplicity Elite control board or under the
ECONOMIZER/EXHAUST tab in the Simplicity PC
software package.
“BUILDING PRESSURE SETPOINT” must be
programmed using Parameter 31 under the PROGRAM
key on the Simplicity Elite control board or under the
ECONOMIZER/EXHAUST tab in the Simplicity PC
software package.
JOHNSON CONTROLS
92
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
Sequence of Operation
“EXHAUSTDAMPER POSITION FOR EXHAUSTFAN
TO TURN OFF” must be programmed using Parameter
47 under the PROGRAM key on the Simplicity Elite
control board or under the ECONOMIZER/EXHAUST
tab in the Simplicity PC software package.
When the building static pressure is 0.015” WC or more
above the “BUILDING PRESSURE SETPOINT” the
Simplicity Elite control closes the output to the exhaust
fan motor. The output is at the “EXH” terminal of the
P13 connector.
Sequence of Operation
When the building static pressure is 0.015” WC or more
below the “BUILDING PRESSURE SETPOINT” the
Simplicity Elite control opens the output to the exhaust
fan motor.
When the building static pressure is 0.025” WC or more
above the “BUILDING PRESSURE SETPOINT” the
Simplicity Elite control sends a 2 to 10 volt DC signal to
open the exhaust damper. The output is at the “EXD+”
and “EXD-“ terminals at the P14 connector.
The minimum run time is 10 seconds and the minimum
off time is 60 seconds.
Modulating Damper with Fixed Speed Exhaust
When the exhaust damper position is equal to or greater
than the “EXHAUST DAMPER POSITION FOR
EXHAUST FAN TO TURN ON” the Simplicity Elite
control turns on the exhaust fan. The output is at the
“EXH” terminal of the P13 connector.
This exhaust option uses a standard motor without any
type of speed control and a modulating damper.
The following System Parameters must be programmed
through the Simplicity Elite control:
When the building static pressure is 0.025” WC or more
below the “BUILDING PRESSURE SETPOINT” the
Simplicity Elite control lowers the 2 – 10 volt DC output
to the exhaust damper to close the damper.
“POWER EXHAUST INSTALLED” – must be turned
on using Parameter 43 under the PROGRAM key
on the Simplicity Elite control board or under the
ECONOMIZER/EXHAUST tab in the Simplicity PC
software package.
When the exhaust damper position is equal to or less
than the “EXHAUST DAMPER POSITION FOR
EXHAUST FAN TO TURN OFF” the Simplicity Elite
control turns on the exhaust fan.
5
“BUILDING STATIC PRESSURE SENSOR
INSTALLED” – must be turned on using Parameter 85
under the PROGRAM key on the Simplicity Elite control
board or under the EQUIPMENT INSTALLATION tab
in the Simplicity PC software package.
The minimum run time is 20 seconds and the minimum
off time is 60 seconds.
Modulating Exhaust with a VFD
“BUILDING PRESSURE SETPOINT” must be
programmed using Parameter 31 under the PROGRAM
key on the Simplicity Elite control board or under the
ECONOMIZER/EXHAUST tab in the Simplicity PC
software package.
This exhaust option uses a Variable Frequency Drive
(VFD) and a barometric damper.
The following System Parameters must be programmed
through the Simplicity Elite control:
“MODULATING POWER EXHAUST INSTALLED”
must be turned on using Parameter 44 under the
PROGRAM key on the Simplicity Elite control board
or under the ECONOMIZER/EXHAUST tab in the
Simplicity PC software package.
“POWER EXHAUST INSTALLED” – must be turned
on using Parameter 43 under the PROGRAM key
on the Simplicity Elite control board or under the
ECONOMIZER/EXHAUST tab in the Simplicity PC
software package.
“EXHAUSTDAMPER POSITION FOR EXHAUSTFAN
TO TURN ON” must be programmed using Parameter
46 under the PROGRAM key on the Simplicity Elite
control board or under the ECONOMIZER/EXHAUST
tab in the Simplicity PC software package.
JOHNSON CONTROLS
93
Sequence of Operation
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
“BUILDING STATIC PRESSURE SENSOR
INSTALLED” – must be turned on using Parameter 85
under the PROGRAM key on the Simplicity Elite control
board or under the EQUIPMENT INSTALLATION tab
in the Simplicity PC software package.
“PRE-OCCUPANCY PURGE ENABLE” – must be
enabled using the SYSTEM OPTIONS tab in the
Simplicity PC software package.
“PRE-OCCUPANCY PURGE TIME (hours of day)”
– must be programmed using the SYSTEM OPTIONS
tab in the Simplicity PC software package.
“BUILDING PRESSURE SETPOINT” must be
programmed using Parameter 31 under the PROGRAM
key on the Simplicity Elite control board or under the
ECONOMIZER/EXHAUST tab in the Simplicity PC
software package.
“PRE-OCCUPANCY PURGE TIME (minutes of day)”
– must be programmed using the SYSTEM OPTIONS
tab in the Simplicity PC software package.
“EXHAUST VFD INSTALLED” must be turned
on using Parameter 45 under the PROGRAM key
on the Simplicity Elite control board or under the
ECONOMIZER/EXHAUST tab in the Simplicity PC
software package.
Criteria for Operation
• The feature will only work when the internal
scheduling feature is being used to determine
occupied and unoccupied periods.
Sequence of Operation
• The feature will only work on a day that has a
occupied period scheduled.
When the building static pressure is 0.025” WC or more
above the “BUILDING PRESSURE SETPOINT” the
Simplicity Elite control sends a 2 to 10 volt DC signal
to Exhaust Fan VFD, the output is at the “EXD+” and
“EXD-“ terminals at the P14 connector, and enables
the VFD operation through the output at the “EXH”
terminal of the P13 connector. When the exhaust fan
first comes on it will operate at the “Output Frequency
Low Limit” that is programmed into the Exhaust
Van VFD, regardless of the voltage output from the
Simplicity Elite control.
Sequence of Operation
• The programmed “PRE-OCCUPANCY PURGE
TIME” is length of the pre-purge prior to the
start of the occupancy period. For example if
the “PRE-OCCUPANCY PURGE TIME (hours
of day)” is set for 1, the “PRE-OCCUPANCY
PURGE TIME (minutes of day)” is set to 30 and
the occupancy start time is 8:00 AM pre-purge
would start at 6:30 AM and operate until 8:00
AM.
When the building static pressure is 0.025” WC or
more below the “BUILDING PRESSURE SETPOINT”
the Simplicity Elite control lowers the 2 – 10 volt DC
output to the Exhaust Fan VFD. When the output is
equal to or below 2 volts, the Exhaust Fan VFD enable
input is removed.
• While in the pre-purge mode the Simplicity Elite
control will turn on the fan and modulate the
outdoor air damper to 100% as long as the supply
air temperature is between 45.0° F and 90.0° F.
• If the supply air temperature drops below 45.0° F
the control will modulate the outdoor air damper
closed until the supply air temperature rises above
50.0° F.
PRE-OCCUPANCY PURGE
This feature allows the blower to come on and the
economizer damper to open during the unoccupied
period to purge the air within the conditioned space.
• If the supply air temperature rises above 90.0° F
the control will modulate the outdoor air damper
closed unit the supply air temperature falls below
85.0° F.
In order to use this feature the following parameters
must be programmed:
JOHNSON CONTROLS
94
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
ENERGY RECOVERY VENTILATOR
OUTDOOR AIR HEATING LOCKOUT
If the unit has an Energy Recovery Ventilator installed
the exhaust fan needs to operate any time the supply fan
is energized. This feature can be programmed to only
occur in the occupied mode or in both the occupied and
unoccupied mode.
This feature prevents the Simplicity Elite control
from operating in the heating mode when the outdoor
temperature is above this set point.
The set point for this feature is programmed through
the following parameter:
The following parameters must be programmed to use
this feature:
“OUTDOOR AIR TEMP HEATING LOCKOUT” – is
programmed using the HEATING SETUP tab in the
Simplicity PC software package.
“ERV ENABLED” – must be enabled using the
ECONOMIZER/EXHAUST tab of the Simplicity PC
software package.
HOT GAS BYPASS
If you want this feature to operate in the unoccupied
mode the following parameter must be enabled.
Hot gas by pass is used to inject discharge gas into the
expansion valve distributor to artificially place a load on
the evaporator coil under a light load condition. This is
done to raise the suction pressure to keep the saturation
temperature of the refrigerant high enough to prevent
icing of the coil. An auxiliary contact on the condenser
fan, 7M- contactor, energizes the hot gas bypass valve
whenever the contactor is energized. The hot gas valve
monitors the suction pressure and will modulate to keep
the suction pressure above 55 PSIG.
“ERV UNOCCUPIED FAN ENABLED”- must be
enabled using the ECONOMIZER/EXHAUST tab of
the Simplicity PC software package.
Sequence of Operation
In the occupied mode, anytime the supply fan is
energized the exhaust fan will also be turned on.
All VAV units have a hot gas valve installed in the
number 1 compressor system. Hot gas is optional
on CV units. If the lead/lag option is enabled the
Simplicity Elite control needs to know the hot gas
option is installed. This is done through the following
programming parameter.
If “ERV UNOCCUPIED FAN ENABLED” is enabled
the exhaust fan will operate in either the occupied or
unoccupied mode when the supply fan is energized.
5
If the unit has a Exhaust Fan VFD, the output voltage
to the Exhaust Fan VFD will be the same as the voltage
output to the supply fan VFD.
“HOT GAS BY PASS PRESENT ON COMPRESSOR #
1” - must be turned on using Parameter 79 under the
PROGRAM key on the Simplicity Elite control board
or under the COOLING SETUP tab of the Simplicity
PC software.
LOW VOLTAGE PROTECTION
The Simplicity Elite control monitors the 24 VAC
low voltage level. Before the Simplicity Elite control
energizes a binary output to a contactor, it checks this
voltage level. If the voltage is equal to or less than
19.2 volts the control will not energize the output and
will flash an Alarm Code 35. If the voltage rises above
19.2 volts the control will close the output and resume
normal operation.
SPACE TEMPERATURE ALARM
When this feature is enabled, the Simplicity Elite
control monitors the space temperature. When the
space temperature continues to trend above or below
the programmed set point and the programmed time
has expired, the Simplicity Elite control will declare a
Space Temperature Alarm.
If the voltage drops below 16 volts with binary outputs
already energized, the control will open all the binary
outputs to the contactors and flash an Alarm Code 35.
If the voltage rises above 19.2 volts the Simplicity Elite
control will resume normal operation.
JOHNSON CONTROLS
95
Sequence of Operation
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
SAT ALARM FOR HEATING
The following parameters must be programmed:
“SPACE TEMP TRENDING ALARM TEMP”- must
be programmed under SYSTEM OPTIONS tab of the
Simplicity PC software package.
When this feature is turned on, the Simplicity Elite
control monitors the supply air temperature in the
heating mode and will generate an alarm if the supply air
temperature goes below the set point, and if conditions
are met, modifies the amount of ventilation air to keep
the supply air temperature above this set point when all
the heating stages are energized. This feature can only
be used on unit operating in the VAV mode.
“SPACE TEMP TRENDING ALARM TIME”- must
be programmed under SYSTEM OPTIONS tab of the
Simplicity PC software package.
Sequence of Operation
In order to use this feature the following parameter must
be programmed:
• To enable this feature “SPACE TEMP TREND-
ING ALARM TEMP” must be set at other then
zero.
“SUPPLY AIR TEMP ALARM SETPOINT FOR
HEATING” – must be set under the HEATING SETUP
tab of the Simplicity PC software package.
• Set “SPACE TEMP TRENDING ALARM TEMP”
to the number of degrees above or below the
space temperature that you want temperature
trending to begin. The range is 1.0° F to 25.0° F
in 1.0° F increments.
• If “SUPPLY AIR TEMP ALARM SETPOINT
FOR HEATING” is set to zero this feature is dis-
abled. If not set to zero, then the setting becomes
the alarm set point.
• To enable this feature “SPACE TEMP TREND-
ING ALARM TIME” must be set at other then
zero.
• Set “SUPPLY AIR TEMP ALARM SETPOINT
FOR HEATING” to the temperature you want
to use for the Alarm set point. The range is 1.0°
F to 120.0° F in 1.0° F increments.
• Set “SPACE TEMP TRENDING ALARM TIME”
to the amount of time the space temperature must
be trending above or below the “SPACE TEMP
TRENDING ALARM TEMP” before a Space
Temperature Alarm will be initiated. The range
is 1 to 120 minutes in 1 minute increments.
Sequence of Operation
“Supply Air Temp Alarm Setpoint for Heating”
Alarm
• The unit must have been in a given operating
mode for 10 minutes before trending will be-
gin.
• The control will initiate a “SUPPLY AIR TEMP
ALARM FOR HEATING” and flash an Alarm
Code 39 if the following conditions are met:
• Every time the trend moves towards the space
temperature set point the “SPACE TEMP
TRENDING ALARM TIME” will reset to zero
– All the stages of heating have been on for 10
or more minutes.
– The supply air temperature is 20 degrees
below the “SUPPLY AIR TEMP ALARM
SETPOINT FOR HEATING” set point for 10
minutes.
– The outdoor air is not 20.0° F or more cooler
then the “SUPPLY AIR TEMP ALARM
SETPOINT FOR HEATING” set point.
– The outdoor air damper is not open more than
20%
• When the temperature is above or below the
“SPACE TEMP TRENDING ALARM TEMP”
and the trend continues to be away from the space
temperature and the “SPACE TEMP TRENDING
ALARM TIME” has expired, the Simplicity Elite
control will declare a “SPACE TEMPERATURE”
Alarm. The Simplicity Elite control will flash an
Alarm Code 41.
• The Simplicity Elite control will continue normal
operation while in this fault mode.
• The Simplicity Elite control will continue to
show the fault until the space temperature is less
then the “SPACE TEMP TRENDING ALARM
TEMP”.
• In order to reset the above Alarm power to the
unit must be cycled on and off.
JOHNSON CONTROLS
96
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
SAT ALARM FOR COOLING
“Economizer Minimum Position” Alarm
When this feature is turned, on the Simplicity Elite
control monitors the supply air temperature in the
cooling mode and will generate an alarm if the supply air
temperature goes above the set point, and if conditions
are met, modifies the amount of ventilation air to keep
the supply air temperature below this set point when all
the cooling stages are energized. This feature can only
be used on unit operating in the VAV mode.
• The supply air temperature must be below the
“SUPPLY AIR TEMP ALARM SETPOINT FOR
HEATING” set point and the following sequence
of events have occurred:
– All the stages of heating must have been on
for 10 or more minutes.
– The outdoor air is 20.0° F or more cooler then
the “SUPPLY AIR TEMPALARM SETPOINT
FOR HEATING” set point.
In order to use this feature the following parameter must
be programmed:
– The economizer must be open more than
20%.
“SUPPLY AIR TEMP ALARM SETPOINT FOR
COOLING” – must be set under the COOLING SETUP
tab of the Simplicity PC software package.
• If the above criteria is met
– The Simplicity Elite control will close the
outdoor damper for ten minutes.
– After ten minutes, the Simplicity Elite control
will read the supply air temperature.
– If the supply air temperature is above the
“SUPPLY AIR TEMP ALARM SETPOINT
FOR HEATING”, the control will keep the
outdoor damper closed and complete the
heating cycle.
• If “SUPPLY AIR TEMP ALARM SETPOINT
FOR COOLING” is set to zero this feature is
disabled. If not set to zero, then the setting be-
comes the alarm set point.
• Set “SUPPLY AIR TEMP ALARM SETPOINT
FOR COOLING” to the temperature you want
to use for the alarm set point. The range is 1.0°
F to 80.0° F in 1.0° F increments.
∗ The Simplicity Elite control will declare an
“ECONOMIZER MINIMUM POSITION”
Alarm and flash an Alarm Code 40.
5
Sequence of Operation
– If the supply air temperature is not above the
“SUPPLY AIR TEMP ALARM SETPOINT
FOR HEATING”.
“Supply Air Temp Alarm Setpoint for Cooling”
Alarm
∗ The Simplicity Elite control will declare
a “SUPPLY AIR TEMP ALARM FOR
HEATING” Alarm and flash an Alarm
Code 39.
• The control will initiate a “SUPPLY AIR TEMP
ALARM FOR COOLING” and flash an Alarm
Code 38 if the following conditions are met:
– After the heating cycle is completed, the Sim-
plicity Elite control sets the outdoor damper
to its minimum position.
– All the stages of cooling have been on for 10
or more minutes.
– In order to reset the above alarms power to
the unit must be cycled on and off.
– The supply air temperature is 20 degrees
above the “SUPPLY AIR TEMP ALARM
SETPOINT FOR COOLING” set point for
10 minutes.
– The outdoor air is not 20.0° F or more warmer
then the “SUPPLY AIR TEMP ALARM
SETPOINT FOR COOLING” set point.
– The outdoor air damper is not open more than
20%.
• In order to reset the above alarm power to the
unit must be cycled on and off.
JOHNSON CONTROLS
97
Sequence of Operation
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
ALARM HISTORY
“Economizer Minimum Position” Alarm
The last five alarms can be view on the Simplicity Elite
control board as follows. The sequence below gives the
alarms from the most recent to the oldest.
• The supply air temperature must be above the
“SUPPLY AIR TEMP ALARM SETPOINT FOR
COOLING” set point and the following sequence
of events have occurred:
Alarm 1 – The most recent alarm can be viewed
under Parameter 72 using the PROGRAM key on the
Simplicity Elite control board.
– All the stages of cooling must have been on
for 10 or more minutes.
– The outdoor air is 20.0° F or more warmer
then the “SUPPLY AIR TEMP ALARM
SETPOINT FOR COOLING” set point.
– The economizer must be open more than
20%.
Alarm 2 – The next alarm in sequence can be viewed
under Parameter 73 using the PROGRAM key on the
Simplicity Elite control board.
Alarm 3 - The next alarm in sequence can be viewed
under Parameter 74 using the PROGRAM key on the
Simplicity Elite control board.
• If the above criteria is met:
– The Simplicity Elite control will close the
outdoor damper for ten minutes.
Alarm 4 - The next alarm in sequence can be viewed
under Parameter 75 using the PROGRAM key on the
Simplicity Elite control board.
– After ten minutes, the Simplicity Elite control
will read the supply air temperature.
– If the supply air temperature is below the
“SUPPLY AIR TEMP ALARM SETPOINT
FOR COOLING”, the control will keep the
outdoor damper closed and complete the cool-
ing cycle.
Alarm 5 - The next alarm in sequence can be viewed
under Parameter 76 using the PROGRAM key on the
Simplicity Elite control board.
∗ The Simplicity Elite control will declare an
“ECONOMIZER MINIMUM POSITION”
alarm and flash an Alarm Code 40.
The above alarms can also be viewed using the
ALARMS tab in the Simplicity PC software program.
– If the supply air temperature is not below the
“SUPPLY AIR TEMP ALARM SETPOINT
FOR COOLING”.
∗ The Simplicity Elite control will declare a
“SUPPLY AIR TEMPALARM SETPOINT
FOR COOLING” alarm and flash an
Alarm Code 38.
– After the cooling cycle is completed, the Sim-
plicity Elite control sets the outdoor damper
to its minimum position.
– In order to reset the above alarms power to
the unit must be cycled on and off.
JOHNSON CONTROLS
98
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
SECTION 6 – USER INTERFACE
PROGRAM BUTTON
There are three different methods that can be used to
interface with the Simplicity Elite control:
This button puts the board into the program mode. In
the program mode, the control displays the parameter
number of the two-digit display and the data for the
parameter of the four-digit display.
• Program buttons and display on the Unit Control-
ler
• Communication between the Unit Controller and
a PC or Personal Computer using “Simplicity
PC”.
For example, the Occupied Cooling Setpoint is parameter
address 10. The addresses are listed on the Parameter
Points list. Pressing the program button once places
the board in program mode. The two-digit display
shows address 1 and the four-digit display shows the
current setting for that address. To scroll up to address
10, press the Test/Up button until address 10 appears
on the two-digit display. Address 10 is the Occupied
Cooling Setpoint. The factory default setting for this
parameter is 72º F. To change this setpoint, address the
Alarm/Change button one time. The temperature is now
flashing and may be increased or decreased by pressing
the Test/Up button or theAddress/Down button. When
the desired temperature has been selected, pressing the
Alarm/Change button accepts and stores the change.
• Communication between the Unit Controller and
a network
This section of the manual will explain how each of
these interface method is employed.
UNIT CONTROLLER INTERFACE
Four buttons located on the control board allow for
viewing and access to setpoints, alarms, functions,
etc. The buttons are used in conjunction with the two
numerical character displays located on the board.
The character display is a convenient way to access
information on the controller when a computer is not
available. Three of the buttons have multiple functions.
The button functions are discussed in detail below.
PROGRAM
TEST/UP
2 CHARACTER DISPLAY
6
RS 485 PORT
4 CHARACTER DISPLAY
RS 485 PORT
ADDRESS/DOWN
LD13013
ALARM/CHANGE
LED
FIG. 6-1 – UNIT CONTROLLER INTERFACE
JOHNSON CONTROLS
99
User Interface Control Center
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
ALARM/CHANGE
If the program button is pushed while in the program
mode, the control will exit the program mode and store
any changed data even if the operator failed to press the
Alarm/Change button to accept any changes.
When this button is pressed and released one time within
five-seconds, it automatically scrolls through the five
alarms held in memory. The first alarm displayed is the
latest and the last displayed is the oldest.
TEST/UP BUTTON
When this button is pressed and released twice within
five-seconds, it clears all alarms in memory.
When not in the program mode, if the Test/Up button
is pushed and released once within five seconds, the
control skips any short cycle delays for one cycle. This
is a useful aid for the technician servicing the system
without having to wait for delays to time out.
When in the program mode and with a parameter
selected, this button when pressed once causes the data
value for that parameter to begin flashing. At this point
the data value can be increased or decreased using the
Test/Up and Address/Down buttons. When pressed
again the current data setting is accepted and stored.
If this button is pressed and released twice within five-
seconds a lock-out is released. This serves the same
function as temporally breaking the 24 VAC circuit to
the Unit Controller.
CHARACTER DISPLAY ADDRESSES & CODES
Table 6-2 shows the address for each control function
as well as the unit of measurement for that function, the
available range of adjustment and the factory setting as
the unit left the factory.
When in the program mode this button scrolls up
through the parameter addresses. See the Parameter
Points list to identify the desired parameter. Parameters
are items that can be viewed and changed in the control
such as setpoints, year, date, time, time delays, etc.
Refer to Section 7 “Parameter Descriptions and
Options” for a description of each of the parameters
listed in Table 6-1.
ADDRESS/DOWN BUTTON
When in the program mode this button scrolls down
through the parameter addresses.
This button is also used to set the controller up on a
network. When wired to a network through the RS-485
terminals on the board, pushing this button once when
not in the program mode causes the control to scan the
communication bus. The control automatically locates
the first vacant communications address and changes its
address to that address. It will then display the address
on the display for two seconds. The controller is then
connected to the network.
When connected to a network, pressing the button twice
within five-seconds causes the network address to be
displayed for two seconds.
Pressing this button three times within five-seconds
resets the network address to one.
100
JOHNSON CONTROLS
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
TABLE 6-1 - PARAMETER POINTS LIST
ADDRESS
DESCRIPTION
NUMBER
RANGE OF
ADJUSTMENT
0 = OFF, 1 = ON
0-30
CURRENT
SETTING
OFF
30
UNITS OF ADJUSTMENT
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
RUN TEST
PARAMETER BIT
SECONDS
HEAT FAN ON DELAY
HEAT FAN OFF DELAY
COOL FAN ON DELAY
COOL FAN OFF DELAY
ADDRESS
SECONDS
0-255
60
SECONDS
0-30
0
SECONDS
0-255
30
DATA
1-250
1
TURN OFF CONTINUOUS FAN WHEN STARTING
CONSTRUCTION MODE
PARAMETER BIT
PARAMETER BIT
0 = OFF, 1 = ON
0 = OFF, 1 = ON
0-240
OFF
OFF
60
9
UNOCCUPIED OVERRIDE TIME PERIOD
DATA MINUTES
0 = DISABLED
45º - 99º
MINUTES
72º
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
CV OCCUPIED COOLING SETPOINT
CV OCCUPIED HEATING SETPOINT
CV UNOCCUPIED COOLING SETPOINT
CV UNOCCUPIED HEATING SETPOINT
SUPPLY AIR TEMP LIMIT FOR COOLING ENABLE
SUPPLY AIR TEMP LIMIT COOLING SETPOINT
SUPPLY AIR TEMP LIMIT FOR HEATING ENABLED
SUPPLY AIR TEMP LIMIT HEATING SETPOINT
HYDRONIC HEATING ENABLED
HYDRONIC HEATING STAGE #1 SUPPLY AIR
SETPOINT
DEGREES F
DEGREES F
45º - 99º
68º
DEGREES F
45º - 99º
85º
DEGREES F
45º - 99º
60º
PARAMETER BIT
DEGREES F
0 = OFF, 1 = ON
40º - 65º
ON
50º
PARAMETER BIT
DEGREES F
0 = OFF, 1 = ON
100º - 180º
0 = OFF, 1 = ON
ON
135º
OFF
PARAMETER BIT
19
20
21
22
23
24
DEGREES F
80º - 180º
80º - 180º
120º
150º
OFF
OFF
60º
HYDRONIC HEATING STAGE #2 SUPPLY AIR
SETPOINT
DEGREES F
HYDRONIC HEAT ACTUATOR VALVE REVERSE
ACTING
PARAMETER BIT
PARAMETER BIT
DEGREES F
0 = OFF, 1 = ON
0 = OFF, 1 = ON
40º - 70º
REMOTE CONTROL INPUT ENABLE FOR THIRD
PARTY BAS
VAV COOLING SUPPLY AIR TEMP UPPER
SETPOINT
VAV COOLING SUPPLY AIR TEMP LOWER
SETPOINT
DEGREES F
40º - 70º
55º
25
26
27
28
VAV SUPPLY AIR TEMP RESET SETPOINT
VAV OCCUPIED HEATING ENABLED
VAV OCCUPIED HEATING SETPOINT
MORNING WARM-UP ENABLE
DEGREES F
40º - 85º
0 = OFF, 1 = ON
40º - 85º
72º
OFF
68º
6
PARAMETER BIT
DEGREES F
PARAMETER BIT
0 = OFF, 1 = ON
ON
MORNING WARM-UP / VAV RETURN AIR TEMP
SETPOINT
29
30
31
DEGREES F
50º - 85º
0.000 - 5.000
-.250 -.250
70º
1.500
0.1
PRESSURE - INCHES OF
H2O
DUCT PRESSURE SETPOINT
PRESSURE - INCHES OF
H2O
BUILDING PRESSURE SETPOINT
32
33
34
35
ECONOMIZER INSTALLED
PARAMETER BIT
DEGREES F
0 = OFF, 1 = ON
40º - 65º
ON
55º
ECONOMIZER FIRST STAGE SETPOINT
ECONOMIZER SECOND STAGE SETPOINT
ECONOMIZER MINIMUM POSITION
DEGREES F
40º - 65º
50º
PERCENT
0 - 100%
20%
Continued on next page
JOHNSON CONTROLS
101
User Interface Control Center
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
TABLE - 6-1 - PARAMETER POINTS LIST (CONT.)
ADDRESS
DESCRIPTION
NUMBER
RANGE OF
ADJUSTMENT
0 = OFF, 1 = ON
10 - 50
CURRENT
SETTING
OFF
UNITS OF ADJUSTMENT
36
37
38
OUTSIDE AIR HUMIDITY SENSOR INSTALLED
PARAMETER BIT
ECONOMIZER OUTSIDE AIR ENTHALPY SETPOINT BTUS PER POUND
27
RETURN AIR HUMIDITY SENSOR INSTALLED
ECONOMIZER OUTSIDE AIR TEMP ENABLE
SETPOINT
PARAMETER BIT
0 = OFF, 1 = ON
OFF
39
DEGREES F
40º - 80º
55º
40
41
42
43
44
45
DEMAND VENTILATION (IAQ) ENABLED
IAQ SENSOR RANGE
PARAMETER BIT
PARTS PER MILLION
PARTS PER MILLION
PARAMETER BIT
PARAMETER BIT
PARAMETER BIT
PERCENT OF ECONOMIZER
POSITION
0 = OFF, 1 = ON
0 - 5000 PPM
OFF
2000
1000
ON
IAQ SETPOINT
0 - 5000 PPM
POWER EXHAUST INSTALLED
0 = OFF, 1 = ON
0 = OFF, 1 = ON
0 = OFF, 1 = ON
MODULATING POWER EXHAUST INSTALLED
EXHAUST VFD INSTALLED
OFF
OFF
EXHAUST DAMPER POSITION FOR EXHAUST FAN
TO TURN ON (MODULATING ONLY)
EXHAUST DAMPER POSITION FOR EXHAUST FAN
TO TURN OFF
46
47
48
49
0 - 100%
0 - 100%
0 - 100%
0 - 100%
80%
20%
60%
20%
PERCENT OF ECONOMIZER
POSITION
ECONOMIZER DAMPER POSITION FOR EXHAUST
FAN TO TURN ON (NON-MODULATING ONLY)
ECONOMIZER DAMPER POSITION FOR EXHAUST
FAN TO TURN OFF (MODULATING ONLY)
PERCENT OF ECONOMIZER
POSITION
PERCENT OF ECONOMIZER
POSITION
0 = CLOSED,
0 = CLOSED,
1 = OPEN
50
51
52
APS DATA
OPEN
OFF
1 = OPEN
DIRTY FILTER SWITCH INSTALLED
DIRTY FILTER SWITCH DATA
PARAMETER BIT
0 = CLOSED,
0 = OFF, 1 = ON
0 = OPEN,
OPEN
1 = OPEN
1 = CLOSED
0 = OFF, 1 = ON
0 = OFF, 1 = ON
53
54
COOLING MODE OPERATION ENABLE
HEATING MODE ENABLED FOR OPERATION
CONTINUOUS INDOOR FAN OPERATION WITH
SENSOR
PARAMETER BIT
PARAMETER BIT
ON
ON
55
PARAMETER BIT
0 = OFF, 1 = ON
ON
56
57
58
59
60
61
62
63
64
65
66
67
68
69
70
71
SPACE TEMPERATURE OFFSET RANGE
METRIC OPERATION
THIRD PARTY BAS ECONOMIZER ENABLED
YEAR
DEGREES F
PARAMETER BIT
PARAMETER BIT
YEAR (BCD)
MONTH
-5º F - 5º F
0 = OFF, 1 = ON
0 = OFF, 1 = ON
00 - 99
0º F
OFF
OFF
4
1
MONTH
1 - 12
DAY OF MONTH
DAY OF MONTH
DAY OF WEEK
HOURS
1 - 31
1
DAY OF WEEK
1 - 7
1
HOUR
0 - 23
0
MINUTE
MINUTES
0 - 59
0
SUPPLY AIR TEMP
DEGREES F
DEGREES F
DEGREES F
DEGREES F
HUMIDITY
-40º - 180º
-40º - 180º
-40º - 180º
-40º - 180º
0% - 100%
0% - 100%
0 = OFF, 1 = ON
0
RETURN AIR TEMP
0
OUTSIDE AIR TEMP
0
SPACE TEMP
0
OUTSIDE AIR HUMIDITY
RETURN AIR HUMIDITY
OCCUPIED INPUT ENABLE
0
HUMIDITY
0
PARAMETER BIT
OFF
Continued on next page
JOHNSON CONTROLS
102
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
TABLE - 6-1 - PARAMETER POINTS LIST (CONT.)
ADDRESS
DESCRIPTION
NUMBER
RANGE OF
ADJUSTMENT
CURRENT
SETTING
UNITS OF ADJUSTMENT
DATA - 5 CHARACTERS
READ ONLY FLAG
72/73/74/
ALARM ARRAY
75/76
0 - 255
0
CV = 0
VAV = 1
77
VAV / CV SELECTION
0
78
79
80
HOT GAS REHEAT
PARAMETER BIT
PARAMETER BIT
PARAMETER BIT
0 = OFF, 1 = ON
0 = OFF, 1 = ON
2 - 4
OFF
OFF
2
HOT GAS PRESENT ON COMPRESSOR # 1
COMPRESSORS AVAILABLE FOR COOLING
0 - 3
81
82
83
STAGES OF HEAT AVAILABLE
DUCT STATIC READING
PARAMETER BIT
2
0 = DISABLED
PRESSURE - INCHES OF
H2O
0.000 - 5.000
0.000 - 5.000
0000
0000
PRESSURE - INCHES OF
H2O
BUILDING STATIC PRESSURE
LOW AMBIENT KIT INSTALLED
84
85
86
87
PARAMETER BIT
0 = OFF, 1 = ON
0 = OFF, 1 = ON
0 = OFF, 1 = ON
0 = OFF, 1 = ON
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
BUILDING STATIC PRESSURE SENSOR INSTALLED PARAMETER BIT
ERV INSTALLED
PARAMETER BIT
PARAMETER BIT
PRESSURE - INCHES OF
H2O
ERV UNOCCUPIED FAN ENABLE
88
DUCT STATIC SHUTDOWN SETPOINT
0.000 - 5.000
4.500
6
JOHNSON CONTROLS
103
User Interface Control Center
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
COMMUNICATION USING SIMPLICITY PC
The recommended method to use for set up and
troubleshooting is to connect the Simplicity Control to a
PC or Personal Computer with “Simplicity PC” software
installed. “Simplicity PC” software is available
through the York UPG web site. The instructions for
downloading the software are as follows:
Simplicity PC Download
1. On the internet connect to YorkUPG.Com
LD13036
104
JOHNSON CONTROLS
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
LD13037
Left click on Software
6
JOHNSON CONTROLS
105
User Interface Control Center
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
4. Left click on Simplicity Software and follow the
directions for downloading the program into your
computer.
USB Adapter Drive - Simplicity Pocket PC
6. In addition to the software an adapter and cable
will be required to connect to the Unit Controller.
The following are available through either Source
1 Parts or Baltimore Parts:
5. Two additional programs are available for down-
loading. If you are running the “Simplicity PC”
software on a Pocket PC you must also download
Simplicity Pocket PC. Left click on Simplicity
Pocket PC and follow the directions for download-
ing the program into your Pocket PC.
FREEnet Serial Adapter – Part Number 031-
01966-000
If you are going to connect the Unit Controller to
your computer through a USB port you will also
have to download the USB driver. To do that left
click on FREE net USBAdapter Driver and follow
the directions for downloading the program into
your PC.
FREEnet USB Adapter – Part Number 031-
Cable – Part Number 025-38682-000
106
JOHNSON CONTROLS
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
7. The FREEnet USBAdapter comes with a standard
USB cable. The “A” end plugs into the computer
and the “B” end into the FREEnet USB Adapter.
FREEnet Serial
CABLE WIRE COLOR
ADAPTER TERMINAL
BOARD MARKING
GND
GREEN
BROWN
WHITE
TDA(-)
8. The FREEnet SerialAdapter comes with a standard
9-pin Serial Extension Cable. It has a computer
standard 9-pin male connector to plug into the
adapter and the same style 9-pin female connec-
tor to plug into the computer. If the computer
connections are the older 25-pin connector, a 25-
pin female to 9-pin male cable or adapter will be
needed.
TDB (+)
JUMPER
JUMPER
TDB(+) TO RDB(+)
TDA(-) TO RDA(-)
10. Connect the other end of the cable to the RS-485
P5 connector on the Unit Controller.
Establishing Communication
The FREEnet Serial Adapter requires two AAA
batteries for power. There is an “OFF/ON” switch
on the side of the adapter that needs to be turned on
for operation. When not in use turn off the battery
to extend its life.
1 After installing the Simplicity PC software on the
computer, the Simplicity PC icon will appear on
the desktop. Double-click on the Simplicity icon
to open the Simplicity window.
9. The above cable connects between the FREEnet
USB or FREEnet Serial Adapter to the Unit Con-
troller. The following table should be used to
connect the cable to each of the adapters.
LD13039
FREEnet USB
ADAPTER TERMINAL
BOARD MARKING
CABLE WIRE COLOR
Double click on Simplicity PC icon
GREEN
BROWN
WHITE
GND
TDA(-)
TDB (+)
6
JOHNSON CONTROLS
107
User Interface Control Center
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
2. Click on the “Add” button and a dialog box will
appear as shown below.
LD13040
Left click on Add button
3. In the “Connection Type” dialog box, select “Se-
rial/USB Direct Connection”. Click on the “Port
Number” pull down box and select the computer
port on the computer that the network is connected
to. The port number in the connection box will
vary depending upon the particular computer used
and what port connection it uses or has available.
You can also use the “Connection Name” box to
identify the unit.
3a. Select Serial/USB
direct Connection
3b. Select proper
Port Number
LD13041
4. Click Add button
108
JOHNSON CONTROLS
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
4. In the dialog box, click the “Add” button. The
“Add Connection” dialog box will close and the
main Simplicity window will appear. In the left
pane of the main screen is a tree. Under “My
Connections”, the name of the device installed in
the computer port connecting the computer to the
simplicity network will appear. The actual name
of the device will depend upon what it was named
when it was set up.
5. Left Click on Scan
LD13042
5. Click on the “Scan” button. The software will find
all Simplicity devices connected to the network.
The devices will appear in the tree under the name
of the connection device. The names of the devices
will depend upon what they were named when set
up on the network.
6. Move the cursor to the small box next to the left
of the device name and left click. The software
will find all Simplicity devices connected to the
network. The devices will appear in the tree under
the name of the connection device. The names
of the devices will depend upon what they were
named when set up on the network.
6
LD13040
7. Left click on desired Simplicity Device.
6. Left click to expand tree
7. Left-click on the particular Simplicity device de-
sired.
JOHNSON CONTROLS
109
User Interface Control Center
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
8. The right hand side of the screen fills with a series
of tabs. The tabs allow you to access, read, and
change settings for that device. Click on the tab
that corresponds to the information you wish to
access.
LD13043
110
JOHNSON CONTROLS
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
SIMPLICITY PC DATA SCREENS
The following pages identify the data contained in each
of the tabs. Move the cursor to the tab and left click to
open.
DEVICE NAMES
LD13015
EQUIPMENT INSTALLATION
6
LD13016
JOHNSON CONTROLS
111
User Interface Control Center
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
SENSOR READINGS
LD13017
112
JOHNSON CONTROLS
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
ECONOMIZER/EXHAUST
LD13018
6
JOHNSON CONTROLS
113
User Interface Control Center
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
FANS
LD13019
114
JOHNSON CONTROLS
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
COOLING SETUP
6
LD13020
JOHNSON CONTROLS
115
User Interface Control Center
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
COOLING STATUS
LD13021
116
JOHNSON CONTROLS
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
HEATING SETUP
6
LD13022
JOHNSON CONTROLS
117
User Interface Control Center
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
HEATING STATUS
LD13023
118
JOHNSON CONTROLS
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
SYSTEM OPTIONS
LD13024
6
JOHNSON CONTROLS
119
User Interface Control Center
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
OUTPUTS/STATUS
LD13025
120
JOHNSON CONTROLS
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
INPUTS
LD13014
COMFORT/DEMAND VENTILATION
6
LD13026
JOHNSON CONTROLS
121
User Interface Control Center
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
GRAPHIC
LD13027
CLOCK
LD13028
122
JOHNSON CONTROLS
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
Weekly Schedule
days. When both the Occupied and Unoccupied times
are programmed to 12:00 AM, that period is disabled.
If all the times are programmed to 12:00 AM, the unit
will operate 24 hours a day, 7 days a week.
The weekly schedule can only be programmed using
the Simplicity PC software under the WEEKLY
SCHEDULE SETTINGS tab. The weekly schedule has
two Occupied/Unoccupied times for each of the seven
WEEKLY SCHEDULE SETTINGS
LD13029
6
JOHNSON CONTROLS
123
User Interface Control Center
Holiday Schedule
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
month and year calendar will appear. Use the cursor to
select the year, month, and day you want the holiday
schedule to start. Use the up and down arrow key to
select the time you want the holiday schedule to start.
Finally select the number of days you want the holiday
schedule to be active.
The holiday schedule can only be programmed using
the Simplicity PC software under the HOLIDAY
SCHEDULE tab. There are 20 holiday schedules. To
program a holiday schedule left click on the box next
to the holiday event you want to program. Click on
the down arrow key to set the start date, the current
HOLIDAY SCHEDULE
LD13030
124
JOHNSON CONTROLS
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
ALARMS
LD13031
6
JOHNSON CONTROLS
125
User Interface Control Center
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
REVISING SETTINGS
To change a set point move the curser to the value you
want to change and left click and highlight the item.
Left click to highlight
Double click to open
change screen
LD13032
126
JOHNSON CONTROLS
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
To open the change screen double left click.
The screen will show the current value and the
acceptable range. Us the numeric key pad to enter the
revised setting. Left click on “Update” and the value
will be change at the Unit Controller.
6
LD13033
JOHNSON CONTROLS
127
User Interface Control Center
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
To change a value move the curser to the value you want
to change and left click and highlight the item.
Left click to highlight
Double click to open
change screen
LD13034
128
JOHNSON CONTROLS
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
The screen will show the current value and option.
Move the curser and left click on the option you want
to turn on. Left click on “Update” and the value will
be change at the Unit Controller.
LD13035
6
JOHNSON CONTROLS
129
User Interface Control Center
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
TABLE 6-2 - SIMPLICITY ELITE DATA MAP
Writing to any register not in this list
may cause erratic operation
This product is not designed to accept
continuous writes to data stored in
long term memory. It is recommended
that no stored value be changed more
often than an average of once per
hour. Changing data more often risks
damaging the ability of the control to
store new data for the full life of the
product.
INITIAL/
ADDRESS ADDRESS
DEFAULT
MIN
MAX
BIT
DESCRIPTION
(HEX)
(DEC)
VALUE
(HEX)
20
VALUE VALUE
00 H
00 L
01 H
0 H
0 L
1 H
NA
NA
NA
NA
0
NA
255
-
DEVICE ID = 20 FOR ELITE
-
DEVICE SOFTWARE REVISION
54
-
OPTION BYTE #1
BITS 1 AND 0 = 0,0 RESPECTIVELY THERE ARE 0 STAGES OF
HEAT; 0,1 = 1 STAGE; 1,0 = 2 STAGES; 1,1 = 3 STAGES
0
1
2
1 = HEATING MODE ENABLED FOR OPERATION
1 = TURN OFF CONTINUOUS FAN WHEN STARTING HEAT
1 = COOLING MODE ENABLED FOR OPERATION
1 = ECONOMIZER LOADING ACTIVE
3
4
5
6
1 = SPACE SENSOR FAULT OVERRIDE ENABLED
NA
7
01 L
02 H
02 L
03 H
03 L
04 L
05 H
05 L
06 H
06 L
07 H
07 L
1 L
2 H
2 L
3 H
3 L
4 L
5 H
5 L
6 H
6 L
7 H
7 L
NA
NA
NA
NA
NA
NA
NA
NA
NA
NA
NA
NA
NA
30
60
0
NA
0
NA
30
ACTIVE ALARM
FAN ON DELAY FOR HEAT (SECONDS)
0
255
30
FAN OFF DELAY FOR HEAT (SECONDS)
0
FAN ON DELAY FOR COOL (SECONDS)
30
3
0
255
10
FAN OFF DELAY FOR COOL (SECONDS)
1
MINIMUM RUN TIME FOR COMPRESSORS (MINUTES)
HEATING #1 ACCUMULATED RUN TIME (HOURS, HIGH BYTE)
HEATING #1 ACCUMULATED RUN TIME (HOURS, LOW BYTE)
HEATING #2 ACCUMULATED RUN TIME (HOURS, HIGH BYTE)
HEATING #2 ACCUMULATED RUN TIME (HOURS, LOW BYTE)
HEATING #3 ACCUMULATED RUN TIME (HOURS, HIGH BYTE)
HEATING #3 ACCUMULATED RUN TIME (HOURS, LOW BYTE)
REGISTERS 8 - 20 STORE THE UNIT NAME. WHEN WRITTEN,
ALL 13 REGISTERS (AT 2 BYTES PER REGISTER) SHOULD BE
WRITTEN. THE FORMAT IS ASCII. CHARACTER #1 IS IN 8 H.
CHARACTER #2 IS IN 8 L. CHARACTER #3 IS IN 9 H, AND SO ON.
INPUT STATUS BYTE #1
0
0
255
255
255
255
255
255
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
08 H - 14 L 8 H - 20 L
NA
15 H
21 H
NA
0
-
-
-
1 = Y1 ON (COOLING 1ST STAGE)
1
1 = Y2 ON (COOLING 2ND STAGE)
2
1 = Y3 ON (COOLING 3RD STAGE)
3
1 = Y4 ON (COOLING 4TH STAGE)
4
1 = W1 ON (HEATING 1ST STAGE)
Continued on next page
JOHNSON CONTROLS
130
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
TABLE - 6-2 - SIMPLICITY ELITE DATA MAP (CONT.)
INITIAL/
ADDRESS ADDRESS
DEFAULT
VALUE
(HEX)
MIN
MAX
BIT
DESCRIPTION
(HEX)
(DEC)
VALUE VALUE
5
6
1 = W2 ON (HEATING 2ND STAGE)
1 = W3 ON (HEATING 3RD STAGE)
1 = G ON (INDOOR FAN)
INPUT STATUS BYTE #2
1 = HPS1 CLOSED (NOT TRIPPED)
1 = HPS2 CLOSED
7
15 L
21 L
NA
0
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
1
2
1 = HPS3 CLOSED
3
1 = HPS4 CLOSED
4
1 = LPS1 CLOSED (NOT TRIPPED)
1 = LPS2 CLOSED
5
6
1 = LPS3 CLOSED
7
1 = LPS4 CLOSED
16 H
16 L
17 L
17 H
22 H
22 L
23 H
23 L
NA
0
INPUT STATUS BYTE #3
1 = C1 OVERLOAD CLOSED (NOT TRIPPED)
1 = C2 OVERLOAD CLOSED
1 = C3 OVERLOAD CLOSED
1 = C4 OVERLOAD CLOSED
1 = PURGE SWITCH CLOSED (ACTIVE)
1 = OCC INPUT ON
1
2
3
4
5
6
NA
7
1 = DIRTY FILTER CLOSED (DIRTY CONDITION)
INPUT STATUS BYTE #4
NA
0
1 = GAS VALVE #1 ON
1
1 = GAS VALVE #2 ON
2
1 = GAS VALVE #3 ON
3
1 = LIMIT #1 CLOSED (NOT TRIPPED)
1 = LIMIT #2 CLOSED
4
5
1 = LIMIT #3 CLOSED
6
NA
6
7
NA
NA
0
INPUT STATUS BYTE #5
1 = FAN OVERLOAD CLOSED (NOT TRIPPED)
1 = FREEZE STAT CLOSED (NOT LOW TEMPERATURE)
1 = AIR PROVING CLOSED (AIR FLOW IS SENSED)
NA
1
2
3
4
NA
5
1 = VAV; 0 = CV
6
1 = CV / VAV OUT OF RANGE (FAULT CONDITION)
1 = LOW 24 VAC SUPPLY VOLTAGE
INPUT STATUS BYTE #6
7
NA
0
1 = PROGRAM BUTTON PRESSED
1 = TEST / UP BUTTON PRESSED
1 = ALARMS / CHANGE BUTTON PRESSED
1
2
Continued on next page
JOHNSON CONTROLS
131
User Interface Control Center
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
TABLE - 6-2 - SIMPLICITY ELITE DATA MAP (CONT.)
INITIAL/
ADDRESS ADDRESS
DEFAULT
VALUE
(HEX)
MIN
MAX
BIT
DESCRIPTION
(HEX)
(DEC)
VALUE VALUE
3
4
1 = ADDRESS / DOWN BUTTON PRESSED
NA
5
NA
6
NA
7
NA
18 H
24 H
NA
0
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
OUTPUT STATUS BYTE #1
1 = COMPRESSOR #1 ON
1 = COMPRESSOR #2 ON
1 = COMPRESSOR #3 ON
1 = COMPRESSOR #4 ON
1 = CONDENSER FAN #1 ON
1 = CONDENSER FAN #2 ON
1 = INDOOR FAN ON
1 = EXHAUST FAN ON
OUTPUT STATUS BYTE #2
1 = STAGE 1 HEAT ON
1 = STAGE 2 HEAT ON
1 = STAGE 3 HEAT ON
NA
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
18 L
19 H
19 L
1A H
24 L
25 H
25 L
26 H
NA
0
-
1
2
3
4
NA
5
NA
6
NA
7
NA
NA
0
-
OUTPUT STATUS BYTE #3
1 = COMPRESSORS OFF BECAUSE FREE COOLING IS AVAILABLE
1
1 = COMPRESSORS OFF BECAUSE OF LOW AMBIENT
2
1 = COMPRESSORS OFF BECAUSE SUPPLY VOLTAGE IS LOW
3
1 = CONTROL IS IN COMFORT VENTILATION MODE
4
1 = DISABLE CONTROL IS ACTIVE
5
1 = ECONOMIZER IS USING FREE COOLING
6
NA
7
NA
NA
0
-
OUTPUT STATUS BYTE #4
1 = COMPRESSOR #1 OFF BECAUSE OF ASCD
1
1 = COMPRESSOR #2 OFF BECAUSE OF ASCD
2
1 = COMPRESSOR #3 OFF BECAUSE OF ASCD
3
1 = COMPRESSOR #4 OFF BECAUSE OF ASCD
4
NA
5
NA
6
NA
7
NA
NA
12
OPTION BYTE #2
Continued on next page
JOHNSON CONTROLS
132
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
TABLE - 6-2 - SIMPLICITY ELITE DATA MAP (CONT.)
INITIAL/
ADDRESS ADDRESS
DEFAULT
VALUE
(HEX)
MIN
MAX
BIT
DESCRIPTION
(HEX)
(DEC)
VALUE VALUE
BITS 1 AND 0 = 0,0 RESPECTIVELY THERE ARE 2 STAGES OF
COMPRESSION; 0,1 = 3 STAGES; 1,0 = 4 STAGES; 1,1 = 4
STAGES
0
1
2
1 = SAT LIMIT FOR COOLING ENABLED
1 = SAT LIMIT FOR HEATING ENABLED
1 = HYDRONIC HEATING ENABLED
1 = HYDRONIC HEAT ACTUATOR VALVE REVERSE ACTING
1 = REMOTE CONTROL INPUT ENABLED FOR THIRD PARTY BAS
1 = HOT GAS REHEAT ENABLED
3
4
5
6
7
1A L
1B H
1B L
26 L
27 H
27 L
NA
0
4
193
8
-
-
-
-
-
-
OPTION BYTE #3
1 = VAV OCCUPIED HEATING ENABLED
NA
1
2
1 = ECONOMIZER PRESENT
3
1 = OUTSIDE AIR HUMIDITY SENSOR PRESENT
1 = RETURN AIR HUMIDITY SENSOR PRESENT
1 = PRE-OCCUPANCY PURGE ENABLED
1 = DEMAND VENTILATION ENABLED
1 = BUILDING PRESSURE SENSOR INSTALLED
OPTION BYTE #4
4
5
6
7
NA
0
1 = POWER EXHAUST PRESENT
1
1 = MODULATING POWER EXHAUST PRESENT
1 = EXHAUST VFD PRESENT
2
3
1 = LOW AMBIENT KIT INSTALLED
1 = DIRTY FILTER SWITCH PRESENT
1 = INTELLI-START OPERATION ENABLED
1 = INDOOR FAN OPERATES WITH SPACE SENSOR PRESENT [CV]
1 = DAYLIGHT SAVINGS TIME ENABLED
OPTION BYTE #5
4
5
6
7
NA
0
6
1 = RUN TEST ENABLED
1
1 = METER OF UNOCCUPIED OVERRIDE ENABLED
1 = METRIC DISPLAY ENABLED
2
1 = USE THERMOSTAT OR COMMUNICATIONS FLAG FOR
OCCUPIED SIGNAL
3
4
1 = LEAD/LAG: EQUALIZE COMPRESSOR RUN TIME ENABLED
1 = HOT GAS BYPASS PRESENT ON COMPRESSOR #1
1 = THIRD PARTY BAS ECONOMIZER ENABLED
1 = MORNING WARM-UP ENABLED
ALARM 1 - MOST RECENT ALARM.
ALARM 2
5
6
7
1C H
1C L
1D H
1D L
1E H
28 H
28 L
29 H
29 L
30 H
NA
NA
NA
NA
NA
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
255
255
255
255
255
ALARM 3
ALARM 4
ALARM 5 – OLDEST STORED ALARM.
Continued on next page
JOHNSON CONTROLS
133
User Interface Control Center
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
TABLE - 6-2 - SIMPLICITY ELITE DATA MAP (CONT.)
INITIAL/
ADDRESS ADDRESS
DEFAULT
VALUE
(HEX)
MIN
MAX
BIT
DESCRIPTION
(HEX)
(DEC)
VALUE VALUE
COMPRESSOR #1 ACCUMULATED RUN TIME (HOURS, HIGH
BYTE)
1F H
1F L
20 H
20 L
21 H
21 L
22 H
31 H
31 L
32 H
32 L
33 H
33 L
34 H
NA
NA
NA
NA
NA
NA
NA
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
255
255
255
255
255
255
255
COMPRESSOR #1 ACCUMULATED RUN TIME (HOURS, LOW BYTE)
COMPRESSOR #2 ACCUMULATED RUN TIME (HOURS, HIGH
BYTE)
COMPRESSOR #2 ACCUMULATED RUN TIME (HOURS, LOW BYTE)
COMPRESSOR #3 ACCUMULATED RUN TIME (HOURS, HIGH
BYTE)
COMPRESSOR #3 ACCUMULATED RUN TIME (HOURS, LOW BYTE)
COMPRESSOR #4 ACCUMULATED RUN TIME (HOURS, HIGH
BYTE)
22 L
24 H
26 L
34 L
36 H
38 L
NA
NA
NA
0
0
1
0
1
255
250
NA
COMPRESSOR #4 ACCUMULATED RUN TIME (HOURS, LOW BYTE)
REQUESTED ADDRESS CHANGE (BUS ADDRESS)
REQUESTED OPERATION
NA
NA
1 = REQUEST FOR 1ST STAGE COOLING
1 = REQUEST FOR 2ND STAGE COOLING
1 = REQUEST FOR 3RD STAGE COOLING
1 = REQUEST FOR 4TH STAGE COOLING
1 = REQUEST FOR 1ST STAGE HEATING
1 = REQUEST FOR 2ND STAGE HEATING
1 = REQUEST FOR 3RD STAGE HEATING
1 = REQUEST FOR FAN
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
REGISTERS 39 - 51 STORE THE MODEL NUMBER. WHEN
WRITTEN, ALL 13 REGISTERS (AT 2 BYTES PER REGISTER)
SHOULD BE WRITTEN. THE FORMAT IS ASCII. CHARACTER #1
IS IN 39 H. CHARACTER #2 IS IN 39 L. CHARACTER #3 IS IN 40 H,
AND SO ON.
39 H - 51
L
27 H - 33 L
NA
REGISTERS 52 - 64 STORE THE SERIAL NUMBER. WHEN
WRITTEN, ALL 13 REGISTERS (AT 2 BYTES PER REGISTER)
SHOULD BE WRITTEN. THE FORMAT IS ASCII. CHARACTER #1
IS IN 52 H. CHARACTER #2 IS IN 52 L. CHARACTER #3 IS IN 53 H,
AND SO ON.
52 H - 64
L
34 H - 40 L
NA
NA
REDLINE/LOADSHED STATUS (5 MINUTE TIMER IS STARTED
EACH WRITE. VALUE IS CLEARED IF TIMER IS ALLOWED TO
FINISH.)
41 L
65 L
NA
NA
NA
0
1
1 = SET REDLINE OPERATION
1 = SET LOADSHED OPERATION
2 - 7
BITS 2-7 UNUSED
42 L
43 H
66 L
67 H
255
-
CLEAR LOCKOUT STATUS
WRITE “00” TO CLEAR ALL LOCKOUTS. ANY OTHER VALUE IS
IGNORED. ALWAYS READS 255.
READING THIS ADDRESS RETURNS EEPROM CHECKSUM HIGH
BYTE
0
255
Continued on next page
JOHNSON CONTROLS
134
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
TABLE - 6-2 - SIMPLICITY ELITE DATA MAP (CONT.)
INITIAL/
ADDRESS ADDRESS
DEFAULT
VALUE
(HEX)
MIN
MAX
BIT
DESCRIPTION
(HEX)
(DEC)
VALUE VALUE
READING THIS ADDRESS RETURNS EEPROM CHECKSUM LOW
BYTE
43 L
67 L
-
0
255
44 H
44 L
45 H
45 L
46 H
46 L
47 H
47 L
48 H
48 L
49 H
49 L
4A H
4A L
4B H
4B L
4C H
4C L
4D H
- 50 L
68 H
68 L
4
1
0
1
99
12
31
7
REAL TIME CLOCK YEAR VALUE
REAL TIME CLOCK MONTH VALUE
REAL TIME CLOCK DAY OF MONTH VALUE
REAL TIME CLOCK DAY OF WEEK VALUE
REAL TIME CLOCK HOUR VALUE
REAL TIME CLOCK MINUTE VALUE
OCCUPIED COOLING SETPOINT [CV]
OCCUPIED HEATING SETPOINT [CV]
UN-OCCUPIED COOLING SETPOINT [CV]
UN-OCCUPIED HEATING SETPOINT [CV]
DAY 1 – OCCUPIED HOUR #1
69 H
1
1
69 L
1
1
70 H
0
0
23
59
99
99
99
99
23
59
23
59
23
59
23
59
70 L
0
0
71 H
72
68
85
60
0
45
45
45
45
0
71 L
72 H
72 L
73 H
73 L
0
0
DAY 1 – OCCUPIED MINUTE #1
74 H
0
0
DAY 1 – UN-OCCUPIED HOUR #1
DAY 1 – UN-OCCUPIED MINUTE #1
DAY 1 – OCCUPIED HOUR #2
74 L
0
0
75 H
0
0
75 L
0
0
DAY 1 – OCCUPIED MINUTE #2
76 H
0
0
DAY 1 – UN-OCCUPIED HOUR #2
DAY 1 – UN-OCCUPIED MINUTE #2
76 L
0
0
77 H - 80
L
NA
NA
NA
NA
NA
NA
NA
NA
NA
NA
NA
NA
NA
NA
NA
NA
NA
NA
DAY 2 (SAME FORMAT AS DAY #1)
DAY 3 (SAME FORMAT AS DAY #1)
DAY 4 (SAME FORMAT AS DAY #1)
DAY 5 (SAME FORMAT AS DAY #1)
DAY 6 (SAME FORMAT AS DAY #1)
DAY 7 (SAME FORMAT AS DAY #1)
81 H - 84
L
51 H - 54 L
55 H - 58 L
85 H - 88
L
59 H - 5C
L
89 H - 92
L
5D H
- 60 L
93 H - 96
L
6
97 H - 100
L
61 H - 64 L
65 H
65 L
101 H
101 L
102 H
102 L
103 L
104 H
- 106 L
107 H
- 109 L
110 H
- 112 L
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
12
31
23
59
99
HOLIDAY #1 – START MONTH
HOLIDAY #1 – START DAY OF MONTH
HOLIDAY #1 – START HOUR
66 H
66 L
HOLIDAY #1 – START MINUTE
HOLIDAY #1 – NUMBER OF DAYS
67 L
68 H - 6A
L
NA
NA
NA
NA
NA
NA
NA
NA
NA
HOLIDAY #2 (SAME FORMAT AS HOLIDAY #1)
HOLIDAY #3 (SAME FORMAT AS HOLIDAY #1)
HOLIDAY #4 (SAME FORMAT AS HOLIDAY #1)
6B H - 6D
L
6E H
- 70 L
Continued on next page
JOHNSON CONTROLS
135
User Interface Control Center
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
TABLE - 6-2 - SIMPLICITY ELITE DATA MAP (CONT.)
INITIAL/
ADDRESS ADDRESS
DEFAULT
VALUE
(HEX)
MIN
MAX
BIT
DESCRIPTION
(HEX)
(DEC)
VALUE VALUE
113 H
- 115 L
116 H
71 H - 73 L
74 H - 76L
77 H - 79 L
NA
NA
NA
NA
NA
NA
NA
NA
NA
NA
NA
NA
NA
NA
NA
NA
-
NA
NA
NA
NA
NA
NA
NA
NA
NA
NA
NA
NA
NA
NA
NA
NA
0
NA
NA
NA
NA
NA
NA
NA
NA
NA
NA
NA
NA
NA
NA
NA
NA
255
255
255
255
255
255
HOLIDAY #5 (SAME FORMAT AS HOLIDAY #1)
HOLIDAY #6 (SAME FORMAT AS HOLIDAY #1)
HOLIDAY #7 (SAME FORMAT AS HOLIDAY #1)
HOLIDAY #8 (SAME FORMAT AS HOLIDAY #1)
HOLIDAY #9 (SAME FORMAT AS HOLIDAY #1)
HOLIDAY #10 (SAME FORMAT AS HOLIDAY #1)
HOLIDAY #11 (SAME FORMAT AS HOLIDAY #1)
HOLIDAY #12 (SAME FORMAT AS HOLIDAY #1)
HOLIDAY #13 (SAME FORMAT AS HOLIDAY #1)
HOLIDAY #14 (SAME FORMAT AS HOLIDAY #1)
HOLIDAY #15 (SAME FORMAT AS HOLIDAY #1)
HOLIDAY #16 (SAME FORMAT AS HOLIDAY #1)
HOLIDAY #17 (SAME FORMAT AS HOLIDAY #1)
HOLIDAY #18 (SAME FORMAT AS HOLIDAY #1)
HOLIDAY #19 (SAME FORMAT AS HOLIDAY #1)
HOLIDAY #20 (SAME FORMAT AS HOLIDAY #1)
- 118 L
119 H
- 121 L
122 H
- 124 L
125 H
- 127 L
128 H
- 130 L
131 H
- 133 L
134 H
- 136 L
137 H
- 139 L
140 H
- 142 L
143 H
- 145 L
146 H
- 148 L
149 H
- 151 L
152 H
- 154 L
155 H
- 157 L
158 H
- 160 L
7A H - 7C
L
7D H
- 7F L
80 H - 82 L
83 H - 85 L
86 H - 88 L
89 H - 8B
L
8C H
- 8E L
8F H - 91
L
92 H - 94 L
95 H - 97 L
98 H - 9A
L
9B H - 9D
L
9E H - A0L
A1 H
SUPPLY AIR TEMPERATURE (1/10 DEGREES, HIGH BYTE, 16 BIT
VALUE, 0 = -40 DEGREES F)
161 H
161 L
162 H
162 L
163 H
163 L
SUPPLY AIR TEMPERATURE (1/10 DEGREES, LOW BYTE, 16 BIT
VALUE, 0 = -40 DEGREES F)
A1 L
-
0
OUTSIDE AIR TEMPERATURE (1/10 DEGREES, HIGH BYTE, 16 BIT
VALUE, 0 = -40 DEGREES F)
A2 H
-
0
OUTSIDE AIR TEMPERATURE (1/10 DEGREES, LOW BYTE, 16 BIT
VALUE, 0 = -40 DEGREES F)
A2 L
-
0
RETURN AIR TEMPERATURE (1/10 DEGREES, HIGH BYTE, 16 BIT
VALUE, 0 = -40 DEGREES F)
A3 H
-
0
RETURN AIR TEMPERATURE (1/10 DEGREES, LOW BYTE, 16 BIT
VALUE, 0 = -40 DEGREES F)
A3 L
-
0
Continued on next page
JOHNSON CONTROLS
136
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
TABLE - 6-2 - SIMPLICITY ELITE DATA MAP (CONT.)
INITIAL/
ADDRESS ADDRESS
DEFAULT
VALUE
(HEX)
MIN
MAX
BIT
DESCRIPTION
(HEX)
(DEC)
VALUE VALUE
SPACE SENSOR TEMPERATURE (ROOM AIR) (1/10 DEGREES,
HIGH BYTE, 16 BIT VALUE, 0 = -40 DEGREES F)
SPACE SENSOR TEMPERATURE (ROOM AIR) (1/10 DEGREES,
LOW BYTE, 16 BIT VALUE, 0 = -40 DEGREES F)
SPACE SENSOR OFFSET RANGE (DEGREES)
RETURN AIR HUMIDITY (%)
A4 H
A4 L
164 H
164 L
-
-
0
0
255
255
A5 L
A6 L
A7 L
A8 H
A8 L
165 L
166 L
167 L
168 H
168 L
3
-
0
0
0
0
0
5
100
100
255
255
-
OUTSIDE AIR HUMIDITY (%)
-
DEMAND VENTILATION (IAQ) VALUE (PPM VALUE, HIGH BYTE)
DEMAND VENTILATION (IAQ) VALUE (PPM VALUE, LOW BYTE)
BUILDING PRESSURE VALUE (0.001” WC, HIGH BYTE, 0 = -0.250”
WC, MAX = 0.250” WC)
-
A9 H
A9 L
AA H
AA L
AB H
AB L
169 H
169 L
170 H
170 L
171 H
171 L
-
-
0
0
0
0
0
0
255
255
255
255
200
200
BUILDING PRESSURE VALUE (0.001” WC, LOW BYTE, 0 = -0.250”
WC, MAX = 0.250” WC)
DUCT PRESSURE VALUE (0.01” WC, HIGH BYTE, 0 = 0.00” WC,
MAX = 5.00” WC)
-
DUCT PRESSURE VALUE (0.01” WC, LOW BYTE, 0 = 0.00” WC, MAX
= 5.00” WC)
-
REMOTE CONTROL INPUT VALUE (0.05 VDC COUNTS FOR
COOLING SAT SETPOINT SCALING)
0
40
DEMAND VENTILATION SETPOINT (25 PPM INCREMENTS,
MAXIMUM 5000 PPM)
AIR QUALITY (DV) SENSOR RANGE (25 PPM INCREMENTS,
MAXIMUM 5000 PPM)
AC L
AD L
AE H
172 L
173 L
174 H
80
60
45
0
0
0
200
240
100
UNOCCUPIED OVERRIDE TIME PERIOD (MINUTES)
OUTDOOR AIR TEMPERATURE COOLING LOCKOUT
TEMPERATURE (DEGREES F, 0 = DISABLED)
OUTDOOR AIR TEMPERATURE HEATING LOCKOUT
TEMPERATURE (DEGREES F, 0 = DISABLED)
SAT COOLING LIMIT SETPOINT (DEGREES F)
SAT HEATING LIMIT SETPOINT (DEGREES F)
HYDRONIC HEATING STAGE #1 SUPPLY AIR SETPOINT (DEGREES
F)
AE L
174 L
75
0
100
AF H
AF L
175 H
175 L
50
40
65
135
100
180
6
B0 H
B0 L
176 H
176 L
120
150
80
80
180
180
HYDRONIC HEATING STAGE #2 SUPPLY AIR SETPOINT (DEGREES
F)
B1 H
B1 L
177 H
177 L
80
70
60
60
85
85
COMFORT VENTILATION UPPER SETPOINT (DEGREES F)
COMFORT VENTILATION LOWER SETPOINT (DEGREES F)
VAV COOLING SUPPLY AIR TEMPERATURE: UPPER SETPOINT
(DEGREES F)
B2 H
B2 L
178 H
178 L
60
55
40
40
70
70
VAV COOLING SUPPLY AIR TEMPERATURE: LOWER SETPOINT
(DEGREES F)
VAV COOLING SUPPLY AIR TEMPERATURE: RESET SETPOINT
(DEGREES F)
B3 H
B3 L
179 H
179 L
72
68
40
40
85
85
VAV OCCUPIED HEATING SETPOINT (DEGREES F)
Continued on next page
JOHNSON CONTROLS
137
User Interface Control Center
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
TABLE - 6-2 - SIMPLICITY ELITE DATA MAP (CONT.)
INITIAL/
ADDRESS ADDRESS
DEFAULT
VALUE
(HEX)
MIN
MAX
BIT
DESCRIPTION
(HEX)
(DEC)
VALUE VALUE
MORNING WARM-UP AND VAV HEATING: RETURN AIR
TEMPERATURE SETPOINT (DEGREES F)
B4 H
B5 H
B5 L
B6 H
180 H
181 H
181 L
182 H
70
60
50
0
85
DUCT PRESSURE SETPOINT (0.025” WC INCREMENTS, DEFAULT
= 1.500” WC « 60)
200
200
100
DUCT PRESSURE SHUTDOWN SETPOINT (0.025” WC
INCREMENTS, DEFAULT = 4.500” WC « 180)
BUILDING PRESSURE SETPOINT (0.005” WC INCREMENTS, 0 =
-0.250” WC, DEFAULT = 0.100” WC « 70)
180
70
0
0
B7 H
B7 L
B8 H
183 H
183 L
184 H
55
50
20
40
40
0
65
65
ECONOMIZER FIRST STAGE (UPPER) SETPOINT (DEGREES F)
ECONOMIZER SECOND STAGE (LOWER) SETPOINT (DEGREES F)
ECONOMIZER MINIMUM POSITION (PERCENT)
ECONOMIZER OUTSIDE AIR ENTHALPY SETPOINT (BTU PER
POUND)
100
B9 H
B9 L
BA H
185 H
185 L
186 H
27
27
55
10
10
40
50
50
80
ECONOMIZER RETURN AIR ENTHALPY SETPOINT (BTU PER
POUND)
ECONOMIZER OUTSIDE AIR TEMPERATURE ENABLE SETPOINT
(DEGREES F)
BB H
BB L
187 H
187 L
4
0
0
0
23
59
PRE-OCCUPANCY PURGE TIME (HOURS)
PRE-OCCUPANCY PURGE TIME (MINUTES)
EXHAUST DAMPER POSITION FOR EXHAUST FAN TO TURN ON
– MODULATING ONLY (PERCENT)
BC H
BC L
BD H
BD L
BE H
BE L
BF H
188 H
188 L
189 H
189 L
190 H
190 L
191 H
80
20
60
20
0
10
0
100
90
EXHAUST DAMPER POSITION FOR EXHAUST FAN TO TURN OFF
– MODULATING ONLY (PERCENT)
ECONOMIZER DAMPER POSITION FOR EXHAUST FAN TO TURN
ON – NON-MODULATING ONLY (PERCENT)
ECONOMIZER DAMPER POSITION FOR EXHAUST FAN TO TURN
OFF – NON-MODULATING ONLY (PERCENT)
SUPPLY AIR TEMPERATURE ALARM SETPOINT FOR COOLING
(DEGREES F, 0 = DISABLED)
10
0
100
90
0
80
SUPPLY AIR TEMPERATURE ALARM SETPOINT FOR HEATING
(DEGREES F, 0 = DISABLED)
0
0
120
25
SPACE SENSOR ALARM TEMPERATURE (DEGREES F, 0 =
DISABLED)
5
0
BF L
C2 H
C3 H
191 L
194 H
195 H
60
0
0
0
-
120
255
-
SPACE SENSOR ALARM TIME (MINUTES, 0 = DISABLED)
INTELLI-START RECOVERY TIME (MINUTES, 0 = DISABLED)
ASCD TIMER FOR COMPRESSOR #1 HIGH BYTE
ASCD TIMER FOR COMPRESSOR #1 LOW BYTE. (SECONDS,
COUNTS DOWN)
-
C3 L
C4 H
C4 L
C5 H
C5 L
195 L
196 H
196 L
197 H
197 L
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
ASCD TIMER FOR COMPRESSOR #2 HIGH BYTE
ASCD TIMER FOR COMPRESSOR #2 LOW BYTE (SECONDS,
COUNTS DOWN)
ASCD TIMER FOR COMPRESSOR #3 HIGH BYTE
ASCD TIMER FOR COMPRESSOR #3 LOW BYTE. (SECONDS,
COUNTS DOWN)
Continued on next page
JOHNSON CONTROLS
138
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
TABLE - 6-2 - SIMPLICITY ELITE DATA MAP (CONT.)
INITIAL/
ADDRESS ADDRESS
DEFAULT
VALUE
(HEX)
-
MIN
MAX
BIT
DESCRIPTION
(HEX)
(DEC)
VALUE VALUE
C6 H
C6 L
198 H
198 L
-
-
-
-
ASCD TIMER FOR COMPRESSOR #4 HIGH BYTE
ASCD TIMER FOR COMPRESSOR #4 LOW BYTE (SECONDS,
COUNTS DOWN)
-
COMPRESSOR #1 MINIMUM RUN TIMER HIGH BYTE (SECONDS,
COUNTS DOWN)
C7 H
C7 L
C8 H
C8 L
C9 H
C9 L
CA H
CA L
199 H
199 L
200 H
200 L
201 H
201 L
202 H
202 L
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
COMPRESSOR #1 MINIMUM RUN TIMER LOW BYTE (SECONDS,
COUNTS DOWN)
COMPRESSOR #2 MINIMUM RUN TIMER HIGH BYTE (SECONDS,
COUNTS DOWN)
COMPRESSOR #2 MINIMUM RUN TIMER LOW BYTE (SECONDS,
COUNTS DOWN)
COMPRESSOR #3 MINIMUM RUN TIMER HIGH BYTE (SECONDS,
COUNTS DOWN)
COMPRESSOR #3 MINIMUM RUN TIMER LOW BYTE (SECONDS,
COUNTS DOWN)
COMPRESSOR #4 MINIMUM RUN TIMER HIGH BYTE (SECONDS,
COUNTS DOWN)
COMPRESSOR #4 MINIMUM RUN TIMER LOW BYTE (SECONDS,
COUNTS DOWN)
CB H
CB L
CC H
CD H
CD L
CE H
CE L
203 H
203 L
204 H
205 H
205 L
206 H
206 L
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
FAN ASCD TIMER HIGH BYTE (ALWAYS ZERO)
FAN ASCD TIMER LOW BYTE. (SECONDS, COUNTS DOWN)
FAN MINIMUM RUN TIMER (SECONDS, COUNTS DOWN)
FAN ON DELAY TIMER FOR HEAT (SECONDS, COUNT DOWN)
FAN OFF DELAY TIMER FOR HEAT (SECONDS, COUNT DOWN)
FAN ON DELAY TIMER FOR COOL (SECONDS, COUNT DOWN)
FAN OFF DELAY TIMER FOR COOL (SECONDS, COUNT DOWN)
ACCUMULATED UNOCCUPIED OVERRIDE TIME (HOURS, HIGH
BYTE)
-
0
0
0
0
0
CF H
CF L
207 H
207 L
0
0
0
0
255
255
ACCUMULATED UNOCCUPIED OVERRIDE TIME (HOURS, LOW
BYTE)
6
D4 H
D4 L
D5 H
D5 L
D6 H
D7 H
212 H
212 L
213 H
213 L
214 H
215 H
-
-
0
0
0
0
0
-
100
100
100
100
100
-
SUPPLY FAN VFD OUTPUT STATUS, 0-100% (2 – 10 VDC)
EXHAUST DAMPER OUTPUT STATUS, 0-100% (2 – 10 VDC)
HOT WATER VALVE OUTPUT STATUS, 0-100% (2 – 10 VDC)
HOT GAS REHEAT VALVE OUTPUT STATUS, 0-100% (2 – 10 VDC)
ECONOMIZER DAMPER OUTPUT STATUS, 0-100% (2 – 10 VDC)
OPTION BYTE #6
-
-
-
NA
0
0
1 = COMFORT VENTILATION FOR COOLING ENABLED
1 = COMFORT VENTILATION FOR HEATING ENABLED
1 = TEMPERATURE / HUMIDITY CONTROL ENABLED
1 = HOT GAS REHEAT ALTERNATE OPERATION ENABLED
1 = NETWORK OCCUPIED FLAG: OCC IS ON
NA
1
2
3
4
5
6
1 = DIFFERENTIAL ENTHALPY MODE ENABLED
NA
7
Continued on next page
JOHNSON CONTROLS
139
User Interface Control Center
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
TABLE - 6-2 - SIMPLICITY ELITE DATA MAP (CONT.)
INITIAL/
ADDRESS ADDRESS
DEFAULT
VALUE
(HEX)
0
MIN
MAX
BIT
DESCRIPTION
(HEX)
(DEC)
VALUE VALUE
D7L
215 L
NA
0
-
-
OPTION BYTE #7
1 = ERV ENABLED
1
1 = ERV UNOCCUPIED FAN ENABLED
NA
2-7
D8 H
D8 L
D9 H
216 H
216 L
217 H
S
50
3
0
20
0
100
80
5
HOT GAS REHEAT HUMIDITY SETPOINT (PERCENT HUMIDITY)
TEMPERATURE / HUMIDITY SETPOINT (PERCENT HUMIDITY)
MAXIMUM TEMPERATURE / HUMIDITY OFFSET (DEGREES F)
TEMPERATURE / HUMIDITY VALUE THAT = 1° F OF OFFSET
(PERCENT HUMIDITY)
D9 L
217 L
5
1
10
DB H
DB L
DC H
DC L
219 H
219 L
220 H
220 L
72
68
-
45
45
10
10
99
99
50
50
OPERATING COOLING SETPOINT (DEGREES F) [CV]
OPERATING HEATING SETPOINT (DEGREES F) [CV]
OUTSIDE AIR ENTHALPY (BTUS PER POUND)
RETURN AIR ENTHALPY (BTUS PER POUND)
MAXIMUM DEMAND VENTILATION ECONOMIZER POSITION
(PERCENT OPEN)
-
DE L
DF H
E0 H
222 L
223 H
224 H
50
-
0
0
-
100
10
-
SPACE SENSOR OFFSET (0 = -5° F, 10 = +5° F)
ASCD TIMER FOR HEATING STAGE #1 (SECONDS, COUNTS
DOWN)
-
HEATING STAGE #1 MINIMUM RUN TIMER (SECONDS, COUNTS
DOWN)
E0 L
E1 H
E1 L
E2 H
E2 L
224 L
225 H
225 L
226 H
226 L
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
ASCD TIMER FOR HEATING STAGE #2 (SECONDS, COUNTS
DOWN)
HEATING STAGE #2 MINIMUM RUN TIMER (SECONDS, COUNTS
DOWN)
ASCD TIMER FOR HEATING STAGE #3 (SECONDS, COUNTS
DOWN)
HEATING STAGE #3 MINIMUM RUN TIMER (SECONDS, COUNTS
DOWN)
E3 H
E3 L
227 H
227 L
0
0
0
0
99
60
LOW AMBIENT ECONOMIZER MINIMUM POSITION (PERCENT)
LOW AMBIENT ECONOMIZER SETPOINT (DEGREES F)
140
JOHNSON CONTROLS
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
SECTION 7 – PARAMETER DESCRIPTIONS AND OPTIONS
TABLE 7-1 – DEFINITIONS
MENU ITEM
DEFINITION
THIS PARAMETER GIVES THE ACCUMULATED TIME THE UNIT
HAS PLACED IN UNOCCUPIED OVERRIDE MODE.
ACCUMULATED UNOCCUPIED OVERRIDE TIME
ACTIVE ALARM
ADDRESS
THIS IDENTIFIES THE NUMBER OF ACTIVE ALARMS PRESENT
THIS PARAMETER IS USED TO SET THE COMMUNICATION
ADDRESS FOR THE UNIT WHEN CONNECTED TO A NETWORK
THIS PARAMETER GIVES THE STATUS OF THE SUPPLY FAN AIR
PROVING SWITCH. 0 = SWITCH OPEN, 1 = SWITCH CLOSED
APS DATA
THIS PARAMETER ESTABLISHES THE BUILDING PRESSURE
SETPOINT FOR THE CONTROL OF BUILDING EXHAUST
OPERATION
BUILDING PRESSURE SETPOINT
BUILDING STATIC PRESSURE
THIS PARAMETER GIVES THE CURRENT VALUE OF THE
BUILDING STATIC PRESSURE INPUT
THIS PARAMETER MUST BE TURNED ON TO ENABLE THE USE
OF BUILDING PRESSURE IN THE OPERATION OF THE EXHAUST
FUNCTION
BUILDING STATIC PRESSURE SENSOR
INSTALLED
THIS PARAMETER MUST BE TURNED ON TO ENABLED
COMFORT VENTILATION DURING COOLING MODE OPERATION
ON A CONSTANT VOLUME UNIT
COMFORT VENTILATION FOR COOLING
ENABLED
THIS PARAMETER MUST BE TURNED ON TO ENABLE COMFORT
VENTILATION DURING HEATING MODE OPERATION ON A
CONSTANT VOLUME UNIT
COMFORT VENTILATION FOR HEATING
ENABLED
THIS PARAMETER IS THE LOWER SETPOINT USED BY THE UNIT
CONTROLLER TO DETERMINE WHEN TO SWITCH THE UNIT IN
COMFORT VENTILATION MODE
COMFORT VENTILATION LOWER SETPOINT
COMFORT VENTILATION UPPER SETPOINT
THIS PARAMETER IS THE UPPER SETPOINT USED BY THE UNIT
CONTROLLER TO DETERMINE WHEN TO SWITCH THE UNIT IN
COMFORT VENTILATION MODE
THIS IS USED TO DETERMINE THE STATUS OF THE OFF CYCLE
TIMER. ON MEANS THE COMPRESSOR 1 IS IN THIS MODE
COMP 1 ASCD ACTIVE
COMP 1 ASCD TIMER
COMP 1 MIN RUN TIME
COMP 1 OUTPUT
THIS GIVES THE ACTUAL TIME OF THE OFF CYCLE TIMER FOR
COMPRESSOR 1 IN SECONDS.
THIS GIVES THE ACTUAL TIME OF THE MINIMUM RUN TIME FOR
COMPRESSOR 1 IN SECONDS.
THIS GIVES THE STATUS OF THE BINARY OUTPUT FROM THE
UNIT CONTROLLER TO COMPRESSOR CIRCUIT 1
THIS IS THE STATUS OF THE BINARY INPUT FROM THE
COMPRESSOR OVERLOAD FOR COMPRESSOR SYSTEM 1 TO
THE UNIT CONTROLLER. ON - OKAY, OFF - FAULTED.
7
COMP 1 OVERLOAD SWITCH
THIS IS USED TO DETERMINE THE STATUS OF THE OFF CYCLE
TIMER. ON MEANS THE COMPRESSOR 2 IS IN THIS MODE
COMP 2 ASCD ACTIVE
COMP 2 ASCD TIMER
COMP 2 MIN RUN TIME
THIS GIVES THE ACTUAL TIME OF THE OFF CYCLE TIMER FOR
COMPRESSOR 2 IN SECONDS.
THIS GIVES THE ACTUAL TIME OF THE MINIMUM RUN TIME FOR
COMPRESSOR 2 IN SECONDS.
Continued on next page
JOHNSON CONTROLS
141
Parameter Description and Options
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
TABLE 7-1 – DEFINITIONS (CONTINUED)
MENU ITEM
DEFINITION
THIS GIVES THE STATUS OF THE BINARY OUTPUT FROM THE
UNIT CONTROLLER TO COMPRESSOR CIRCUIT 2
COMP 2 OUTPUT
THIS IS THE STATUS OF THE BINARY INPUT FROM THE
COMPRESSOR OVERLOAD FOR COMPRESSOR SYSTEM 2 TO
THE UNIT CONTROLLER. ON - OKAY, OFF - FAULTED.
COMP 2 OVERLOAD SWITCH
THIS IS USED TO DETERMINE THE STATUS OF THE OFF CYCLE
TIMER. ON MEANS THE COMPRESSOR 3 IS IN THIS MODE
COMP 3 ASCD ACTIVE
COMP 3 ASCD TIMER
COMP 3 MIN RUN TIME
COMP 3 OUTPUT
THIS GIVES THE ACTUAL TIME OF THE OFF CYCLE TIMER FOR
COMPRESSOR 3 IN SECONDS.
THIS GIVES THE ACTUAL TIME OF THE MINIMUM RUN TIME FOR
COMPRESSOR 3 IN SECONDS.
THIS GIVES THE STATUS OF THE BINARY OUTPUT FROM THE
UNIT CONTROLLER TO COMPRESSOR CIRCUIT 3
THIS IS THE STATUS OF THE BINARY INPUT FROM THE
COMPRESSOR OVERLOAD FOR COMPRESSOR SYSTEM 3 TO
THE UNIT CONTROLLER. ON - OKAY, OFF - FAULTED.
COMP 3 OVERLOAD SWITCH
THIS IS USED TO DETERMINE THE STATUS OF THE OFF CYCLE
TIMER. ON MEANS THE COMPRESSOR 4 IS IN THIS MODE
COMP 4 ASCD ACTIVE
COMP 4 ASCD TIMER
COMP 4 MIN RUN TIME
COMP 4 OUTPUT
THIS GIVES THE ACTUAL TIME OF THE OFF CYCLE TIMER FOR
COMPRESSOR 4 IN SECONDS.
THIS GIVES THE ACTUAL TIME OF THE MINIMUM RUN TIME FOR
COMPRESSOR 4 IN SECONDS.
THIS GIVES THE STATUS OF THE BINARY OUTPUT FROM THE
UNIT CONTROLLER TO COMPRESSOR CIRCUIT 4
THIS IS THE STATUS OF THE BINARY INPUT FROM THE
COMPRESSOR OVERLOAD FOR COMPRESSOR SYSTEM 4 TO
THE UNIT CONTROLLER. ON - OKAY, OFF - FAULTED.
COMP 4 OVERLOAD SWITCH
THIS IS THE NUMBER OF HOURS THAT COMPRESSOR SYSTEM
1 HAS BEEN OPERATIVE
COMPRESSOR #1 ACCUMULATED RUNTIME
COMPRESSOR #2 ACCUMULATED RUNTIME
COMPRESSOR #3 ACCUMULATED RUNTIME
COMPRESSOR #4 ACCUMULATED RUNTIME
COMPRESSORS AVAILABLE FOR COOLING
CONDENSER FAN #1 OUTPUT
THIS IS THE NUMBER OF HOURS THAT COMPRESSOR SYSTEM
2 HAS BEEN OPERATIVE
THIS IS THE NUMBER OF HOURS THAT COMPRESSOR SYSTEM
3 HAS BEEN OPERATIVE
THIS IS THE NUMBER OF HOURS THAT COMPRESSOR SYSTEM
4 HAS BEEN OPERATIVE
THIS PARAMETER IDENTIFIES THE NUMBERS OF COMPRESSOR
THE UNIT CONTROLLER IS SET UP TO CONTROL
THIS GIVES THE STATUS OF THE BINARY OUTPUT FROM THE
UNIT CONTROLLER TO THE #1 CONDENSER FAN, OFF OR ON
THIS GIVES THE STATUS OF THE BINARY OUTPUT FROM THE
UNIT CONTROLLER TO THE #2 CONDENSER FAN, OFF OR ON
CONDENSER FAN #2 OUTPUT
WHEN THIS PARAMETER IS TURNED ON, ON A CONSTANT
VOLUME UNIT THE SUPPLY FAN WILL OPERATE WHENEVER
THE UNIT IS IN THE OCCUPIED MODE
CONTINUOUS INDOOR FAN OPERATION WITH
SENSOR
THIS IDENTIFIES IF THE UNIT CONTROLLER IS IN THE COMFORT
VENTILATION MODE. OFF NOT IN MODE, ON IN COMFORT
VENTILATION MODE.
CONTROL IN COMFORT VENTILATION
Continued on next page
JOHNSON CONTROLS
142
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
TABLE 7-1 – DEFINITIONS (CONTINUED)
MENU ITEM
DEFINITION
IN THE INTERMITTENT FAN MODE THIS IS THE TIME DELAY
BETWEEN THE TIME THE COOLING CALL IS TERMINATED AND
THE SHUT DOWN OF THE SUPPLY FAN
COOL FAN OFF DELAY
IN THE INTERMITTENT FAN MODE THIS IS THE TIME DELAY
BETWEEN THE TIME THE COOLING CALL IS INITIATED AND THE
START OF THE SUPPLY FAN
COOL FAN ON DELAY
THIS PARAMETER MUST BE TURNED ON TO ALLOW COOLING
OPERATION
COOLING MODE OPERATION ENABLE
COOL 1 (Y1)
THIS IS THE STATUS OF THE BINARY INPUT TO TERMINAL Y1
- FIRST STAGE COOLING
THIS IS THE STATUS OF THE BINARY INPUT TO TERMINAL Y2
- SECOND STAGE COOLING
COOL 2 (Y2)
THIS IS THE STATUS OF THE BINARY INPUT TO TERMINAL Y3
- THIRD STAGE COOLING
COOL 3 (Y3)
THIS IS THE STATUS OF THE BINARY INPUT TO TERMINAL Y4
- FOURTH STAGE COOLING
COOL 4 (Y4)
THIS IDENTIFIES THE ADDRESS OF THE UNIT ON THE
NETWORK
CURRENT BUS ADDRESS
CV CURRENT OPERATING COOLING SETPOINT
CV CURRENT OPERATING HEATING SETPOINT
CV OCCUPIED COOLING SET POINT
CV OCCUPIED HEATING SET POINT
THIS PARAMETER IDENTIFIES THE COOLING SET POINT THE
UNIT CONTROLLER IS CONTROLLING TO COOLING TOO
THIS PARAMETER IDENTIFIES THE HEATING SET POINT THE
UNIT CONTROLLER IS CONTROLLING TO HEATING TOO
THIS IS THE SPACE OR RETURN AIR TEMPERATURE THE UNIT
WILL CONTROL TO WHEN IN THE OCCUPIED COOLING MODE.
THIS IS THE SPACE OR RETURN AIR TEMPERATURE THE UNIT
WILL CONTROL TO WHEN IN THE OCCUPIED HEATING MODE.
THIS IS THE SPACE OR RETURN AIR TEMPERATURE THE UNIT
WILL CONTROL TO WHEN IN THE UNOCCUPIED COOLING
MODE.
CV UNOCCUPIED COOLING SET POINT
THIS IS THE SPACE OR RETURN AIR TEMPERATURE THE UNIT
WILL CONTROL TO WHEN IN THE UNOCCUPIED HEATING MODE.
CV UNOCCUPIED HEATING SET POINT
DAY OF MONTH
THIS PARAMETER IS USED TO ENTER THE CURRENT DAY OF
THE MONTH, 1 - 31
THIS PARAMETER IS USED TO ENTER THE DAY OF THE WEEK
(1-7) WITH 1 EQUAL TO SUNDAY
DAY OF WEEK
THIS PARAMETER MUST BE TURNED ON TO ENABLE DEMAND
VENTILATION. DEMAND VENTILATION INCREASE THE AMOUNT
OF VENTILATION AIR IN RESPONSE TO A INCREASE IN THE CO2
LEVEL IN THE CONDITIONED SPACE
DEMAND VENTILATION (IAQ) ENABLED
7
DEMAND VENTILATION (IAQ) VALUE (CO2)
DIFFERENTIAL ENTHALPY MODE ENABLED
THIS THE CO2 INPUT VALUE TO THE UNIT CONTROLLER IN PPM
THIS PARAMETER MUST BE TURNED ON IN ORDER TO USE
DIFFERENTIAL ENTHALPY
THIS PARAMETER GIVE THE STATUS OF THE DIRTY FILTER
SWITCH, 0 = CLEAN, 1 = DIRTY
DIRTY FILTER SWITCH DATA
Continued on next page
JOHNSON CONTROLS
143
Parameter Description and Options
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
TABLE 7-1 – DEFINITIONS (CONTINUED)
MENU ITEM
DEFINITION
THIS PARAMETER MUST BE SET TO ON TO ENABLE THE DIRTY
FILTER FEATURE ON THE UNIT. A DIRTY FILTER SWITCH MUST
ALSO BE INSTALLED FOR THIS FEATURE TO FUNCTION
DIRTY FILTER SWITCH INSTALLED
THE UNIT CONTROLLER VARIES THE SPEED OF THE SUPPLY
FAN ON A VAV UNIT TO MAINTAIN THIS PROGRAMMED
SETPOINT
DUCT PRESSURE SETPOINT
IF THE DUCT STATIC PRESSURE ON A VAV UNIT EXCEED THIS
VALUE THE UNIT WILL SHUT DOWN THE FAN AND LOCK OUT
THE UNIT
DUCT PRESSURE SHUTDOWN SETPOINT
THIS PARAMETER GIVES THE CURRENT VALUE OF THE DUCT
STATIC PRESSURE INPUT
DUCT STATIC READING
THIS GIVES THE STATUS OF THE UNIT CONTROLLER OUTPUT
TO THE ECONOMIZER DAMPER IN %
ECONOMIZER DAMPER OUTPUT STATUS
WHEN ON/OFF EXHAUST IS BEING USED THIS IS THE POSITION
OF THE ECONOMIZER DAMPER TO TURN OFF THE EXHAUST
FAN
ECONOMIZER DAMPER POSITION FOR
EXHAUST TURN OFF
ECONOMIZER DAMPER POSITION FOR
EXHAUST TURN ON
WHEN ON/OFF EXHAUST IS BEING USED THIS IS THE POSITION
OF THE ECONOMIZER DAMPER TO TURN ON THE EXHAUST FAN
ON A CONSTANT VOLUME UNIT THE UNIT CONTROLLER WILL
TRY AND MAINTAIN THE SUPPLY AIR TEMPERATURE AT THIS
SETPOINT IN THE ECONOMIZER MODE WITH A FIRST STAGE
COOLING CALL
ECONOMIZER FIRST STAGE SETPOINT
THIS PARAMETER MUST BE TURN ON TO ENABLE ECONOMIZER
OPERATION
ECONOMIZER INSTALLED
ECONOMIZER IS CURRENTLY USING FREE
COOLING
THIS IDENTIFIES IF THE UNIT CONTROLLER IS USING OUTDOOR
AIR TO SATISFY THE COOLING DEMAND, OFF OR ON
THIS PARAMETER MUST BE TURNED ON TO ENABLE
ECONOMIZER LOADING
ECONOMIZER LOADING ENABLE
THIS PARAMETER ESTABLISHES THE POSITION OF THE
OUTDOOR DAMPER WHEN THE ECONOMIZER IS INACTIVE AND
THE UNIT IS IN THE OCCUPIED MODE
ECONOMIZER MINIMUM POSITION
THIS IS THE OUTDOOR ENTHALPY SETTING WHICH
DETERMINES WHEN TO SWITCH INTO AND OUT OF
ECONOMIZER OPERATION IN SINGLE ENTHALPY ECONOMIZER
MODE
ECONOMIZER OUTSIDE AIR ENTHALPY
SETPOINT
ECONOMIZER OUTSIDE AIR TEMP ENABLE
SETPOINT
THIS IS THE OUTDOOR TEMPERATURE WHICH DETERMINES
WHEN TO SWITCH INTO AND OUT OF ECONOMIZER OPERATION
ON A CONSTANT VOLUME UNIT THE UNIT CONTROLLER WILL
TRY AND MAINTAIN THE SUPPLY AIR TEMPERATURE AT THIS
SETPOINT IN THE ECONOMIZER MODE WITH A SECOND STAGE
COOLING CALL
ECONOMIZER SECOND STAGE SETPOINT
ERV INSTALLED
THIS PARAMETER MUST BE TURNED ON IF AN ENERGY
RECOVERY VENTILATOR IS INSTALLED. THIS FEATURE IS
CURRENTLY NOT AVAILABLE ON THESE UNITS
Continued on next page
JOHNSON CONTROLS
144
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
TABLE 7-1 – DEFINITIONS (CONTINUED)
MENU ITEM
DEFINITION
THIS PARAMETER ALLOWS THE EXHAUST FAN TO OPERATE
ANYTIME THE SUPPLY FAN IS ON. THIS FEATURE IS REQUIRED
WHEN AN ENERGY RECOVERY VENTILATOR IS INSTALLED.
THIS FEATURE IS CURRENTLY NOT USED ON THESE UNITS.
ERV UNOCCUPIED FAN ENABLE
WHEN MODULATING DAMPER EXHAUST IS BEING USED THIS IS
THE POSITION OF THE EXHAUST DAMPER TO TURN OFF THE
EXHAUST FAN
EXHAUST DAMPER POSITION FOR EXHAUST
TO TURN OFF
WHEN MODULATING DAMPER EXHAUST IS BEING USED THIS
IS THE POSITION OF THE EXHAUST DAMPER TO TURN ON THE
EXHAUST FAN
EXHAUST DAMPER POSITION FOR EXHAUST
TO TURN ON
THIS GIVES THE STATUS OF THE BINARY OUTPUT FROM THE
UNIT CONTROLLER TO THE EXHAUST FAN, OFF OR ON
EXHAUST FAN OUTPUT
THIS GIVES THE STATUS OF THE ANALOG UNIT CONTROLLER
EXHAUST DAMPER / VFD OUTPUT STATUS
OUTPUT TO THE EXHAUST DAMPER OR EXHAUST FAN VFD IN
%
THIS PARAMETER IDENTIFIES TO THE UNIT CONTROLLER THAT
AN EXHAUST FAN VFD IS INSTALLED. THE PARAMETER MUST
BE TURNED ON TO ENABLE THIS FEATURE
EXHAUST VFD INSTALLED
THIS GIVES THE STATUS OF THE BINARY INPUT TO THE G
TERMINAL OF THE UNIT CONTROLLER, OFF OR ON
FAN (G) THERMOSTAT INPUT
FAN ASD TIMER
THIS IS THE STATUS OF THE SUPPLY FAN OFF DELAY IN
SECONDS
THIS GIVES THE STATUS OF THE COOLING TIME OFF DELAY IN
SECONDS
FAN OFF DELAY TIMER FOR COOL
FAN OFF DELAY TIMER FOR HEAT
FAN ON DELAY TIMER FOR COOL
FAN ON DELAY TIMER FOR HEAT
THIS GIVES THE STATUS OF THE COOLING TIME OFF DELAY IN
SECONDS
THIS GIVES THE STATUS OF THE COOLING TIME ON DELAY IN
SECONDS
THIS GIVES THE STATUS OF THE COOLING TIME ON DELAY IN
SECONDS
THIS IS THE BINARY INPUT FROM THE HYDRONIC HEAT FREEZE
STAT TO THE UNIT CONTROLLER. OFF = FAULTED, ON =
NORMAL OPERATION
FREEZE THERMOSTAT SWITCH
GAS VALVE #1
THIS IS THE STATUS OF THE BINARY INPUT FROM THE GAS
VALVE FOR HEAT SECTION 1 TO THE UNIT CONTROLLER OFF /
ON
THIS IS THE STATUS OF THE BINARY INPUT FROM THE GAS
GAS VALVE #2
VALVE FOR HEAT SECTION 2 TO THE UNIT CONTROLLER OFF /
ON
7
THIS IS THE STATUS OF THE BINARY INPUT FROM THE GAS
VALVE FOR HEAT SECTION 3 TO THE UNIT CONTROLLER OFF /
ON
GAS VALVE #3
THIS IS THE STATUS OF THE BINARY INPUT TO TERMINAL W1
- FIRST STAGE HEATING
HEAT 1 (W1)
THIS GIVES THE ACTUAL TIME OF THE OFF CYCLE TIMER FOR
HEAT SECTION 1 IN SECONDS.
HEAT 1 ASCD TIMER
Continued on next page
JOHNSON CONTROLS
145
Parameter Description and Options
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
TABLE 7-1 – DEFINITIONS (CONTINUED)
MENU ITEM
DEFINITION
THIS GIVES THE ACTUAL TIME OF THE MINIMUM RUN TIME
TIMER FOR HEAT SECTION 1 IN SECONDS
HEAT 1 MIN RUN TIMER
THIS IS THE STATUS OF THE BINARY INPUT TO TERMINAL W2
- SECOND STAGE HEATING
HEAT 2 (W2)
THIS GIVES THE ACTUAL TIME OF THE OFF CYCLE TIMER FOR
HEAT SECTION 2 IN SECONDS.
HEAT 2 ASCD TIMER
HEAT 2 MIN RUN TIMER
HEAT 3 (W3)
THIS GIVES THE ACTUAL TIME OF THE MINIMUM RUN TIME
TIMER FOR HEAT SECTION 2 IN SECONDS
THIS IS THE STATUS OF THE BINARY INPUT TO TERMINAL W3
- THIRD STAGE HEATING
THIS GIVES THE ACTUAL TIME OF THE OFF CYCLE TIMER FOR
HEAT SECTION 3 IN SECONDS.
HEAT 3 ASCD TIMER
HEAT 3 MIN RUN TIMER
THIS GIVES THE ACTUAL TIME OF THE MINIMUM RUN TIME
TIMER FOR HEAT SECTION 3 IN SECONDS
IN THE INTERMITTENT FAN MODE THIS IS THE TIME DELAY
BETWEEN THE TIME THE HEAT CALL IS TERMINATED AND THE
SHUT DOWN OF THE SUPPLY FAN
HEAT FAN OFF DELAY
HEAT FAN ON DELAY
IN THE INTERMITTENT FAN MODE THIS IS THE TIME DELAY
BETWEEN THE TIME THE HEATING OPERATION IS VERIFIED
AND THE START OF SUPPLY FAN OPERATION
THIS PARAMETER MUST BE TURNED ON TO ALLOW HEATING
OPERATION
HEATING MODE ENABLED FOR OPERATION
HEATING NUMBER #1 ACCUMULATED RUNTIME
HEATING NUMBER #2 ACCUMULATED RUNTIME
HEATING NUMBER #3 ACCUMULATED RUNTIME
HEATING OUTPUT #1 (H1)
THIS IS THE NUMBER OF HOURS THAT HEATING SYSTEM 1 HAS
BEEN OPERATIVE
THIS IS THE NUMBER OF HOURS THAT HEATING SYSTEM 2 HAS
BEEN OPERATIVE
THIS IS THE NUMBER OF HOURS THAT HEATING SYSTEM 3 HAS
BEEN OPERATIVE
THIS IS THE STATUS OF THE BINARY OUTPUT FROM THE UNIT
CONTROLLER TO HEAT SECTION # 1, OFF/ON
THIS IS THE STATUS OF THE BINARY OUTPUT FROM THE UNIT
CONTROLLER TO HEAT SECTION # 2, OFF/ON
HEATING OUTPUT #2 (H2)
THIS IS THE STATUS OF THE BINARY OUTPUT FROM THE UNIT
CONTROLLER TO HEAT SECTION # 3, OFF/ON
HEATING OUTPUT #3 (H3)
THIS PARAMETER MUST BE TURNED ON WHEN HOT GAS
BYPASS IS INSTALLED
HOT GAS PRESENT ON COMPRESSOR # 1
HOT GAS REHEAT
THIS PARAMETER WOULD BE TURNED ON TO ENABLE HOT GAS
REHEAT. THIS FEATURE IS NOT AVAILABLE ON THESE UNITS
THIS GIVES THE STATUS OF THE ANALOG UNIT CONTROLLER
OUTPUT TO THE HYDRONIC VALVE IN %
HOT WATER VALVE OUTPUT STATUS
THIS GIVES THE STATUS OF THE ANALOG UNIT CONTROLLER
OUTPUT TO THE HYDRONIC VALVE IN % WHEN THE UNIT IS
PROGRAMMED FOR A REVERSE ACTING VALVE
HOT WATER VALVE OUTPUT STATUS
(REVERSE ACTING)
THIS PARAMETER IS USED TO ENTER THE HOUR OF THE
CURRENT TIME BASED ON A 24 HOUR SCHEDULE, 13 WOULD
BE 1 PM
HOUR
Continued on next page
JOHNSON CONTROLS
146
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
TABLE 7-1 – DEFINITIONS (CONTINUED)
MENU ITEM
DEFINITION
THIS IS THE STATUS OF THE BINARY INPUT FROM THE HIGH
PRESSURE SWITCH FOR COMPRESSOR SYSTEM 1 TO THE
UNIT CONTROLLER. ON - OKAY, OFF - FAULTED.
HSP1
THIS IS THE STATUS OF THE BINARY INPUT FROM THE HIGH
PRESSURE SWITCH FOR COMPRESSOR SYSTEM 2 TO THE
UNIT CONTROLLER. ON - OKAY, OFF - FAULTED.
HSP2
HSP3
HSP4
THIS IS THE STATUS OF THE BINARY INPUT FROM THE HIGH
PRESSURE SWITCH FOR COMPRESSOR SYSTEM 3 TO THE
UNIT CONTROLLER. ON - OKAY, OFF - FAULTED.
THIS IS THE STATUS OF THE BINARY INPUT FROM THE HIGH
PRESSURE SWITCH FOR COMPRESSOR SYSTEM 4 TO THE
UNIT CONTROLLER. ON - OKAY, OFF - FAULTED.
THIS PARAMETER REVERSES THE ACTION OF THE HYDRONIC
VALVE. WHEN THE PARAMETER IS TURNED ON A 2 VOLT INPUT
TO THE VALVE IS FULL OPEN AND A 10 VOLT INPUT TO THE
VALVE IS FULL CLOSED
HYDRONIC HEAT ACTUATOR VALVE REVERSE
ACTING
THIS PARAMETER MUST BE TURNED ON TO ENABLE HYDRONIC
HEATING OPERATION
HYDRONIC HEATING ENABLED
THIS PARAMETER ESTABLISHES THE SETPOINT FOR
CONSTANT VOLUME HYDRONIC HEATING OPERATION DURING
FIRST STAGE OPERATION
HYDRONIC HEATING STAGE #1 SUPPLY AIR
SETPOINT
THIS PARAMETER ESTABLISHES THE SETPOINT FOR
CONSTANT VOLUME HYDRONIC HEATING OPERATION DURING
SECOND STAGE OPERATION AND ALSO THE CONTROL
SETPOINT FOR VAV HYDRONIC HEATING OPERATION
HYDRONIC HEATING STAGE #2 SUPPLY AIR
SETPOINT
THIS PARAMETER IDENTIFIES TO THE UNIT CONTROLLER THE
RANGE OF THE CO2 SENSOR IN PPM
IAQ SENSOR RANGE
IAQ SETPOINT
THE UNIT CONTROLLER WILL TRY AND MAINTAIN THE CO2
LEVEL IN THE SPACE TO WITHIN +/- 100 PPM OF THIS VALUE
THIS IS THE STATUS OF THE BINARY INPUT TO TERMINAL G
- SUPPLY FAN
INDOOR FAN (G)
THIS GIVES THE STATUS OF THE MINIMUM SUPPLY FAN RUN
TIME IN SECONDS
INDOOR FAN MIN RUN TIME
INDOOR FAN OUTPUT
INDOOR FAN VFD OUTPUT
INPUT AIR PROVING SWITCH
THIS GIVES THE STATUS OF THE BINARY OUTPUT FROM THE
UNIT CONTROLLER TO THE SUPPLY FAN
THIS GIVES THE STATUS OF THE ANALOG OUTPUT FROM THE
UNIT CONTROLLER TO THE SUPPLY FAN IN %
THIS IS THE STATUS OF THE AIR PROVING SWITCH INPUT TO
THE UNIT CONTROLLER, OFF OR ON
7
THIS IS THE STATUS OF THE DIRTY FILTER SWITCH INPUT TO
THE UNIT CONTROLLER, OFF - CLEAN FILTER, ON - DIRTY
FILTER
INPUT DIRTY FILTER SWITCH
THIS GIVES THE STATUS OF THE BINARY INPUT FROM THE
SUPPLY FAN OVERLOAD TO THE UNIT CONTROLLER, OFF -
FAULT, ON - NORMAL OPERATION
INPUT INDOOR FAN OVERLOAD SWITCH
Continued on next page
JOHNSON CONTROLS
147
Parameter Description and Options
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
TABLE 7-1 – DEFINITIONS (CONTINUED)
MENU ITEM
DEFINITION
THIS FEATURE IS ONLY AVAILABLE ON CONSTANT VOLUME
UNITS WITH A SPACE SENSOR USING THE INTERNAL
SCHEDULE. THIS OPTION BRINGS THE UNIT UP TO THE CV
OCCUPIED COOLING OR CV OCCUPIED HEATING SETPOINTS
PRIOR TO THE BEGINNING OF OCCUPIED OPERATION.
INTELLI-START OPERATION ENABLE
LAST ALARM 1
LAST ALARM 2
LAST ALARM 3
LAST ALARM 4
LAST ALARM 5
THIS PARAMETER IDENTIFIES THE MOST RECENT ALARM
THIS PARAMETER IDENTIFIES THE ALARM PRECEDING ALARM 1
THIS PARAMETER IDENTIFIES THE ALARM PRECEDING ALARM 2
THIS PARAMETER IDENTIFIES THE ALARM PRECEDING ALARM 3
THIS PARAMETER IDENTIFIES THE ALARM OLDEST IN HISTORY
LEAD-LAG EQUALIZE COMPRESSOR RUN TIME THIS PARAMETER ENABLES LEAD LAG OPERATION FOR THE
ENABLED
COMPRESSOR, OFF OR ON
THIS GIVES THE STATUS OF THE BINARY INPUT FROM THE
LIMIT SWITCH TO THE UNIT CONTROLLER FOR HEAT SECTION 1
IN SECONDS. OFF - FAULTED, ON - NORMAL
LIMIT SWITCH #1
THIS GIVES THE STATUS OF THE BINARY INPUT FROM THE
LIMIT SWITCH TO THE UNIT CONTROLLER FOR HEAT SECTION 2
IN SECONDS. OFF - FAULTED, ON - NORMAL
LIMIT SWITCH #2
LIMIT SWITCH #3
THIS GIVES THE STATUS OF THE BINARY INPUT FROM THE
LIMIT SWITCH TO THE UNIT CONTROLLER FOR HEAT SECTION 3
IN SECONDS. OFF - FAULTED, ON - NORMAL
THIS FEATURE CAN BE USED TO TEMPORALLY REDUCE THE
ELECTRICAL CONSUMPTION OF THE UNIT BY TURNING OFF
ALL OF THE ACTIVE COMPRESSORS. THIS FEATURE IS ONLY
AVAILABLE THROUGH A COMMUNICATED INPUT.
LOADSHED
THIS PARAMETER IDENTIFIES IF THE SUPPLY VOLTAGE TO THE
CONTROL IS OUTSIDE THE ACCEPTABLE LIMITS. OFF = WITHIN
LIMITS, ON = FAULTED, OUTSIDE LIMITS
LOW AC SUPPLY VOLTAGE DETECTED
THIS PARAMETER ESTABLISHES THE MINIMUM POSITION
FOR THE OUTDOOR AIR DAMPER DURING LOW AMBIENT
OPERATION
LOW AMBIENT ECONOMIZER MINIMUM
POSITION
THIS PARAMETER IS USED TO TURN ON AND SET THE
OUTDOOR TEMPERATURE AT WHICH THIS FEATURE BECOMES
ACTIVE. A 0 VALUE TURNS THE FEATURE OFF. THIS FEATURE
REDUCES THE MINIMUM VENTILATION POSITION OF THE
OUTDOOR DAMPER DURING TIMES OF COLD OUTDOOR
TEMPERATURES
LOW AMBIENT ECONOMIZER SETPOINT
THIS PARAMETER MUST BE TURNED ON IF A LOW AMBIENT
VFD IS INSTALLED ON THE CONDENSER FAN. THIS ALLOWS
COMPRESSOR OPERATION BELOW 45.0° F
LOW AMBIENT KIT INSTALLED
THIS IS THE STATUS OF THE BINARY INPUT FROM THE LOW
PRESSURE SWITCH FOR COMPRESSOR SYSTEM 1 TO THE
UNIT CONTROLLER. ON - OKAY, OFF - FAULTED.
LPS1
LPS2
THIS IS THE STATUS OF THE BINARY INPUT FROM THE LOW
PRESSURE SWITCH FOR COMPRESSOR SYSTEM 2 TO THE
UNIT CONTROLLER. ON - OKAY, OFF - FAULTED.
Continued on next page
JOHNSON CONTROLS
148
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
TABLE 7-1 – DEFINITIONS (CONTINUED)
MENU ITEM
DEFINITION
THIS IS THE STATUS OF THE BINARY INPUT FROM THE LOW
PRESSURE SWITCH FOR COMPRESSOR SYSTEM 3 TO THE
UNIT CONTROLLER. ON - OKAY, OFF - FAULTED.
LPS3
THIS IS THE STATUS OF THE BINARY INPUT FROM THE LOW
PRESSURE SWITCH FOR COMPRESSOR SYSTEM 4 TO THE
UNIT CONTROLLER. ON - OKAY, OFF - FAULTED.
LPS4
THIS PARAMETER ESTABLISHED THE MAXIMUM POSITION
THE OUTDOOR DAMPER CAN OPEN TO IN THE DEMAND
VENTILATION MODE
MAXIMUM IAQ ECONOMIZER POSITION
THIS PARAMETER GIVES THE STATUS OF THE UNOCCUPIED
METER OF UNOCCUPIED OVERRIDE ENABLED OVERRIDE INPUT. OFF MEANS IT IS NOT IN OVERRIDE MODE
AND ON MEANS IT IS IN OVERRIDE MODE.
WHEN THIS OPTION IS TURNED ON THE TEMPERATURE DATA
METRIC OPERATION
WILL BE CONVERTED TO METRIC UNITS. 0 = IMPERIAL, 1 =
METRIC
THIS PARAMETER ESTABLISHES THE MINIMUM RUN TIME FOR
THE COMPRESSORS, 1 TO 10 MINUTES
MINIMUM RUN TIME FOR COMPRESSORS
THIS PARAMETER IS USED TO ENTER THE MINUTES OF THE
CURRENT TIME.
MINUTE
THIS PARAMETER MUST BE TURNED ON IN ORDER TO USE
MODULATING EXHAUST, EITHER DAMPER OR VFD
MODULATING POWER EXHAUST INSTALLED
MONTH
THIS PARAMETER IS USED TO ENTER THE CURRENT MONTH 1
TO 12. FOR EXAMPLE 1 WOULD BE JANUARY
THIS PARAMETER IS USED TO DETERMINE THE ON AND OFF
POINTS FOR VAV OCCUPIED HEATING OPERATION IN THE
STAND ALONE OR SPACE SENSOR MODE OF OPERATION. IT
IS ALSO USED TO CONTROL THE HEATING OPTION IN THE
MORNING WARM-UP MODE.
MORNING WARM-UP / VAV RETURN AIR TEMP
SETPOINT
THIS PARAMETER MUST BE TURNED ON TO ENABLE MORNING
WARM-UP OPERATION
MORNING WARM-UP ENABLE
NETWORK OCCUPIED FLAG
OCC INPUT
THIS GIVES THE STATUS OF THE COMMUNICATED OCCUPIED
COMMAND, OFF UNOCCUPIED, ON OCCUPIED
THIS IS THE STATUS OF THE BINARY INPUT TO TERMINAL OCC
- OCCUPIED INPUT
THIS PARAMETER MUST BE TURNED ON IN ORDER TO USE THE
HARD WIRED OR COMMUNICATED OCCUPIED INPUT. IT MUST
BE TURNED OFF IN ORDER TO USE THE DAILY OR HOLIDAY
SCHEDULING FEATURE
OCCUPIED INPUT ENABLED
THIS PARAMETER ESTABLISHES AN OUTDOOR SET POINT TO
LOCKOUT COOLING OPERATION. WHEN THE TEMPERATURE IS
BELOW THIS SETTING COOLING IS LOCKED OUT
7
OUTDOOR AIR TEMP COOLING LOCKOUT
THIS PARAMETER ESTABLISHES AN OUTDOOR SET POINT TO
LOCKOUT HEATING OPERATION. WHEN THE TEMPERATURE IS
ABOVE THIS SETTING HEATING IS LOCKED OUT
OUTDOOR AIR TEMP HEATING LOCKOUT
OUTSIDE AIR ENTHALPY
THIS PARAMETER IS THE CALCULATED VALUE FOR THE
OUTDOOR AIR ENTHALPY
Continued on next page
JOHNSON CONTROLS
149
Parameter Description and Options
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
TABLE 7-1 – DEFINITIONS (CONTINUED)
MENU ITEM
DEFINITION
THIS PARAMETER GIVES THE CURRENT VALUE OF THE
OUTSIDE AIR HUMIDITY INPUT
OUTSIDE AIR HUMIDITY
THIS PARAMETERS IDENTIFIES TO THE UNIT CONTROLLER
THAT AN OUTDOOR AIR HUMIDITY SENSOR IS INSTALLED
OUTSIDE AIR HUMIDITY SENSOR INSTALLED
OUTSIDE AIR TEMP
THIS PARAMETER GIVES THE CURRENT VALUE FOR THE
OUTDOOR AIR TEMPERATURE INPUT
THIS PARAMETER MUST BE TURNED ON TO ENABLE POWER
EXHAUST OPERATION
POWER EXHAUST INSTALLED
PRE-OCCUPANCY PURGE ENABLE
THIS PARAMETER IS USED TO TURN ON THE PRE-OCCUPANCY
PURGE OPTION. THIS FEATURE TURNS ON THE SUPPLY FAN
AND OPENS THE OUTDOOR AIR DAMPER PRIOR TO GOING
INTO THE OCCUPIED MODE.
PRE-OCCUPANCY PURGE TIME (HOURS OF
DAY)
THIS PARAMETER ESTABLISHES THE NUMBER OF HOURS
PRIOR TO THE OCCUPIED START TIME THAT THE PRE-
OCCUPANCY PURGE WOULD START
PRE-OCCUPANCY PURGE TIME (MINUTES OF
DAY)
THIS PARAMETER ESTABLISHES THE NUMBER OF MINUTES
PRIOR TO THE OCCUPIED START TIME THAT THE PRE-
OCCUPANCY PURGE WOULD START
PURGE SWITCH
REDLINE
THIS IS THE STATUS OF THE BINARY INPUT TO TERMINAL
PURGE - PURGE MODE
THIS FEATURE CAN BE USED TO TEMPORALLY REDUCE THE
ELECTRICAL CONSUMPTION OF THE UNIT BY TURNING OFF
SOME OF THE ACTIVE COMPRESSORS. THIS FEATURE IS ONLY
AVAILABLE THROUGH A COMMUNICATED INPUT.
REMOTE CONTROL INPUT ENABLE FOR THIRD THIS ALLOWS THE USE OF AN EXTERNAL 0 TO 10 VDC SIGNAL
PARTY BAS
TO RESET THE SUPPLY AIR TEMPERATURE SETPOINT ON VAV
UNITS.
REMOTE CONTROL INPUT VALUE
RETURN AIR ENTHALPY
GIVES THE VALUE OF THE 0 TO 10 VDC REMOTE CONTROL
INPUT FOR THE REMOTE CONTROL OF THE DAMPERS
THIS PARAMETER IS THE CALCULATED VALUE FOR THE
RETURN AIR ENTHALPY
RETURN AIR HUMIDITY
THIS PARAMETER GIVES THE CURRENT VALUE OF THE
RETURN AIR HUMIDITY INPUT
RETURN AIR HUMIDITY SENSOR INSTALLED
THIS IS THE RETURN ENTHALPY SETTING WHICH THE UNIT
CONTROLLER USES TO DETERMINE WHEN TO SWITCH INTO
ECONOMIZER OPERATION IN DUAL ENTHALPY ECONOMIZER
MODE
RETURN AIR TEMP
RUN TEST
THIS PARAMETER GIVE THE CURRENT VALUE FOR THE
RETURN AIR TEMPERATURE INPUT
BY TURNING THIS FEATURE ON THE UNIT CONTROLLER
SEQUENCING ON ALL THE BINARY OUTPUTS TO VERIFY
OPERATION OF THE UNIT ELECTRICAL DEVICES
SENSOR SPACE TEMPERATURE SENSOR
OUTSET
THIS IS THE ACTUAL SPACE SENSOR OFFSET AMOUNT BEING
USED BY THE UNIT CONTROLLER IN DEGREES.
Continued on next page
JOHNSON CONTROLS
150
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
TABLE 7-1 – DEFINITIONS (CONTINUED)
MENU ITEM
DEFINITION
SPACE SENSOR DETECTED
IDENTIFIES IF THE UNIT CONTROLLER HAS DETECTED THE
PRESENCE OF A SPACE SENSOR. IF THE UNIT CONTROLLER
DETECTS A SPACE SENSOR IT WILL SELF CONFIGURE TO USE
IT FOR CONTROL OF THE UNIT.
SPACE SENSOR FAULT OVERRIDE ENABLE
WHEN THIS OPTION IS TURNED ON THE CONTROLLER USES
THE RETURN AIR TEMPERATURE INPUT IN PLACE OF THE
SPACE TEMPERATURE INPUT TO CONTROL THE UNIT. TURING
THIS OPTION ON ALLOWS THE UNIT TO OPERATE IN A VAV
STAND ALONE MODE
SPACE TEMP
THIS PARAMETER GIVES THE CURRENT VALUE OF THE SPACE
TEMPERATURE INPUT
SPACE TEMP TRENDING ALARM TEMP
TO ENABLE THIS FEATURE THE PARAMETER MUST BE SET
TO OTHER THEN 0. A VALUE OTHER THEN 0 IS THE NUMBER
OF DEGREES ABOVE OR BELOW THE SETPOINT THE
TEMPERATURE MUST BE TO START THE TIMING
SPACE TEMP TRENDING ALARM TIME
THIS PARAMETER ESTABLISHED THE AMOUNT OF TIME THE
SPACE TEMPERATURE MUST BE TRENDING ABOVE OR BELOW
THE SPACE TEMP TRENDING ALARM TEMP BEFORE THE ALARM
WILL BE INITIATED.
SPACE TEMPERATURE OFFSET RANGE
STAGES OF HEAT AVAILABLE
THIS SETPOINT ESTABLISHES THE MAXIMUM AMOUNT OF
HEATING OR COOLING RESET AVAILABLE THROUGH THE
RESET FEATURE ON A SPACE SENSOR.
THIS PARAMETER IDENTIFIES THE NUMBER OF STAGES OF
HEAT THE UNIT CONTROLLER IS SET UP TO CONTROL
STATE COMPRESSOR OFF - LOW SUPPLY
VOLTAGE
THIS IDENTIFIES THE COMPRESSORS ARE OFF BECAUSE OF
LOW SUPPLY VOLTAGE. ON WHEN THIS STATE IS ACTIVE
STATE COMPRESSORS OFF - LOW AMBIENT
TEMPERATURE
THIS IDENTIFIES THE COMPRESSOR ARE OFF BECAUSE
THE OUTDOOR TEMPERATURE IS BELOW THE LOW AMBIENT
LOCKOUT TEMPERATURE. ON WHEN THIS STATE IS ACTIVE
STATUS COMPRESSOR OFF - ECON IS USING
FREE COOLING
THIS IDENTIFIES THE COMPRESSORS ARE OFF BECAUSE THE
UNIT CONTROLLER IS USING OUTDOOR AIR FOR COOLING. ON
WHEN THIS IS ACTIVE
SUPPLY AIR TEMP
THIS PARAMETER GIVES THE CURRENT VALUE FOR THE
SUPPLY AIR TEMPERATURE INPUT
SUPPLY AIR TEMP ALARM SETPOINT FOR
COOLING
TO ENABLE THIS FEATURE THE PARAMETER MUST BE SET TO
OTHER THEN 0. A VALUE OTHER THEN 0 ESTABLISHES THE
SETPOINT TO USE IN DETERMINE WHEN TO INITIATE A SUPPLY
AIR TEMP ALARM FOR COOLING
SUPPLY AIR TEMP ALARM SETPOINT FOR
HEATING
TO ENABLE THIS FEATURE THE PARAMETER MUST BE SET TO
OTHER THEN 0. A VALUE OTHER THEN 0 ESTABLISHES THE
SETPOINT TO USE IN DETERMINE WHEN TO INITIATE A SUPPLY
AIR TEMP ALARM FOR HEATING
7
SUPPLY AIR TEMP LIMIT COOLING SETPOINT
THIS SET POINT IS USED BY THE UNIT CONTROLLER DURING
ECONOMIZER LOADING OR SUPPLY AIR TEMP LIMIT MODE OF
OPERATION
Continued on next page
JOHNSON CONTROLS
151
Parameter Description and Options
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
TABLE 7-1 – DEFINITIONS (CONTINUED)
MENU ITEM
DEFINITION
SUPPLY AIR TEMP LIMIT FOR COOLING
ENABLE
THIS PARAMETER MUST BE TURNED ON TO ENABLE SUPPLY
AIR TEMP LIMIT OPERATION IN THE COOLING MODE ON A
CONSTANT VOLUME UNIT
SUPPLY AIR TEMP LIMIT FOR HEATING
ENABLED
THIS PARAMETER MUST BE TURNED ON TO ENABLE SUPPLY
AIR TEMP LIMIT OPERATION IN THE HEATING MODE ON A
CONSTANT VOLUME UNIT
SUPPLY AIR TEMP LIMIT HEATING SETPOINT
THIS PARAMETER IS USED BY THE UNIT CONTROLLER DURING
SUPPLY AIR TEMP LIMIT FOR HEATING OPERATION ON A
CONSTANT VOLUME UNIT.
TEMPERATURE/HUMIDITY (RETURN) CONTROL THIS PARAMETER WOULD BE USED IF HOT GAS REHEAT WAS
ENABLED
BEING USED. THIS FEATURE IS NOT AVAILABLE ON THESE
UNITS. THIS SHOULD ALWAYS BE SET TO OFF
THIRD PARTY BAS ECONOMIZER ENABLED
WHEN THIS PARAMETER IS TURNED ON THE POSITION OF THE
ECONOMIZER DAMPER IS CONTROLLED BY AN EXTERNAL 2-10
VDC INPUT
TURN OFF CONTINUOUS FAN WHEN STARTING IF THIS PARAMETER IS TURNED ON AND THE UNIT IS RUNNING
HEAT
CONTINUOUS FAN, THE CONTROL WILL STOP THE SUPPLY FAN
AT THE START OF A HEATING CYCLE AND TURN IT BACK ON
BASED ON THE FAN ON FOR HEAT SETTING
UNIT MODEL NUMBER
UNIT NAME
THIS ALLOWS THE UNIT MODEL NUMBER TO BE ENTERED FOR
THE UNIT THROUGH THE SIMPLICITY PC SOFTWARE
THIS ALLOWS A NAME TO BE ASSIGNED TO THE UNIT TO
IDENTIFY IT ON THE NETWORK THROUGH THE SIMPLICITY PC
SOFTWARE
UNIT SERIAL NUMBER
THIS ALLOWS THE UNIT SERIAL NUMBER TO BE ENTERED FOR
THE UNIT THROUGH THE SIMPLICITY PC SOFTWARE
UNOCCUPIED OVERRIDE TIME PERIOD
THIS PARAMETER ESTABLISHES THE MAXIMUM TIME THE UNIT
WILL REMAIN IN THE UNOCCUPIED OVERRIDE MODE WHEN
THE OVERRIDE BUTTON IS PUSHED ON THE SPACE SENSOR.
VAV / CV SELECTION
THIS PARAMETER GIVES THE STATUS OF THE SET UP OF THE
UNIT , VAV OR CV
VAV COOLING SUPPLY AIR TEMP LOWER
SETPOINT
THIS PARAMETER ESTABLISHES THE LOWER COOLING
SETPOINT FOR VAV COOLING OPERATION
VAV COOLING SUPPLY AIR TEMP UPPER
SETPOINT
THIS PARAMETER ESTABLISHES THE UPPER COOLING
SETPOINT FOR VAV COOLING OPERATION
VAV OCCUPIED HEATING ENABLED
THIS PARAMETER MUST BE TURNED ON TO ALLOW OCCUPIED
HEATING OPERATION.
VAV OCCUPIED HEATING SETPOINT
THE UNIT CONTROLLER COMPARES THE SPACE TEMPERATURE
TO THIS VALUE AS ONE OF THE CRITERIA TO USE TO
DETERMINE WHEN TO INITIATE VAV OCCUPIED HEATING
OPERATION
VAV SUPPLY AIR TEMP RESET SETPOINT
THE UNIT CONTROLLER COMPARES THE SPACE OR RETURN
AIR TEMPERATURE TO THIS VALVE TO DETERMINE IF IT
SHOULD CONTROL TO THE VAV COOLING SUPPLY AIR UPPER
OR LOWER SETPOINT
YEAR
THIS PARAMETER IS USED TO ENTER THE CURRENT YEAR 0 TO
99. FOR EXAMPLE 7 WOULD BE 2007
JOHNSON CONTROLS
152
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
SECTION 8 – SERVICE
ANALOG INPUT OPERATION
Duct Pressure Transducer
This section describes the control operation of the (29)
twenty-nine analog inputs. These inputs are used by
the control to monitor and respond to unit temperatures,
pressures, enthalpy, etc. The location of each of these
connections on the Unit Controller is contained in
Table 8-8. Notice that the ID gives the jack connection
designated as “J” and then the identifying number of
the connector, followed by a – and then the pin number
of the connector. For example the SUPPLY AIR
TEMPERATURE analog input would be found at J1-1.
This is connector J1 – Pin 1. As the Unit Control board
is positioned in the control box the top row of the J series
connectors is the input, the middle row is the common,
and the bottom row is the 5 VDC input to the sensor.
Also the pin in the right hand top corner is pin 1.
The Duct Pressure Transducer is located behind the right
hand damper door. The purpose of the transducer is to
sense and convert the static pressure in the supply-side
of the duct to a 0 to 5 volt DC voltage. The DC voltage
is sent to the Unit Controller and compared against the
“DUCT STATIC PRESS ACTIVE SP”. The transducer is
factory wired, but pneumatic tubing must be field supplied
and installed (refer to Section 2 “INSTALLATION” in this
manual). The Duct Static Pressure Transducer measures
differential pressure between the pressure in the duct
and atmospheric pressure. When verifying transducer
operation, the technician must insert a tee in the pneumatic
tubing and connect a manometer to the tee to verify the
pressure being applied to the transducer. Once this pressure
is known, a comparison can be made of the duct pressure
vs. output volts DC from the transducer. Table 8-2 shows
the relationship between the pressure applied to the duct
pressure transducer and the output voltage. The output is
linear between 0" WC and the SPAN. The “DUCT PRESS
TRANSDUCER SPAN” can be set to 1.25, 2.5 or 5" WC.
The “DUCT PRESS TRANSDUCER SPAN” must always
be set based on the span of the transducer installed.
Temperature Sensors
The temperature sensors are all 10KType IIIThermistors.
The relationship between the temperature and the
voltage output and resistance is contained in Table 8-1
.The following analog input are of this type: Supply
Air Temperature, Heat Entering Temp, Flex Evap Temp,
Outside Air Temp, Return Air Temp, Suction Temp #1,
Suction Temp #2, Zone Temp, and Under Floor Temp.
TABLE 8-1 – TEMPERATURE SENSOR RESISTANCE
°F
-25
-20
-15
-10
-5
VOLTAGE
RESISTANCE
°C
°F
VOLTAGE
RESISTANCE
16,744
14,681
13,216
11,771
10,502
9,388
°C
55
60
2.36
2.51
2.66
2.80
2.94
3.08
3.21
3.33
3.45
3.56
3.66
3.76
3.85
3.94
4.02
4.09
4.16
12.78
15.56
18.33
21.11
23.89
26.67
29.45
32.22
35.0
0.49
0.53
0.60
0.69
0.78
139,639
127,453
109,624
94,519
-30.6
-28.9
65
-26.1
70
-23.34
-20.55
75
81,665
80
85
8,404
0.0
5
0.88
0.98
1.10
1.22
1.35
1.48
1.62
1.77
1.91
2.06
2.21
70,750
61,418
53,426
46,582
40,703
35,639
31,269
27,490
24,219
21,377
18,900
-17.78
-15.00
-12.22
-9.44
-6.67
-3.89
-1.11
1.67
90
7,537
95
6,770
10
15
20
25
30
35
40
45
50
100
105
110
115
120
125
130
135
6,090
37.78
40.56
43.34
46.11
48.89
51.66
54.44
57.22
5,487
4,951
4,475
4,050
3,671
4.44
3,332
7.22
3,029
8
10.00
153
JOHNSON CONTROLS
Service
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
TABLE 8-2 – DUCT PRESSURE TRANSDUCER
Return Fan Pressure Transducer
1.25" WC SPAN
2.5" WC SPAN
5.0" WC SPAN
VOLTAGE
VDC
DIFFERENTIAL DIFFERENTIAL
DIFFERENTIAL
INPUT PRESS
0.5
If the unit is order with the Return Fan Option the
unit will have a Return Fan Pressure Transducer. The
transducer is behind the right hand damper door and
compares the pressure in the return air compartment to
atmospheric pressure. The Unit Controller varies the
speed of the Return Fan in order to maintain the correct
differential pressure in the return compartment. When
verifying transducer operation, the technician can inset a
tee into the pneumatic tubing and connect a manometer
to the tee to verify the pressure being applied to the
transducer. Once this pressure is known, a comparison
can be made of the return compartment pressure vs.
output volts DC from the transducer. A practical and
quick check of this transducer can also be accomplished
by removing the pneumatic tubing lines from both the
low and high side connections on the transducer. Since
both of the inputs will now be exposed to the same
pressure, the differential pressure will be zero, and the
output 2.5 volts DC according to Table 8-4.
INPUT PRESS
0.125
0.25
INPUT PRESS
0.25
0.50
1.00
1.50
2.00
2.50
3.00
3.50
4.00
4.50
5.00
0.50
1.0
0.375
0.50
0.75
1.50
1.00
2.00
0.625
0.75
1.25
2.50
1.50
3.00
0.875
1.00
1.75
3.50
2.00
4.00
1.125
1.25
2.25
4.50
2.50
5.00
Building Pressure Transducer
The Building Pressure Transducer is located behind the
right hand damper door. The purpose of the transducer is
to sense and convert the static pressure in the building to
a 0 to 5 volt DC voltage. The DC voltage is then sent to
the Unit Controller and compared against the “BUILDING
PRESSURE ACTIVE SETPOINT”. The transducer is
factory wired, but pneumatic tubing must be field supplied
and installed (refer to Section 2 “INSTALLATION” in this
manual). The Building Pressure Transducer measures
differential pressure in the building and atmospheric
pressure. When verifying transducer operation, the
technician can inset a tee into the pneumatic tubing and
connect a manometer to the tee to verify the pressure being
applied to the transducer. Once this pressure is known, a
comparison can be made of the building pressure vs. output
volts DC from the transducer. Apractical and quick check
of this transducer can also be accomplished by removing
the pneumatic tubing lines from both the low and high side
connections on the transducer. Since both of the inputs
will now be exposed to the same pressure, the differential
pressure will be zero, and the output 2.5 volts DC according
to Table 8-3.
TABLE 8-4 – RETURN FAN PRESSURE
TRANSDUCER OUTPUT
DIFFERENTIAL INPUT
PRESSURE - IWC
OUPTUT VOLTAGE - VDC
-1.00
-0.80
-0.60
-0.40
-0.20
0.00
0.20
0.40
0.60
0.80
1.00
0.00
0.50
1.00
1.50
2.00
2.50
3.00
3.50
4.00
4.50
5.00
TABLE 8-3 – BUILDING PRESSURE TRANSDUCER OUTPUT
DIFFERENTIAL INPUT
PRESSURE - IWC
-0.50
OUPTUT VOLTAGE - VDC
Discharge Pressure Transducer
0.00
0.50
1.00
1.50
2.00
2.50
3.00
3.50
4.00
4.50
5.00
The discharge Pressure Transducer is located in the
common discharge line of the tandem compressors for
each refrigerant circuit. The purpose of this transducer
is to sense and convert the discharge pressure into a
DC voltage. The DC voltage is then sent to the Unit
Controller where it is used to control the number of
condenser fan when the unit is in cooling operation.
The discharge pressure value, in PSIG, is displayed by
the User Interface.
-0.40
-0.30
-0.20
-0.10
0.00
0.10
0.20
0.30
0.40
0.50
JOHNSON CONTROLS
154
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
Humidity Sensors
The Discharge Transducer has a range of 0 to 650
PSIG, with a linear output of 0 to 5 DC volts. Table
8-5 illustrates the DC volt output from the transducer
for a given discharge pressure.
The humidity sensor outputs a 0 to 5 volts DC in response
to the relative humidity sensed. An outdoor air humidity
sensor is used whenever the economizer is configured
for single or dual enthalpy. Areturn air humidity sensor
is used whenever the economizer is configured for dual
enthalpy. A humidity sensor is also used to monitor
the humidity in the space between the slab and raised
floor system used for FlexSys applications. Table 8-6
gives the relationship between the voltage output of the
humidity sensor and the % relative humidity.
Suction Pressure Transducer
The optional suction pressure transducer is located in
the common suction line of the tandem compressors for
each refrigerant circuit. The purpose of the transducer
is to sense and convert the suction pressure to a DC
voltage. The DC voltage is then sent to the Unit
Controller where it is displayed by the User Interface.
When this option is installed the Unit Controller will
also calculate and display the Evaporator Superheat
value for the system.
TABLE 8-6 – HUMIDITY SENSOR OUTPUTS
% RELATIVE
HUMIDITY
5
% RELATIVE
HUMIDITY
55
0.25
0.50
0.75
1.00
1.25
1.50
1.75
2.00
2.25
2.50
2.75
3.00
3.25
3.50
3.75
4.00
4.25
4.50
4.75
5.00
The Suction Transducer has a range of 0 to 400 PSIG,
with a linear output of 0 to 5 volts DC. Table 8-5
illustrates the DC volt output from the transducer for a
given suction pressure.
10
15
20
25
30
35
40
45
50
60
65
70
75
80
85
90
95
100
TABLE 8-5 – PRESSURE TRANSDUCERS
SUCTION TRANSDUCER
DISCHARGE TRANSDUCER
PRESSURE
VOLTAGE
VDC
PRESSURE
VOLTAGE
VDC
PSIG
PSIG
0
0.5
0
0.5
25
0.75
1
32.5
65
0.7
0.9
1.1
1.3
1.5
1.7
1.9
2.1
2.3
2.5
2.7
2.9
3.1
3.3
3.5
3.7
3.9
4.1
4.3
4.5
50
75
1.25
1.5
1.75
2
97.5
130
100
125
150
175
200
225
250
275
300
325
350
375
400
162.5
195
2.25
2.5
2.75
3
227.5
260
292.5
325
3.25
3.5
3.75
4
357.5
390
422.5
455
4.25
4.5
487.5
520
552.5
585
617.5
650
8
155
JOHNSON CONTROLS
Service
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
CO2 Sensor
Furnace Status Input
Two CO2 sensors are used in conjunction with the
“DEMAND VENTILATION” option. In “DEMAND
VENTILATION” the Unit Control monitors the CO2 level
of the outdoor air and the CO2 level in the conditioned
space and varies the amount of ventilation air based on
the relationship between these two values. Table 8-7
gives the volts DC output for a given CO2 level.
The Unit Controller monitors the operation of the
Staged and Modulating Gas Heat sections and displays
the status through the STATUS screen of the User
Interface. The operation of each of the gas heat sections
is monitored by a multiplexer installed in the gas heat
section. When a gas heat section is energized, it sends a
24-volt signal to the multiplexer. The multiplexer takes
the five “ON”/”OFF” inputs and converts them into a
0 to 5 volt DC signal that is sent to the Unit Controller.
The Unit Controller then decodes this analog input and
displays the furnace section status. Tables 8-9 and 8-10
show the relationship between the DC voltage and the
furnace operation status.
TABLE 8-7 – CO2 SENSOR OUTPUT
PPM CO2
OUTPUT
VOLTAGE
VDC
PPM CO2
OUTPUT
VOLTAGE
VDC
80
160
240
320
400
480
560
640
720
800
880
960
1040
0.20
0.40
0.60
0.80
1.00
1.20
1.40
1.60
1.80
2.00
2.20
2.40
2.60
1120
1200
1280
1360
1440
1520
1600
1680
1760
1840
1920
2000
2.80
3.00
3.20
3.40
3.60
3.80
4.00
4.20
4.40
4.60
4.80
5.00
JOHNSON CONTROLS
156
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
TERMINALS
FSI
P21
P7
P20
SD2
P19
P8
P11
P9
P22
P6
COM
FSP
SD1
R
P15
P1
P2
P16
P5
P4
TERM. VAV OPEN +
TERM. VAV OPEN -
P3
LD13124
P14
P10
P13
P12
TERM
24VAC
FIG. 8-1 – CONNECTOR LOCATIONS
TABLE 8-8 – WIRING DATA
CONNECTOR #
TYPE
IDENTIFICATION
WIRE #
DESCRIPTION
P9
P9
AI
AI
AI
AI
AI
AI
AI
AI
AI
AI
AI
AI
AI
AI
AI
AI
AI
AO
AO
AO
BP-
BP+
340
339
-
BUILDING PRESSURE INPUT -
BUILDING PRESSURE INPUT +
CV VAV CONFIGURATION RESISTOR
DUCT STATIC PRESSURE INPUT -
DUCT STATIC PRESSURE INPUT +
DEMAND VENTILATION INPUT -
DEAMND VENTILATION INPUT +
OUTDOOR AIR TEMPERATURE INPUT
OUTDOOR AIR TEMPERATURE INPUT
OUTDOOR AIR HUMIDITY INPUT -
OUTDOOR AIR HUMIDITY INPUT +
RETURN AIR TEMPERATURE -
P7
CV/VAV
DP-
P21
P21
P20
P20
P11
P11
P6
338
337
-
DP+
DV-
DV+
-
OAT-
OAT+
OH-
330
329
334
333
332
331
336
335
309
308
406
405
408
P6
OH+
RAT-
RAT+
RH-
P11
P11
P6
RETURN AIR TEMPERATURE +
RETURN AIR HUMIDITY INPUT 1
RETURN AIR HUMIDITY INPUT +
SUPPLY AIR TEMPERATURE INPUT
SUPPLY AIR TEMPERATURE INPUT
OUTDOOR DAMPER OUTPUT -
OUTDOOR DAMPER OUTPUT +
EXHAUST FAN VFD / DAMPER OUTPUT-
P6
RH+
P11
P11
P14
P14
P14
SAT-
SAT+
ECO-
ECO+
EXD-
8
Continued on next page
157
JOHNSON CONTROLS
Service
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
TABLE 8-8 – WIRING DATA (CONTINUED)
CONNECTOR #
TYPE
IDENTIFICATION
WIRE #
DESCRIPTION
P14
P14
P14
P14
P14
P14
P14
P4
AO
AO
AO
AO
AO
AO
AO
COMM
COMM
COMM
DI
EXD+
HGR-
HGR+
HWV-
HWV+
VFD-
VFD+
RS-485 B
RS-485 A
RS-485
C10
407
EXHAUST FAN VFD / DAMPER OUTPUT+
NOT USED
-
-
NOT USED
410
HOT WATER VALVE OUTPUT -
HOT WATER VALVE OUTPUT +
SUPPLY FAN VFD OUTPUT -
409
402
401
SUPPLY FAN VFD OUTPUT +
-
(+) COMMUNICATION CONNECTION
(-) COMMUNICATION CONNECTION
CONNECTION FOR SIMPLICITY PC SOFTWARE
COMPRESSOR 1A MOTOR PROTECTION CIRCUIT
P4
-
P5
-
P12
P12
P12
P12
P12
P12
P12
P10
P10
P10
JUMPER
DI
C20
JUMP / 440 COMPRESSOR 1B MOTOR PROTECTION CIRCUIT
JUMP / 441 24 VAC TO COMMON
DI
C20
DI
C30
JUMP / 442 COMPRESSOR 2A MOTOR PROTECTION CIRCUIT
JUMP / 443 24 VAC TO COMMON
DI
C30
DI
C40
JUMP / 444 COMPRESSOR 2B MOTOR PROTECTION CIRCUIT
JUMP / 445 24 VAC TO COMMON
DI
C40
DI
GV1
510
525
536
HEAT SECTION 1 GAS VALVE INPUT
HEAT SECTION 2 GAS VALVE INPUT
HEAT SECTION 3 GAS VALVE INPUT
24 VAC INPUT TO UNIT CONTROLLER FOR BINARY
OUTPUTS
DI
GV2
DI
GV3
TERMINAL
DI
24 VAC
301
P11
P11
DI
DI
DI
DI
DI
DI
DI
DI
DI
DI
DI
DI
DI
DI
DI
DI
DI
DI
DI
DI
DI
DI
DI
DI
APS
APS
411
412
AIR PROVING SIWTCH INPUT
24 VAC TO COMMON
P12
C10
JUMPER
304
COMPRESSOR 1A MOTOR PROTECTION CIRCUIT
24 VAC COMMON
TERMINAL
P22
COM
FILT
390
DIRTY FILTER SWITCH INPUT
24 VAC TO COMMON
P22
FILT
391
P16
FOVR
FOVR
FSI
JUMP / 404 24 VAC TO COMMON
P16
JUMP / 403 SUPPLY FAN OVERLOAD INPUT CV UNITS ONLY
TERMINAL
TERMINAL
P15
388
389
399
400
-
FREEZE STAT INPUT
FSP
24 VAC TO COMMON
HSP1
HSP1
HSP2
HSP2
HSP3
HSP3
HSP4
HSP4
LIM1
LIM2
LIM3
LPS1
LPS1
LPS2
24 VAC TO COMMON
P15
COMPRESSOR SYSTEM 1 HIGH PRESSURE INPUT
NOT USED
P15
P15
400
431
432
-
JUMPERED TO HSP1
P16
24 VAC TO COMMON
P16
COMPRESSOR SYSTEM 2 1 HIGH PRESSURE INPUT
NOT USED
P16
P16
432
507
522
533
395
396
-
JUMPERED TO HSP3
P10
HEAT SECTION 1 LIMIT INPUT
HEAT SECTION 2 LIMIT INPUT
HEAT SECTION 3 LIMIT INPUT
24 VAC TO COMMON
P10
P10
P15
P15
COMPRESSOR SYSTEM 1 LOW PRESSURE INPUT
NOT USED
P15
Continued on next page
JOHNSON CONTROLS
158
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
TABLE 8-8 – WIRING DATA (CONTINUED)
CONNECTOR #
TYPE
IDENTIFICATION
WIRE #
DESCRIPTION
P15
P16
P16
P16
P16
DI
DI
DI
DI
DI
LPS2
LPS3
LSP3
LPS4
LPS4
396
JUMPERED TO LSP1
24 VAC TO COMMON
433
434
COMPRESSOR SYSTEM 2 LOW PRESSURE INPUT
NOT USED
-
434
JUMPERED TO LSP3
SD
TERMINAL
TERMINAL
DI
DI
R
24 VAC INPUT TO UNIT CONTROLLER
INPUT FOR SMOKE SHUTDOWN
JUMPER
SD
SDI
JUMPER
TERMINAL
P12
P12
P12
P12
P13
P13
P13
P13
P10
P10
P10
P3
DI
DO
SD2
303
24 VAC TO COMMON
C1
427
COMPRESSOR 1A OUTPUT
COMPRESSOR 1BOUTPUT
COMPRESSOR 2A OUTPUT
COMPRESSOR 2B OUTPUT
CONDENSER FAN BANK 1 OUTPUT
CONDENSER FAN BANK 2 OUTPUT
EXHAUST FAN OUTPUT
DO
C2
428
DO
C3
429
DO
C4
430
DO
CF1
423
DO
CF2
425
DO
EXH
422
DO
FAN
421
SUPPLY FAN OUTPUT
DO
H1
570
HEAT SECTION ONE OUTPUT
HEAT SECTION TWO OUTPUT
HEAT SECTION 3 OUTPUT
ECONOMIZER DAMPER INPUT - VDC
ECONOMIZER DAMPER INPUT + VDC
COMMON SIDE OF 24 VAC SUPPLY
SUPPLY FAN INPUT
DO
H2
572
DO
H3
574
FIELD INPUT
FIELD INPUT
FIELD INPUT
FIELD INPUT
FIELD INPUT
FIELD INPUT
FIELD INPUT
FIELD INPUT
FIELD INPUT
FIELD INPUT
FIELD INPUT
FIELD INPUT
FIELD INPUT
FIELD INPUT
FIELD INPUT
FIELD INPUT
FIELD INPUT
FIELD INPUT
FIELD INPUT
FIELD INPUT
FIELD INPUT
FIELD OUTPUT / AO
FIELD OUTPUT / AO
BAS ECON -
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
P3
BAS ECON +
P1
C
P1
G
OCC
PURGE
R
P1
OCCUPIED INPUT
P3
SMOKE PURGE INPUT
P1
HOT SIDE OF 24 VAC SUPPLY
REMOTE RESET -
P19
P19
P1
REM-
REM+
SD
REMOTE RESET +
NOT USED
P8
GND
SSO
ST
SPACE TEMPERATURE INPUT COMMON
SPACE TEMP SENSOR OFFSET +
SPACE TEMPERATURE INPUT +
IST STAGE HEAT INPUT
P8
P8
P2
W1
P2
W2
2ND STAGE HEAT INPUT
P2
W3
3RD STAGE HEAT INPUT
P1
X
FAULT OUTPUT
P2
Y1
1ST STAGECOOLING INPUT
2ND STATE COOLING INPUT
3RD STAGE COOLING INPUT
4TH STAGE COOLING INPUT
IDENTIFIES UNIT IS IN THE HEATING MODE (24 VDC -)
IDENTIFIES UNIT IS IN THE HEATING MODE (24VDC +)
P2
Y2
P2
Y3
P3
Y4
TERMINAL
TERMINAL
VAV OPEN -
VAV OPEN +
8
159
JOHNSON CONTROLS
Service
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
FAULTS AND LOCKOUTS
LIGHT EMITTING DIODE
ALARM CODES
The light emitting diode (LED) installed on the Unit
Controller is used to indicate the functionality of the
Unit Controller and the unit. Normal operation is
indicated by the LED flashing ON and OFF at a rate
of one-second. A one-second ON followed by a one-
second OFF flash. This means there are no active flash
codes, faults or clock-outs. However there may be faults
recorded in the history buffer.
An active alarm is represented by a flashing alarm code
numeral. There are 43 alarms in all. Not all the alarms
are critical enough to shut down the system. Some
alarms flag the problem to bring it to the attention of
the operator or technician while allowing the system to
continue to operate.
The display flashes the current or most recent code
and contains the last five failures as well. To recall the
last five failures from the most recent to the oldest of
the five, press the “Alarm/Change” button once and
each code is displayed for two seconds. Each failure
code is numbered 1 to 5 and the number is shown in
the two-digit character display located above the four-
digit display.
A flash rate of 250 ms ON and OFF indicates a current
alarm is present. The alarm code number will also be
flashing on the four-digit character display. See Table
8-9 for a description of each of the alarm codes.
If the LED is constantly on (does not flash), the board
has failed and must be replaced. If the LED is OFF
this indicates no power to the board or a board failure.
Two flashes ON, then two-seconds OFF indicates the
control is timing out on an Anti-Cycle-Delay (ASCD).
To bypass theASCD timer depress the TEST/UPbutton
3 times within 5 seconds.
The current and last five alarms can also be views under
the “ALARM” tab using the Simplicity PC software.
A unit lockout can be reset in three ways:
• Removing the 24 VAC supply to the Unit Con-
troller.
• Press the TEST/UP button twice in 5 seconds.
• By a communicated command.
JOHNSON CONTROLS
160
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
TABLE 8-9 – ALARM CODE DESCRIPTIONS
ALARM CODE
DESCRIPTION
COMPRESSOR SYSTEM 1 (COMPRESSORS 1A, 1B) LOCKED OUT ON HIGH PRESSURE CONTROL. THE CIRCUIT
OPENED THREE TIMES WITHIN A 2-HOUR WINDOW.
01
02
03
04
05
06
07
08
09
10
11
12
13
14
15
COMPRESSOR SYSTEM 1 (COMPRESSORS 1A, 1B) LOCKED OUT ON HIGH PRESSURE CONTROL. THE CIRCUIT
OPENED THREE TIMES WITHIN A 2-HOUR WINDOW.
COMPRESSOR SYSTEM 2 (COMPRESSORS 2A, 2B) LOCKED OUT ON HIGH PRESSURE CONTROL. THE CIRCUIT
OPENED THREE TIMES WITHIN A 2-HOUR WINDOW.
COMPRESSOR SYSTEM 2 (COMPRESSORS 2A, 2B) LOCKED OUT ON HIGH PRESSURE CONTROL. THE CIRCUIT
OPENED THREE TIMES WITHIN A 2-HOUR WINDOW.
COMPRESSOR SYSTEM 1 (COMPRESSORS 1A, 1B) LOCKED OUT ON LOW PRESSURE CONTROL. THE CIRCUIT
OPENED THREE TIMES WITHIN A 1-HOUR WINDOW.
COMPRESSOR SYSTEM 1 (COMPRESSORS 1A, 1B) LOCKED OUT ON LOW PRESSURE CONTROL. THE CIRCUIT
OPENED THREE TIMES WITHIN A 1-HOUR WINDOW.
COMPRESSOR SYSTEM 2 (COMPRESSORS 2A, 2B) LOCKED OUT ON LOW PRESSURE CONTROL. THE CIRCUIT
OPENED THREE TIMES WITHIN A 1-HOUR WINDOW.
COMPRESSOR SYSTEM 2 (COMPRESSORS 2A, 2B) LOCKED OUT ON LOW PRESSURE CONTROL. THE CIRCUIT
OPENED THREE TIMES WITHIN A 1-HOUR WINDOW.
COMPRESSOR SYSTEM 1A LOCKED OUT ON COMPRESSOR MOTOR PROTECTION MODULE. THE CIRCUIT
OPENED THREE TIMES WITHIN A 1-HOUR WINDOW.
COMPRESSOR SYSTEM 1B LOCKED OUT ON COMPRESSOR MOTOR PROTECTION MODULE. THE CIRCUIT
OPENED THREE TIMES WITHIN A 1-HOUR WINDOW.
COMPRESSOR SYSTEM 2A LOCKED OUT ON COMPRESSOR MOTOR PROTECTION MODULE. THE CIRCUIT
OPENED THREE TIMES WITHIN A 1-HOUR WINDOW.
COMPRESSOR SYSTEM 2B LOCKED OUT ON COMPRESSOR MOTOR PROTECTION MODULE. THE CIRCUIT
OPENED THREE TIMES WITHIN A 1-HOUR WINDOW.
FIRST STAGE HEATING IS LOCKED OUT ON LIMIT SWITCH TRIPS. THE CIRCUIT OPENED THREE TIMES WITHIN
A 1-HOUR WINDOW.
SECOND STAGE HEATING IS LOCKED OUT ON LIMIT SWITCH TRIPS. THE CIRCUIT OPENED THREE TIMES
WITHIN A 1-HOUR WINDOW.
THIRD STAGE HEATING IS LOCKED OUT ON LIMIT SWITCH TRIPS. THE CIRCUIT OPENED THREE TIMES WITHIN
A 1-HOUR WINDOW.
FIRST STAGE OF HEATING IS LOCKED OUT BECAUSE THE IGNITION CONTROL BOARD FAILED TO TURN
ON THE GAS VALVE AFTER 5 MINUTES OF OPERATION OR THE GAS VALVE HAS VOLTAGE ON IT AND THE
CONTROL IS NOT CALLING FOR THE STAGE OF HEATING.
16
17
18
SECOND STAGE OF HEATING IS LOCKED OUT BECAUSE THE IGNITION CONTROL BOARD FAILED TO TURN
ON THE GAS VALVE AFTER 5 MINUTES OF OPERATION OR THE GAS VALVE HAS VOLTAGE ON IT AND THE
CONTROL IS NOT CALLING FOR THE STAGE OF HEATING.
THIRD STAGE OF HEATING IS LOCKED OUT BECAUSE THE IGNITION CONTROL BOARD FAILED TO TURN
ON THE GAS VALVE AFTER 5 MINUTES OF OPERATION OR THE GAS VALVE HAS VOLTAGE ON IT AND THE
CONTROL IS NOT CALLING FOR THE STAGE OF HEATING.
19
20
21
22
SPACE TEMPERATURE SENSOR HAS FAILED OPEN OR SHORTED. THE DISPLAY WILL INDICATE –40.0.
SUPPLY AIR TEMPERATURE SENSOR HAS FAILED OPEN OR SHORTED. THE DISPLAY WILL INDICATE –40.0.
RETURN AIR TEMPERATURE SENSOR HAS FAILED OPEN OR SHORTED. THE DISPLAY WILL INDICATE –40.0.
OUTDOOR AIR TEMPERATURE SENSOR HAS FAILED OPEN OR SHORTED. THE DISPLAY WILL INDICATE –40.0.
DIRTY FILTER SWITCH HAS CLOSED INDICATING THE FILTERS NEED REPLACED. THIS HAS NO EFFECT ON
THE OPERATION OF THE UNIT.
23
8
Continued on next page
161
JOHNSON CONTROLS
Service
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
TABLE 8-9 – ALARM CODE DESCRIPTIONS (CONTINUED)
ALARM CODE
DESCRIPTION
THE SUPPLY FAN BINARY OUTPUT HAS BEEN TURNED ON FOR 90 SECONDS AND THE AIR PROVING SWITCH
CIRCUIT HAS NOT CLOSED.
24
THE SUPPLY FAN BINARY OUTPUT HAS BEEN TURNED OFF FOR 90 SECONDS AND THE AIR PROVING SWITCH
CIRCUIT HAS NOT OPENED.
25
26
27
A MICROELECTRONICS FAILURE HAS OCCURRED AND THE CONTROL IS OPERATING ON DEFAULTS.
A MICROELECTRONICS FAILURE HAS OCCURRED AND THE CONTROL IS DOWN DUE TO A FATAL FAULT.
THIS INDICATES THE SUPPLY FAN BINARY OUTPUT IS TURNED ON AND THE SUPPLY FAN OVERLOAD CIRCUIT
IS OPEN. THIS HAS TO OCCUR 3 TIMES WITHIN A TWO HOUR WINDOW.
THIS INDICATES THE OUTDOOR AIR HUMIDITY SENSOR IS OUT OF RANGE. WHEN THIS OCCURS, THE UNIT
CONTROLLER SWITCHES THE ECONOMIZER TYPE TO DRY BULB.
28
29
30
31
THIS INDICATES THE RETURN AIR HUMIDITY SENSOR IS OUT OF RANGE. WHEN THIS OCCURS, THE UNIT
CONTROLLER SWITCHES THE ECONOMIZER TYPE TO SINGLE ENTHALPY.
THIS INDICATES THE IAQ (CO2) SENSOR IS OUT OF RANGE. THE UNIT CONTROLLER CHANGES THE
VENTILATION MODE TO FIXED MINIMUM.
32
33
34
THIS INDICATES THE REAL TIME CLOCK CANNOT BE READ AS A RESULT OF A HARDWARE FAILURE.
THIS INDICATES THE SPACE TEMPERATURE OFFSET IS GREATER THAN 20 K OHMS.
THIS INDICATES THE CV/VAV INPUT IS OUT OF RANGE. THE UNIT WILL LOCK OUT.
THIS INDICATES THE 24-VOLT SUPPLY CIRCUIT HAS DROPPED BELOW THE ALLOWABLE LEVEL. THE CONTROL
WILL SHUT DOWN UNTIL THE VOLTAGE RISES ABOVE 19.2 VAC.
35
36
37
38
THIS INDICATES THE UNIT COOLING AND HEATING OPERATION IS SHUT DOWN BECAUSE THE UNIT IS
OPERATING IN A SMOKE PURGE MODE.
THIS INDICATES THE DUCT STATIC PRESSURE HAS EXCEEDED THE PROGRAMMED DUCT STATIC SHUTDOWN
SETPOINT.
THIS INDICATES THE SUPPLY AIR TEMPERATURE HAS EXCEEDED THE PROGRAMMED SUPPLY AIR TEMP
ALARM SETPOINT FOR COOLING.
THIS INDICATES THE SUPPLY AIR TEMPERATURE HAS EXCEEDED THE PROGRAMMED SUPPLY AIR TEMP
ALARM SETPOINT FOR HEATING.
39
40
41
THIS INDICATES AN ECONOMIZER MINIMUM POSITION ALARM.
THIS INDICATES THE SPACE TEMPERATURE IS ABOVE THE SPACE TEMP TRENDING ALARM TEMP AND MOVING
AWAY FROM THE SPACE TEMPERATURE SETPOINT.
THIS INDICATES THE DUCT STATIC HAS NOT RISEN QUICKLY ENOUGH IN A VAV UNIT WHEN THE SUPPLY FAN IS
ENERGIZED.
42
43
THIS INDICATES THE HYDRONIC HEAT FREEZE STAT HAS OPENED AND THE OUTDOOR TEMPERATURE IS
BELOW 45.0° F.
JOHNSON CONTROLS
162
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
ALARM TROUBLE SHOOTING
Since tandem compressors are used there is a single high
pressure switch for system 1 and one for system 2. If
the high pressure switch opens both of the compressors
for that system will be turned off. If the high pressure
switch for system 1, (compressors 1A, 1B), opens it will
generate both a 01 and 02 alarm code. Likewise if the
high pressure switch opens for system 2, (compressors
2A, 2B), opens it will generate both a 03 and 04 alarm
code.
Refrigerant System Alarm Codes
(01, 02, 03, 04, 09, 10, 11, 12)
The first 12 alarms involve controls intended to
protect the compressors. Each compressor system is
equipped with external circuitry monitoring hardware
intended to protect the compressor in case the operating
characteristics of the refrigerant system fall outside the
safe operating envelope for the compressor. The type of
protection varies depending on the type of compressor
used.
The high pressure switch opens at 625 PSIG and closes
at 500 PSIG. In order to generate a high pressure
lockout the high pressure switch must open three times
within a 2 hour window.
YPAL 050 Compressors 1A, 1B, 2A, and 2B
YPAL 051 Compressors 1A, 1B, 2A, and 2B
YPAL 060 Compressors 1A and 2A
YPAL 061 Compressor 1A
24 VAC power is supplied to the system 1 high pressure
switch circuit from wire 399 at terminal HPS1 of the P15
connector. The binary input back to the Unit Controller
from the high pressure switch is wire 400 at terminal
HPS1 of the P15 connector. The above input is then
jumpered to terminal HSP2 of the P15 connector.
The Compressor Safety Circuit consists of a high-
pressure cutout switch. Each of the compressors is also
protected by internal line break switch imbedded in the
windings of the compressor that protects the compressor
from excessive current or temperatures. The Unit
Controller will not be able to identify the internal line
break switch is open and no fault will be generated or
reported by the Unit Controller.
24 VAC power is supplied to the system 2 high pressure
switch circuit from wire 431 at terminal HPS3 of the P16
connector. The binary input back to the Unit Controller
from the high pressure switch is wire 432 at terminal
HPS3 of the P16 connector. The above input is then
jumpered to terminal HPS4 of the P16 connector.
If the internal line break is open it will appear as
a compressor failure. To trouble shoot verify the
compressor contactor for the compressor that is not
running, is closed and line voltage is present on the
load and line side of all three legs. If so remove power
from the unit and remove the cover from the compressor
control box. Check for an open winding. If all three
winding are open carefully check the compressor shell.
If the shell is hot no determination can be made until the
shell has cooled. If the shell is cool and a winding is
open the compressor is defective. If the windings close
as the compressor cools the internal line break switch
was open. Some possible causes for an open switch are,
high discharge super heat (low charge), start of a bearing
failure (partial locked rotor), or high voltage.
Because there is no external compressor protection
module on these models jumpers are placed between
terminals C10 and C10 of the P12 connector for
compressor 1A, C20 and C20 of the P12 connector for
compressor 1B, C30 and C30 of the P12 connector for
compressor 2A, and C40 and C40 of the P12 connector
for compressor 2B.
YPAL 060 Compressors 1B and 2B
YPAL 061 Compressors 1B, 2A and 2B
The high pressure switches are connected as described
above; however, the compressors identified above
employ a compressor protection module. 24 VAC
power is supplied to the compressor protection module
for compressor 1B from wire 441 at terminal C20 of
the P12 connector. The binary input back to the Unit
Controller from the compressor protection module is
wire 440 at terminal C20 of the P12 connector.
The above units also have a low- pressure cutout that
will be discussed later.
8
163
JOHNSON CONTROLS
Service
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
Limit Switch Alarms (13, 14, 15)
24 VAC power is supplied to the compressor protection
module for compressor 2A from wire 443 at terminal
C30 of the P12 connector. The binary input back to the
Unit Controller from the compressor protection module
is wire 442 at terminal C30 of the P12 connector.
The control monitors the limit switch status for each of
the heating sections installed. If the limit switch circuit
opens the control de-energizes the heat section output
for the section with the open limit circuit and energizes
the indoor blower output. The supply fan performs a
Fan Delay Off when the limit re-closes.
24 VAC power is supplied to the compressor protection
module for compressor 2B from wire 445 at terminal
C40 of the P12 connector. The binary input back to the
Unit Controller from the compressor protection module
is wire 444 at terminal C40 of the P12 connector.
In order to generate a limit lockout the limit switch must
open three times within a 2-hour window.
Low Pressure Cutout Alarm (09, 10, 11, 12)
The limit input for heat section 1 is located at terminal
LIM1 wire 507 of the P10 connector. The limit input
for heat section 2 is located at terminal LIM2 wire 522
of the P10 connector. The limit input for heat section
3 is located at terminal LIM3 wire 533 of the P10
connector.
Since tandem compressors are used there is a single low
pressure switch for system 1 and one for system 2. If
the low pressure switch opens both of the compressors
for that system will be turned off. If the low pressure
switch for system 1, (compressors 1A, 1B), opens it will
generate both a 09 and 10 alarm code. Likewise if the
low pressure switch opens for system 2, (compressors
2A, 2B), opens it will generate both an 11 and 12 alarm
code.
Gas Heating Alarms (16, 17, 18)
The Unit Controller monitors the output to the gas valve.
If the Unit Controller is calling for the operation of the
heat stage and voltage is not present after 5 continuous
minutes it will generate an alarm.
The low pressure switch opens at 50 PSIG and closes
at 71 PSIG. In order to generate a low pressure lockout
the high pressure switch must open three times within
a 2 hour window.
If the Unit Controller is not calling for the operation of
the heat stage and voltage is present at the gas valve for
5 continuous minutes it will generate an alarm and lock
on the supply fan. If the input goes away the control
will revert to normal operation.
During the start up of the compressor system the low
pressure switch input is ignored for 30 seconds. After
the 30 second delay if the low pressure switch circuit
opens for 5 seconds the Unit Controller will turn off
both compressors for the system.
The gas valve input for heat section 1 is located at
terminal GV1 wire 510 of the P10 connector. The gas
valve input for heat section 2 is located at terminal GV2
wire 525 of the P10 connector. The gas valve input for
heat section 3 is located at terminal GV3 wire 536 of
the P10 connector.
24 VAC power is supplied to the system 1 low pressure
switch circuit from wire 395 at terminal LPS1 of the P15
connector. The binary input back to the Unit Controller
from the low pressure switch is wire 396 at terminal
LPS1 of the P15 connector. The above input is then
jumpered to terminal LPS2 of the P15 connector.
Space Temperature Sensor Alarm (19)
This alarm indicates the space temperature input is
either open or shorted. The display will show a value
of –40.0° F. The space temperature input is at ST and
GND of the P6 connector. To trouble shoot compare the
resistance of the input to the temperature in the space
using Table 8-1.
24 VAC power is supplied to the system 2 low pressure
switch circuit from wire 433 at terminal LPS3 of the P16
connector. The binary input back to the Unit Controller
from the low pressure switch is wire 434 at terminal
LPS3 of the P16 connector. The above input is then
jumpered to terminal LPS4 of the P16 connector.
JOHNSON CONTROLS
164
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
Supply Air Temperature Sensor Alarm (20)
The 24 VAC output to the switch is at terminalAPS wire
412 of the P11 connector and the input to the control is
at terminal APS wire 411 of the P11 connector.
This alarm indicates the supply air temperature input is
either open or shorted. The display will show a value
of –40.0° F. The supply air temperature input is at
SAT+ and SAT- of the P11 connector. To trouble shoot
compare the resistance of the input to the actual supply
air temperature using Table 8-1.
Supply Fan Air Proving Switch Closed Alarm (25)
This alarm indicates the call for supply fan operation
has been terminated and after 90 seconds of supply fan
operation the switch remained closed. The control will
flash the alarm but allow the unit to operate normally.
Return Air Temperature Sensor Alarm (21)
The 24 VAC output to the switch is at terminalAPS wire
412 of the P11 connector and the input to the control is
at terminal APS wire 411 of the P11 connector.
This alarm indicates the return air temperature input is
either open or shorted. The display will show a value
of –40.0° F. The return air temperature input is at
RAT+ and RAT- of the P11 connector. To trouble shoot
compare the resistance of the input to the actual return
air temperature using Table 8-1.
Microelectronics Failure Alarm (26)
This alarm indicates a problem with the Unit Controller
microelectronics has occurred and the Unit Controller
is operating on default values. Try recycling power
to the control. If the fault reappears replace the Unit
Controller.
Outdoor Air Temperature Sensor Alarm (22)
This alarm indicates the outdoor air temperature input
is either open or shorted. The display will show a
value of –40.0° F. The outdoor air temperature input
is at OAT+ and OAT- of the P11 connector. To trouble
shoot compare the resistance of the input to the actual
outdoor air temperature using Table 8-1.
Microelectronics Failure Alarm (27)
This alarm indicates a problem with the Unit Controller
microelectronics has occurred and the Unit Controller is
shut down. Try recycling power to the control. If the
fault reappears replace the Unit Controller.
Dirty Filter Switch Alarm (23)
This alarm will have no effect on the operation of the
unit. The alarm indicates the dirty filter switch contacts
have closed indicating the pressure drop across the filters
is above the setting of the switch. The 24 VAC output
to the switch is at terminal FILT wire 391 of the P22
connector and the input to the control is at terminal FILT
wire 390 of the P22 connector.
Supply Fan Overload Alarm (28)
The Unit Controller monitors this circuit anytime
the supply fan is operative. If this input is lost for
50 milliseconds, the control will shut down all unit
operation. If the voltage input does not return in 5-
minutes the control will turn on the alarm.
Supply Fan Air Proving Switch (24)
If the voltage returns the Unit Controller will log the
first incident and track the run time. If the switch opens
three times in a two-hour period the Unit Controller will
shut down the unit.
This alarm indicates there was a call for supply fan
operation and after 90 seconds of supply fan operation
the switch did not close. The Unit Controller will retry
the fan output every 30 minutes for three retires. If after
the three retries the Unit Controller will lockout heating
and cooling operation.
The 24 VAC output to the switch is at terminal FOVR
wire 404 of the P16 connector and the input to the control
is at terminal FOVR wire 403 of the P16 connector.
On a VAV unit the Unit Controller will also use the duct
static pressure input to qualify supply fan operation.
If the Unit Controller reads more then 0.05" WC it
will continue to identify the alarm but allow the unit
to operate.
8
165
JOHNSON CONTROLS
Service
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
Outdoor Humidity Sensor Alarm (29)
CV/VAV Input Alarm (34)
This alarm indicates the outdoor humidity sensor is
out of range. When this occurs the Unit Controller
will switch economizer operation to Dry Bulb. The
Outdoor Humidity analog input is at OH+ wire 333 of
the P6 connector and OH- wire 334 of the P6 connector.
To trouble shoot the sensor verify 24 VAC between
terminals EXC and COM of the sensor. Also verify
the VDC between the OUT and COM connection of the
sensor. If no voltage is present replace the sensor.
This alarm indicates the resistance between terminals
CV/VAV and CV/VAV at the P7 connection is out of
range. The acceptable range is 0.0 to 20,000 ohms.
Check the resistance between the two CV/VAV terminals
and take appropriate action.
Low Voltage Alarm (35)
The Unit Controller monitors the 24 VAC input to the
control. The input has two thresholds. The voltage
must be above 19.2 VAC or the control will not turn on
a contactor. If the voltage is not above this value it will
not turn on the contactor and flashes the fault code. If
contactors are energized and the voltage drops below
16 .0 volts the Unit Controller will de-energize the
contactors and flash the alarm. To trouble shoot check
the voltage between the “R” and “COM” at the ¼ inch
terminals on the board.
Return Humidity Sensor Alarm (30)
This alarm indicates the return humidity sensor is out
of range. When this occurs the Unit Controller will
switch economizer operation to Single Enthalpy. The
Return Humidity analog input is at RH+ wire 335 of
the P6 connector and OH- wire 336 of the P6 connector.
To trouble shoot the sensor verify 24 VAC between
terminals EXC and COM of the sensor. Also verify
the VDC between the OUT and COM connection of the
sensor. If no voltage is present replace the sensor.
Smoke Purge Mode Alarm (36)
This is not an alarm but rather an indication the unit
has been placed in a smoke purge mode. Verify the
presence of 24 VAC between PURGE connection at
the P3 connector and “C” on the P1 connector. If 24
VAC is present and the unit is not supposed to be in the
Purge mode trace the field wiring to determine why the
voltage is present.
IAQ (CO2) Sensor Alarm (31)
This alarm indicates the IAQ (CO2) sensor is out of
range. When this occurs the Unit Controller will switch
the ventilation mode from Demand to Fixed Minimum.
The IAQ sensor input is at terminal DV+ and DV-. This
device is field supplied.
High Duct Static Pressure Alarm (37)
Time Clock Error Alarm (32)
This alarm indicates the duct static pressure has exceeded
the Duct Static Shutdown Setpoint. The problem could
be caused by a faulty Duct Static Pressure Transducer
input. To check measure the VDC input between
terminal DP+ wire 337 at the P21 connector and
terminal DP- wire 338 at the P21 connector. Compare
the voltage verses the duct pressure the control indicates
to Table 8-2 in this section of the manual. Also verify
that 24 VAC is present between terminals “COM” and
“EXC” at the duct static transducer.
This alarm indicates the Unit Controller Real Time
Clock is not functioning. The Unit Controller will shut
down all operation. Try recycling power to the control.
If the fault reappears replace the Unit Controller.
Space Temperature Offset Alarm (33)
This alarm is generated when the resistance in the Space
Temperature Offset circuit is greater then 20,000 ohms.
The Space Temperature Offset input is at terminals SSD
and GND of the P6 connector. Check the resistance
between these to points. If greater then 20,000 ohms
check the tightness of the connections and the wire
wiring between the Unit Controller and the space sensor.
If both are okay and the resistance is still greater then
20,000 ohms replace the space sensor reset.
JOHNSON CONTROLS
166
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
Supply Air Temperature Cooling Alarm (38)
Space Temperature Trending Alarm (41)
The Unit Controller compares the supply air temperature
to the “SUPPLY AIR TEMP ALARM FOR COOLING”
and initiates the alarm based on the following criteria:
This alarm will be generated based on the following
criteria:
• The “SPACE TEMP TRENDING ALARM TEMP”
and the “SPACE TEMPERATURE ALARM
TIME” must be set.
• All the stages of cooling have been on for 10 or
more minutes.
• The supply air temperature is 20 or more degrees
above the “SUPPLY AIR TEMP ALARM FOR
COOLING” set point for 10 minutes.
• The outdoor air is not 20.0° F or more warmer
then the “SUPPLY AIR TEMP ALARM FOR
COOLING” set point.
• The unit has been in a given mode of operation
for 10 minutes.
• The temperature is below or above the space
temperature set point and the trend continues to
be away from the space temperature set point and
the “SPACE TEMP TRENDING ALARM TIME”
has expired.
• The outdoor air damper is not open more then
20%.
Duct Static Low Pressure Alarm (42)
Supply Air Temperature Heating Alarm (39)
This alarm is initiated on a VAV unit if after 35 seconds
of supply fan operation the duct static pressure is not
equal to or greater then 0.05” WC. When the alarm
becomes active the unit stops all operation and locks out.
This can be the result of a faulty Duct Static Pressure
Transducer or in the transition from an unoccupied to
occupied mode if the VAV boxes are wide open.
The Unit Controller compares the supply air temperature
to the “SUPPLY AIR TEMP ALARM FOR HEATING”
and initiates the alarm based on the following criteria:
• All the stages of heating have been on for 10 or
more minutes.
• The supply air temperature is 20 or more degrees
below the “SUPPLY AIR TEMP ALARM FOR
HEATING” set point for 10 minutes.
• The outdoor air is not 20.0° F or more cooler
then the “SUPPLY AIR TEMP ALARM FOR
HEATING” set point.
To check the operation of the duct static transducer
measure the VDC input between terminal DP+ wire
337 at the P21 connector and terminal DP- wire 338
at the P21 connector. Compare the voltage verses
the duct pressure the control indicates to Table 8-2 in
this section of the manual. Also verify that 24 VAC is
present between terminals “COM” and “EXC” at the
duct static transducer.
• The outdoor air damper is not open more then
20%.
Hot Water Coil Freeze Alarm (43)
Economizer Minimum Position Alarm (40)
The alarm indicates the hydronic freeze stat switch has
opened. The 24 VAC source originates at the terminal
FSP, wire 389. The input to the control originates at
terminal FSI, wire 388.
Prior to declaring this fault the Unit Controller checks the
outside air temperature and the economizer position. If
the outside air temperature is more then 20.0° F warmer
then the set point and the economizer is open more then
20%, the Unit Controller will close the economizer for
10 minutes and then check the supply air temperature.
If the SAT falls below the set point, the control will
declare an economizer minimum position alarm. The
Unit Controller will keep the economizer closed until
the end of the cooling cycle. It will then return the
economizer damper to its minimum position.
8
167
JOHNSON CONTROLS
Tele. 800-861-1001
www.york.com
P.O. Box 1592, York, Pennsylvania USA 17405-1592
Copyright © by Johnson Controls 2007
Subject to change without notice. Printed in USA
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED
Form 100.50-NOM6 (1207)
New Release
|